Platinum Mathematics Grade 12 - 220429 - 115301 - 230408 - 210600
Platinum Mathematics Grade 12 - 220429 - 115301 - 230408 - 210600
Platinum Mathematics Grade 12 - 220429 - 115301 - 230408 - 210600
Simply superior!
Mathematics
12
Platinum English First Platinum Afrikaans Huistaal Platinum Geography
Additional Language Grade 12 Graad 12 Grade 12 Learner’s Book
Mathematics
Platinum Business Studies Platinum Mathematical
Grade 12 Literacy Grade 12
Grade 12
• Superior illustrations and activities to improve results and motivate learners
• Superior teacher support to save time and make teaching easy, including
photocopiable worksheets, control tests and Question Bank CD-ROM
• Superior quality = exam success!
Learner’s Book
www.mml.co.za
linear pattern – an
• d is the common difference between the terms, d = T2 − T1 = T3 − T2 = Tn − Tn−1
common difference between • n is the position of a term and can only be a positive whole number, also known as
consecutive terms a natural number.
arithmetic sequence – a
sequence of numbers with a Consider the arithmetic sequence 3; 7; 11; 15; … 99
common difference between T1 = 3, T2 = 7, T3 = 11, T4 = 15
consecutive terms d1 = T2 – T1 = 7 – 3 = 4, d2 = T3 – T2 = 11 – 7 = 4 and d3 = T4 – T3 = 15 – 11 = 4.
common difference – the Since d1 = d2 = d3, we have a common difference of 4.
constant amount by which
consecutive terms increase (or The first term is given by a = 3 and the common difference is given by d = 4.
decrease) We determine the formula for the nth term in the sequence by substituting a = 3 and
d = 4 into Tn = a + (n – 1) d.
This gives us Tn = 3 + (n – 1)(4) = 3 + 4n – 4 = 4n – 1
Check the formula by substituting n = 1 to obtain the value of T1, n = 2 to obtain the
value of T2 and so on.
If n =1, then T1 = 4(1) – 1 = 3
If n = 2, then T2 = 4(2) – 1 = 7
If n = 3, then T3 = 4(3) – 1 = 11
The nth term formula, Tn = 4n – 1, can be used to determine the position of any term
in the sequence if the value of the term is given. To determine which term has a value
of 99, substitute Tn = 99 into Tn = 4n – 1.
99 = 4n – 1 ⇒ 4n = 100 and n = 25, so T25 = 99, which means that the twenty-fifth
term has a value of 99.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
1 d = T2 − T1 = 6 – 2 = 4
2 The common difference is 4, so the next two terms are 18 and 22.
3 Substitute a = 2 and d = 4 into the formula Tn = a + (n − 1)d
Tn = 2 + (n − 1)(4) = 4n − 2
4 Substitute n = 25 into Tn = 4n – 2 to find the value of T25
T25 = 4(25) − 2 = 98
5 Substitute Tn = 46 into Tn = 4n – 2 to determine the value of n.
4n − 2 = 46 ⇒ 4n = 48 and n = 12
The twelfth term has a value of 46.
6 n represents the position of a term and it cannot be negative, a fraction or
zero.
7 If n is a whole number, then 72 is a term in the sequence.
If n is negative, zero or a fraction, then 72 is not a term in the sequence.
Substitute Tn = 72 into the formula into Tn = 4n − 2
4n − 2 = 72 ⇒ 4n = 74 and n = 18,5 so 72 is not a term in the sequence.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTIONS d = Tn – Tn – 1
d = T2 – T1
1 d = T2 − T1 = T3 − T2 d = T3 – T2
( 5x − 2 ) − ( 3x − 1 ) = ( 4x + 3 ) − ( 5x − 2 )
5x − 2 − 3x + 1 = 4x + 3 − 5x + 2
3x = 6 ⇒ x = 2 a = T1 = 5
2 T1 = 3( 2 ) − 1 = 5; T2 = 5( 2 ) − 2 = 8 and T3 = 4( 2 ) + 3 = 11 d=8–5=3
Substitute a = 5 and d = 3 into Tn = a + ( n − 1 )d
⇒ Tn = 5 + ( n − 1 )( 3 ) = 5 + 3n − 3 = 3n + 2
Substitute n = 15 to
3 T15 = 3( 15 ) + 2 = 47
determine the fifteenth term’s
4 Tn = 3n + 2 = 302 ⇒ 3n = 300
Find n if Tn = 302, so value, T15
n = 100 substitute Tn = 302.
5 Tn = 3n + 2 = 150 ⇒ 3n = 148
n = ____ = 49__
148 1
3 3
⇒ n ∉ ℕ, so Tn ≠ 150
n is the position of term
Tn and must be a natural
number.
WORKED EXAMPLE
The sixth term of an arithmetic sequence is −5 and the sum of the second and
eighth terms is −2. Determine the first three terms in the sequence.
SOLUTION
T2 + T8 = −2, T2 = a + d and T8 = a + 7d
( a + d ) + ( a + 7d ) = −2
2a + 8d = −2 ⇒ a = −1 − 4d ➁
Substitute ➁ into ➀:
( −1 − 4d ) + 5d = −5 ⇒ d = −4
Substitute d = −4 into ➁ :
a = −1 − 4( −4 ) = 15
T1 = 15; T2 = 11; T3 = 7
1 The fifth term of an arithmetic sequence is 23 and the 12th term is 72.
1.1 Determine the first three terms of the sequence and the nth term.
1.2 What is the value of the tenth term?
1.3 Which term has a value of 268?
2 The 11th term of an arithmetic sequence is 57 and the sum of the first and fourth
terms is 29.
2.1 Determine the first three terms of the sequence.
2.2 Determine a formula for the nth term.
2.3 Is 100 a term in the sequence? Justify your answer.
3 The sum of the second and sixth terms of an arithmetic sequence is 4.
The third term is 24 more than the 11th term.
3.1 Determine the first three terms in the sequence.
3.2 Determine a formula for the nth term of the sequence.
3.3 Determine the 17th term in the sequence.
3.4 Is −72 a term in the sequence? Justify your answer.
Which term in the sequence −2; − __ ; − __
5 4
4 3 3
; −1; … has a value of 8?
5 Consider the sequence 13; 11; 9; 7; 5; … .
5.1 Determine a formula for the nth term of the sequence.
5.2 Show that Tn + T15 − n = 0, for n ∈ ℕ, n < 15
6 The second term of an arithmetic sequence 6 __ 1
2
and the tenth term is 18 __
1
2
.
6.1 th
Determine a formula for the n term of the sequence.
6.2 Is 93 a term in the sequence? Justify your answer.
7 The letters of the alphabet are arranged in rows as illustrated, starting with A
and ending with Z.
Row 3 C C C C C C C C C C C
Row 2 B B B B B B B
Row 1 A A A
7.1 Which row will contain the letter K and how many Ks will there be
in that row?
7.2 Which letter will appear 79 times and in which row will this letter be?
KEY WORDS
• a is the value of the first term T3
T2 ___ Tn
• r is the common ratio between the terms, r = ___
T
= T = ____
T 1 2 n−1
geometric sequence – a
sequence of numbers with
• Tn is the value of the term in position n, so Tn = ar n−1
a common ratio between Consider the geometric sequence 5; 10; 20; 40; 80; …
consecutive terms The terms are doubling, so the next term will be 160.
common ratio – the constant T2 T3 T3
r1 = ___ = ___ = 2, r2 = ___ = ___ = 2, r3 = ___ = ___
10 20 40
T 5 T 10 T 20
= 2, so r1 = r2 = r3 = 2 and so the
amount by which consecutive 1 2 2
terms are multiplied common ratio is 2.
The first term is given by a = 5 and the common ratio is given by r = 2.
In order to determine a formula for the nth term, substitute a = 5 and r = 2 into the
formula Tn = ar n−1
The formula for the nth term in this series is given by Tn = 5 × 2n−1
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTIONS
Each term is half the
6; 3; __
value of the previous 3
1 2
term.
2 The first term is 96, so a = 96.
T2 ___
___ 48 __ T3 24 1
= and ___ = ___ = __, so this is a geometric sequence with r = __
1 1
=
T1 96 2 T2 48 2 2
Substitute a = 96 and r = __
1
2
into Tn = ar n−1 ⇒ Tn = 96 __
1
2 ( )
n−1
⇒ T = 96 __
10
1 10−1
(2)
= 96 __ = ___
1 9 3
(2) 16
4 To determine which term has a value of ___
3
64
, substitute Tn = ___
3
64
into Tn = 96 __
1
2 ( )n−1
∴ ___
3
64
= 96 __
(2)
1 n−1
⇒ _______
3
= __
1 n−1
64 × 96 (2)
_____
1
∴ 2 048 = ( __12 )
n−1
and so __
1
2 ( ) = ( __12 )
11 n−1
| 2 048 = 211
∴ n – 1 = 11 and n = 12
( 5x + 3 )( x − 6 ) = ( 2x − 6 )( 2x − 6 )
5x2 − 27x − 18 = 4x2 − 24x + 36
x2 − 3x − 54 = 0
( x − 9 )( x + 6 ) = 0
x = 9 or x = −6
2 T1 = −6 − 6 = −12, T2 = 2(−6) – 6 = − 18 and T3 = 5(−6) + 3 = −27
T2 ____
a = T1 = −12 and r = ___ = −12 = __
−18 3
T 21
EXERCISE 3
The second term in a geometric sequence is −4 and the fifth term is 32.
1 Determine a formula for the nth term of this sequence, that is, Tn.
2 Which term has a value of −1 024?
3 Determine the eighth term in the sequence.
SOLUTIONS
If any term in a 1 T2 = −4 = ar ➀
geometric sequence T5 = 32 = ar 4 ➁
is divided by any ar 4 ___
___ 32
➁÷➀⇒ = ar −4
other term in the
same sequence, the a r 3 = −8 = ( −2 )3 ⇒ r = −2
values cancel. Substitute r = −2 into ➀
a( − 2 ) = − 4 ⇒ a = 2
Tn = 2( − 2 )n−1
–1 024 is the value of 2 Tn = 2( − 2 )n−1 = −1 024
Tn in the formula
( −2 )n−1 = −512 = ( −2 )9
Tn = 2(–2)n–1
n − 1 = 9 ⇒ n = 10
3 T8 = 2( −2 )7 = −256
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTION
4x2 − 17x + 4 = 0
( 4x − 1 )( x − 4 ) = 0
⇒ x = __
1
4
or x = 4
If x = 4 , then y = 2 __
__
1 1
4 ( )
− 2 = −__
3
2
A.P. 2; __1
4
; − __
3
2
G.P. __
1
4
; − __
3
2
; 9
If x = 4, then y = 2( 4 ) − 2 = 6
A.P. 2; 4; 6
G.P. 4; 6; 9
The third term of a geometric sequence is 6 and the sixth term is ___
3
1 32
.
Determine the first three terms and the general term Tn.
2 The first term of a geometric sequence is 3 and the sum of the second and third
terms is 60. Determine the first three terms and the general term Tn.
3 The first three terms of the sequence 6; x; y; 27 form an arithmetic progression
and the last three terms form a geometric progression.
3.1 Determine the values of x and y.
3.2 State the arithmetic and geometric sequences for each of your solutions.
4 The first three terms of the sequence 6; x; y; 16 form an arithmetic progression
and the last three terms form a geometric progression.
4.1 Determine x and y.
4.2 State the arithmetic and geometric sequences for each of your solutions.
Consider the sequence: __ 1 ___
; ; ___; ____
3 5 7
5 4 16 64 256
;…
5.1 State the next two terms in the sequence.
5.2 Determine the nth term of the sequence.
The algebraic proof below applies to all arithmetic series and is examinable.
Required to prove: S = __[2a + n − 1d]
n
n 2
Proof:
In each column the ds add
up to zero because they are
always equal in value, but a is the first term, d is the difference, n is the number of terms and l is the last term,
opposite in sign. given by l = Tn = a + ( n − 1 )d
Sn = a + (a + d) + (a + 2d) + … + (l − 2d) + (l − d) + l ➀
The second row of Sn = l + (l − d) + (l − 2d) + … + (a + 2d) + (a + d) + a ➁
terms is obtained by
reversing the order of ➀ + ➁: 2Sn = (a + l) + (a + l) + (a + l) + … + (a + l) + (a + l) + (a + l)
the terms in first row. for n terms
2Sn = n( a + l ) ⇒ Sn = __
n(
2
a + l)
There are n terms, so
Substitute l = a + ( n − 1 )d into Sn = __
n(
there are n columns. 2
a + l)
__
n( __
n
⇒ S = a + l ) = S = [ 2a + ( n − 1 )d ]
n 2 n 2
Before you decide which version of the formula to use, check the information given:
• If the value of the last term is given, use the formula sn = __2 ( a + l ).
n
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTION
a = 4, d = 7 and l = 368
Tn = a + ( n − 1 )d ⇒ 368 = 4 + ( n − 1 )( 7 )
So n − 1 = _______ and n = 53
368 − 4
7
Sn = __ a + l ) ⇒ S53 = ___
n( 53 (
2 2
4 + 368 ) = 9 858
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
Determine the sum of the first 20 terms of the arithmetic series −15 − 9 − 3 + 3 + …
SOLUTION
a = −15, d = 6 and n = 20
S = __[ 2a + ( n − 1 )d ]
n
n 2
⇒ S20 = ___
20 [ (
2
2 −15 ) + 19( 6 ) ] = 840
∴ 11 + T2 = 26 and T2 = 15
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
Sn = 2n2 + 9n
SOLUTION
1 S1 = T1 = 2( 1 )2 + 9( 1 ) = 11 ∴ T1 = 11
S2 = T1 + T2 = 2( 2 )2 + 9( 2 ) = 26
∴ 11 + T2 = 26 and T2 = 15
S3 = T1 + T2 + T3 = 2( 3 )2 + 9( 3 ) = 45
∴ 26 + T3 = 45 and T3 = 19
The first three terms are 11, 15, 19.
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
The second term of a sequence is 17 and the sum of the first six terms is 147.
Determine the first three terms and the nth term.
SOLUTION
T2 = 17 and S6 = 147
Tn = a + ( n − 1 )d ⇒ T2 = a + d = 17 and so a = 17 − d ➀
S = __
n
n[
2
2a + ( n − 1 )d ]
⇒ S6 = __
6[
2
2a + 5d ] = 147
∴ 3( 2a + 5d ) = 147 and 2a + 5d = 49 ➁
Substitute ➀ into ➁:
⇒ 2( 17 − d ) + 5d = 49
⇒ 34 − 2d + 5d = 49
∴ 3d = 15 and d = 5
Substitute d = 5 into ➀:
⇒ a = 17 − 5 = 12
T1 = 12, T2 = 17 and T3 = 22
Tn = a + ( n − 1 )d = 12 + ( n − 1 )( 5 ) = 5n + 7
EXERCISE 5
The algebraic proof below applies to all geometric series and is examinable.
a( 1 − r n ) a( r n − 1 )
Required to prove: S = ________ = ________, for r ≠ 1
n 1−r r−1
Proof:
Sn = a + ar + ar 2 + … + ar n −2 + ar n − 1 ➀
r Sn = ar + ar 2 +…+ ar n − 2 + ar n − 1 + ar n ➁
➀ − ➁: Sn − r Sn = a − ar n
a( 1 − r n ) a( r n − 1 )
Sn( 1 − r ) = a( 1 − r n ) ⇒ Sn = ________ = ________
r−1
, r≠1
( ) 1−r
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
Determine the sum of the first seven terms in the geometric series
3 + 15 + 75 + …
SOLUTION
a( 1 − r n ) 3( 1 − 57 )
a = 3, r = 5 and n = 7 ⇒ Sn = ________
1−r
= ________
1−5
= 58 593
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTION
a = 5, r = ___
10
5
= 2 and Tn = 5r n−1 = 655 360 ⇒ r n−1 = 131 072 = 217, so n = 18
| By trial and error
a( 1 − r n ) 5( 1 − 218 )
S = ________ = _________ = 1 310 715
n 1−r 1−2
The first term of a geometric series is 16 and the sum of the second term and third
term is 12.
Determine the sum of the first ten terms.
SOLUTION
4r 2 + 4r − 3 = 0 ⇒ ( 2r + 3 )( 2r − 1 ) = 0 and so r = − __ or r = __
3 1
2 2
If r = −__ then S
3 ( ( 3) )
16 1 − − __
10
= ____________ = −______
2 11 605
1 − ( − __
10
2)
2 3 32
16( 1 − ( __
2) )
1 10
If r = __ = ___________ = _____
1 1 023
2
, then S10 32
1 − __
1
2
REMEMBER EXERCISE 6
a is the first term. Round off your answers to two decimal places where necessary.
r is the common ratio.
1 Determine the sum of the first 12 terms of the series 36 + 24 + 16 + … .
n is the number of terms or
2 Determine the sum of the first 10 terms of the series 125 + 100 + 80 + 64 + … .
the position of a term.
Tn = ar n−1 is the formula for 3 Determine the sum of the series 54 + 18 + 6 + … + ___ 2
. 81
the nth term in a geometric 4 Determine the sum of the series 3 125 + 625 + 125 + 25+ …+ ____
1
625
.
sequence.
( (3) )
n
5 Determine the fifth term of the series if S = ____
243
1− __
1
.
a( 1 − r n )
S = ________ is the formula
n 1−r
n 2
for the sum of the first n
terms in a geometric series.
The sum of an infinite number of terms of a geometric series can be determined
Tn = Sn − Sn−1
if −1 < r < 1
If r > 1, then r n → ∞ as n → ∞, so a sum to infinity cannot be determined.
• If r = 2, the sequence 2n diverges:
KEY WORDS 2; 4; 8; 16; 32; 64; 128; 256; 512; 1 024; 2 048; 4 096; 8 192; …
infinite series – a series that If r < −1, then r n → −∞ when n is odd and n → ∞, but r n → ∞ when n is even and n → ∞.
has no end and for which it is
impossible to determine the • If r = −2 the sequence ( −2 )n diverges and oscillates:
number of terms −2; 4; −8; 16; −32; 64; −128; 256; −512; …
diverge – grow further apart
in value If −1 < r < 1, r n → 0 as n → ∞, so a sum to infinity can be determined.
oscillate – swing back and
( )
n
forth between large and small • If r = __
1
2
, the sequence __
1
2
converges __
1 __
; 1 ; __
1 ___
; 1 ; ___
1 ___
; 1 ; ____
1 ____
2 4 8 16 32 64 128 256 512 1 024
; 1 ; ____
1 _____
; 1 ;…
values, and between positive
and negative values
sum to infinity – no limit to
• If r = −__
1
2
, the sequence −__ ( )
1 n
2
oscillates and converges
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTION
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTIONS
−1 < __
k
1 2
< 1 ⇒ −2 < k < 2
−1,5
2 a = − 24 and r = _____
2
= −0,75
_____
a
⇒ S∞ = 1 − r = ___________
−24
1 − ( − 0,75 )
=−7 ___
96
EXERCISE 7
∑( 2k − 1 ) = [ 2( 1 ) − 1 ] + [ 2( 2 ) − 1 ] + [ 2( 3 ) − 1 ] = 1 + 3 + 5 = 9
k=1
• k = 1, so substitute 1 into the formula to determine the value of the first term, T1
• Substitute the 3 above the sigma sign to determine the value of the last term.
• There are ( 3 − 1 + 1 ) = 3 terms in the series.
• The formula for each term is given by Tk = 2k − 1
2
∑ 2n = 2 −3
+ 2−2 + 2−1 + 20 + 21 + 22 = __
1 __
+ + __ + 1 + 2 + 4 = 7__
1 1
8 4 2
7
8
n = −3
The number at the bottom and top of the sigma sign may need to change in each
series. You are often given these numbers, but you may need to find either the top or
the bottom value if all other values are given. First substitute the bottom value, fol-
REMEMBER lowed by consecutive integers (always increasing by 1) until you have substituted the
a is the first term for both top value.
an arithmetic series and a
geometric series. In one of the examples above, the formula is Tn = 2k − 1 and the substitution values
d is the common difference of are k = 1, k = 2 and k = 3. So you substitute 1 to determine the first term’s value and
an arithmetic series. 3 to determine the last term’s value.
5
Sn = __
n( + )
2
a l are both sum ∑ ( 5n − 2 ) = [ 5( − 4 ) − 2 ] + [ 5( − 3 ) − 2 ] + [ 5( −2 ) − 2 ] + … + [ 5( 20 ) − 2 ]
formulae for arithmetic series. n = −4
= −22 − 17 − 12 − ... + 98
a( 1 − r n )
S = ________ is the formula
n 1−r
for the sum of the first n a = −22, l = 98 and n = 25
S = __( a + l )
terms in a geometric series. n
n 2
S = _____ , −1 < r < 1 is the
a
⇒ S25 = ___
25 (
∞ 1−r
2
−22 + 98 )
formula for the sum to infinity
of an infinite geometric series. = 950
Tn = Sn − Sn−1 in both
arithmetic and geometric
series.
n=1
SOLUTION
∞
∑3( __12 )n −1 1
2( )
= 3 __
+ 3 __
1 2−1
2
1− 1 1
2( )
+ 3 __ ( )
3−1
+ … = 3 + __
3 __
2 4
3
+ …
n=1
__
1 _____
a
a = 3, r = 2 and S∞ = 1 − r = _____
3
=6
1 − __
1
2
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
n
If ∑__12( 3r −1 )
= 1 640, determine the value of n.
r=1
SOLUTION
n
∑__12( 3r −1 ) 1 __
= __
3 9
2 2 2
3n −1
+ + __ + … + ____
2
= 1 640
r=1
G.P. a = __
1
2
, r = 3 and Sn = 1 640
a( 1 − r n )
Sn = ________
1−r
__
1(
1 − 3n )
= ________
2
1−3
= 1 640
− __
1(
4
1 − 3n )
= 1 640
1 − 3n = −6 560
3n = 6 561
⇒n=8
Evaluate each of the series below and express the result in sigma notation:
1 12 + 4 − 4 … −276
2 100 + 40 + 16 + …
3 5 − 10 + 20 − … 5 120
4 1 + 4 + 9 + 16 + 25 + 36 + 49
SOLUTIONS
∑( 20 − 8n ) = −4 884
n=1
| r = ____
40 ___16 __
2 a = 100 and r = __
2
5
=
100 40 5
=2
∞
S∞ = _____
a
= ______
100
× __
5
= ____
500
⇒ ∑100( __25 )n−1
= ____
500
1−r
(
2 5
1 − __
5
3
) n=1
3
3 a = 5, r = −2 and Tn = 5 120
Tn = ar n−1 = 5 × ( −2 )n−1 = 5 120 ⇒ ( −2 )n−1 = 1 024 = ( −2 )10
5( 1 − ( −2 )11 )
⇒ n = 11 and S = ___________ = 3 415
11 1 − ( −2 )
11
∑5 × ( −2 )n −1 = 3 415
n=1 7
EXERCISE 8
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
12x 6x
6 2x 6x
6x
3 2x
12x
6x
6 2x 6x
6x
3 2x
12x
The large red square has sides of 12x cm. The midpoints are joined to form the
green square. The midpoints of the green square are joined to form the purple
square. This process is repeated indefinitely. Calculate the sum of the areas of all
the squares that are found this way, including the large red square. REMEMBER
Pythagoras’ Theorem: In a
SOLUTION right-angled triangle, the
square on the hypotenuse
The sides of the large red square are 12x cm.
is equal to the sum of the
By Pythagoras' Theorem: squares on the other two
The sides of the large green square are: sides.
__________ ____ __ Remember to convert units
√ 36x2 + 36x2 = √ 72x2 = 6√ 2 x cm
to the same value. All units
By Pythagoras' Theorem: should be in m, cm or mm.
The sides of the large purple square are:
_______________
__ __ ____
√( 3√2 x )2 + ( 3√2 x )2 = √36x2 = 6x cm
__ __
Sides of squares: 12x; 6√2 x; 6x; 3√2 x
Areas of squares: 144x2; 72x2; 36x2; 18x2...
This is a geometric series with a = 144x2 and r = __
1
2
.
Sum of areas of squares:
144x2
S = _____ = 288x2
∞
1 − __
1
2
1
Note that the sum to infinity can be determined because −1 < __
2 < 1.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
At the end of the first year after planting, a tree is one metre tall. In the second
year its height increases by 56 cm. In each successive year its height increases by __
7
8
of the previous year’s increase in height.
1 Determine the increase in the height of the tree in the third year.
2 Determine the total height of the tree after three years.
3 Lobelo says that by the end of the fifth year the tree will exceed a height of
3m. Thabo disagrees with him and says that the tree will only exceed a height
of 3m after 6 years. Is either of them correct? Fully justify your answer by
means of calculations.
4 Calculate the maximum height to which the tree will grow.
SOLUTIONS
Neither of them is correct. It will be less than 3 m by the end of 5 yers and
more than 3 m by the end of 6 years, so it will exceed 3 m during the sixth
year.
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
˙=2
Show that 1,9
SOLUTION
The large red triangle has a base of 96 cm and a height of 64 cm. The base of the
green triangle is half the base of the red triangle and its height is three quarters
of the height of the red triangle. The base of the purple triangle is half the base
of the green triangle and its height is three quarters of the height of the green
triangle. Determine the sum of areas of all of the triangles that will be created if
this process is repeated indefinitely.
2 Zukile trained for the Comrades. In the first week of training he ran 5 km per day.
In the second week he ran 7 km per day and in the third week he ran 9 km per day.
He ran on every day except Sundays when he rested.
2.1 In which week did his total distance exceed 100 km for the first time?
2.2 How far did he run in the tenth week?
2.3 Determine the total distance Zukile ran during the first ten weeks of
his training.
3 Siseko is hoping to buy a car when he turns 18. His grandmother offers to sell
him her car for R131 071. He works on Saturdays only and earns R200 every
Saturday. He saves R1 on the first Saturday. Each Saturday thereafter he doubles
the amount he saved on the previous Saturday. He puts the money into a bottle
on his desk and not into a bank account.
3.1 In which week will his weekly payment exceed his earnings for the first
time, and what is the amount of the final payment he can afford?
3.2 How much will he have saved by the time he is no longer able to afford
the weekly payments?
3.3 If he had been able to afford the payments, how long would it have taken
him to save R131 071?
4 Show that 0,1 ˙7
˙ = ___
17
.
99
5 A tree grows to a height of 3 metres in the first year. In the second year it grows
2,5 metres. In each successive year its height increases by __
4
5
of the increase in
height of the previous year.
What is the maximum height to which the tree can grow?
7 A bouncy rubber ball dropped from any height will lose 25% of its height on
each successive bounce. If dropped from a height of 30 m, the first bounce will
have a height of 22,5 m and the second bounce a height of 16,875 m. Determine
the total vertical distance travelled by the ball from the time it is dropped from
a height of 40 m, until it finally comes to rest. Note that the height from which
the ball is dropped is 40 m, and not 30 m.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTIONS
1 −6 2−x 4 2x + 5
8−x 2+x 2x + 1
2x − 6 x−1
2x − 6 = x − 1 ⇒ x = 5
The sequence is −6; −3; 4; 15
2 Tn = an2 + bn + c
T1 T2 T3 T4 T0 T1 T2 T3 T4
−6 −3 4 15 −5 −6 −3 4 15
3 7 11 −1 3 7 11
4 4 4 4 4
2a = 4 ⇒ a = 2 2a = 4 ⇒ a = 2
3a + b = 3 ⇒ b = 3 − 6 = −3 T0 = −5 = c
a + b + c = −6 T1 = a + b + c = −6
2 − 3 + c = −6 and c = −5 2 + b − 5 = −6 and b = −3
Tn = 2n2 − 3n − 5 Tn = 2n2 − 3n − 5
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
SOLUTION
1 + 2 + 4 + 5 + 8 + 10 + 15 + 16 + … + 256 + 260
Geometric sequence with
( 1 + 2 + 4 + 8 + 16 + … + 256 ) + ( 5 + 10 + 15 + 20 + … + 260 )
a = 1 and r = 2
Tn = 2n−1 = 256 = 28 ⇒ n = 9
and
Arithmetic sequence with
Tn = 5n = 260 ⇒ n = 52
1( 1 − 29 ) 52 a = d = 5 and l = 260
Sum = ________ + ___( 5 + 260 )
1−2 2
= 511 + 6 890
= 7 401
The first two terms of a geometric sequence and an arithmetic sequence are
the same. The first term is 4. The sum of the first three terms of the
geometric sequence is one more than the sum of the first three terms of the
arithmetic sequence. Determine two possible values of r, the common ratio
of the geometric sequence.
SOLUTION
Check:
A.P.: 4; 6; 8 and G.P.: 4; 6; 9
or A.P.: 4; 2; 0 and G.P. 4; 2; 1
EXERCISE 10
4
3
2
1
2 4 6 8
Triangle 1 Triangle 2 Triangle 3 Triangle 4
7.1 Determine a formula for the area of the nth triangle if the pattern
continues in the same way.
7.2 What type of sequence is formed by the areas of these triangles?
1 Consider the sequences A, B and C and for each sequence, answer the questions
that follow.
A 1; 6; 11; 16; 21; … B 3; 6; 12; 24; 48; … C 0; 5; 12; 21; 32; …
1.1 Is the sequence arithmetic, geometric or quadratic? Fully justify your
answer. (2)
1.2 th
Determine a formula for the n term of the sequence. (3)
1.3 Which term has a value of 96? (4)
1.4 Is 1 536 a term in the sequence? Fully justify your answer. (2)
1.5 th
Determine the 20 term in the sequence. (2)
1.6 If the sequence is arithmetic or geometric: REMEMBER
1.6.1 express the sum of the first fifty terms in sigma notation (2)
1.6.2 determine the sum of the first 50 terms. (4) If x2 = 9, then x = 3 or −3
If x2 = 16, x = ±4
2 Given the sequence: 32; x; 18 a is the first term for both
2.1 Determine the value(s) of x if the sequence is arithmetic. (3) an arithmetic series and a
2.2 Determine the value(s) of x if the sequence is geometric. (3) geometric series.
15 d is the common difference of
3 Determine the value of A if A = ∑5k −6
. (4) an arithmetic series.
k=1 r is the common ratio of a
4 The following sequence is a combination of an arithmetic sequence and geometric series.
a geometric sequence: n is the number of terms or
5; 5; 15; 10; 25; 20; 35; 40; … the position of a term in both
arithmetic and geometric
4.1 Write down the next 2 terms. (4)
sequences.
4.2 Calculate T42 − T41. (6)
n ∈ ℕ as it indicates the
4.3 Determine the sum of the first 50 terms. (6) position of a term in the
4.4 Prove that ALL the terms of this infinite sequence will be divisible by 5. (4) sequence.
Tn = a + ( n − 1 )d is the
5 A quadratic pattern has a third term equal to 16, a fourth term equal to 35 and
formula for the nth term in an
a sixth term equal to 91.
arithmetic sequence.
5.1 Determine the second difference of this quadratic pattern. (4) Tn = ar n−1 is the formula for
5.2 Determine the first term of the pattern. (4) the nth term in a geometric
5.3 Determine the nth term of the pattern. (4) sequence.
Sn = __
n[
2
2a + ( n − 1 )d ]
6 The following sequence forms a convergent geometric sequence:
and Sn = __
n( + )
x3 a l are both
7x; x2; __
7
; … 2
sum formulae for arithmetic
6.1 Determine the possible values of x. (3) series.
a( 1 − r n )
6.2 If x = −4, calculate S∞. (4) Sn = ________
1−r
is the formula
n for the sum of the first
7 ∑( 3k − 15 ) = 285 n terms in a geometric series.
S∞ = _____
k=1 a
1−r
if −1 < r < 1
7.1 How many terms are there in the sequence? (4) is the formula for the sum
7.2 The odd numbers are removed from the sequence. to infinity of an infinite
Calculate the sum of the terms of the remaining sequence. (6) geometric series.
If a sequence converges, the
8 The sequence 3; −2; x; −24; … is a quadratic sequence. ratio lies between −1 and 1.
8.1 Calculate x. (4) The area of a triangle
8.2 Determine the nth term of the sequence. (5) = __1
base × ⊥ height
2
The area of a circle = πr2
29
14 A shrub grew in a greenhouse for one year and reached a height of 108 cm. The
shrub was planted in a garden and in the second year grew 54 cm. During each
consecutive year, the height increased by __
1
3
of the previous year’s increase.
14.1 Calculate the height of the shrub after 5 years. (5)
14.2 Show that the shrub could never reach a height of 2 m. (3)
15. The first term of an arithmetic sequence is 1. The first, second and fifth terms of
the arithmetic sequence form a geometric sequence. The common difference is
not zero.
15.1 Find the common difference of the arithmetic sequence. (4)
15.2 Determine the first three terms of the geometric sequence. (4)
16 Insert four geometric means between 7 and 224. (Insert the missing terms of the
geometric sequence.) (5)
17 Insert 3 arithmetic means between 22 and −14. (Insert the missing terms of the
arithmetic sequence.) (4)
30
8 The sum to infinity of a convergent series is 243. The sum of the first five terms
is 242. Determine the values of the common ratio and the first term. (7)
31
If Sn = __
3 2 __ 5
10 2
n − 2 n, determine:
10.1 the 11th term of the sequence (5)
10.2 the nth term of the sequence. (5)
10.3 How many terms have a sum of 1 106? (7)
11 The sum of the first two terms of a convergent geometric sequence is 15 and the
sum of all its terms is 20.
11.1 Determine the ratio(s). (9)
11.2 Determine the first three terms in the series. (6)
12 Three positive numbers are in the ratio 1:3:8. If 7 is added to the largest number,
the three numbers form a geometric sequence. Find the numbers. (5)
13 Evaluate:
3
13.1 ∑( k + 1 )k
k=0
100
13.2 ∑( 9 − 7k )
k=1
13.3 ∑5 × 2 1 −n
n−1
(3 × 4)
14 A bouncy ball is dropped from a height of 25 m. On each bounce the ball reaches
80% of its previous height. Determine the total vertical distance travelled by the
ball from the time it is dropped until it finally comes to rest. (6)
32
D I F
J L
G K H
B E C
20.1 Determine the lengths of the sides of the first three triangles formed in
this way. (3)
20.2 State the heights of these triangles. (3)
20.3 What type of sequence is generated by
the heights? (2)
20.4 Determine the areas of the red, blue and green triangles. (3)
20.5 Determine the sum of the areas of all the triangles formed in this way. (4)
__
20.6 Solve for x if the sum of all the areas is given by 19 200√ 3 . (4)
33
REMEMBER If f(x) = y = 2x + 3
You have worked with Then f(1) = 2(1) + 3 = 5 and f(−3) = 2(−3) + 3 = −3.
x
functions and function Notice that the vertical dotted line cuts the graph of f(x)
notation before. once only, indicating a one-to-one correspondence
(−3;−3)
between x and y.
EXERCISE 1
1 The x and y values in the tables represent a relation between x and y. State
whether each relation is:
one-to-one, one-to-many, many-to-one or many-to-many.
Use your answers to say whether each relation in 1.1−1.5 is a function or not.
1.4 x y 1.5 x y
4 1 0 1
8 2 1 3
12 3 2 5
16 4 3 3
20 5 4 1
Unit 1 Functions 35
2.1 y 2.2 y
x x
2.3 y 2.4 y
x x
3 State how the range of each graph should be restricted so that is becomes a
function.
3.1 3.1 3.1
3.2 3.2 3.2
3.3 3.3 3.3
3.1 y y 3.2y y y y y 3.3y y
x 0 1 4 9 16 25
y
Figure 2
In Figure 3 the domain of f(x) is restricted to x ≤ 0 y
making f(x) a one-to-one function and therefore its f(x); x ≤ 0
inverse is also a function.
(−1;2)
If a horizontal line cuts a function more than once,
the function is a many-to-one function and therefore
x
its inverse will not be a function unless the domain
is restricted. f 'x
(2;−1)
Figure 3
x (3;0)
(1;0) x
(0;−3)
f
1.3 f 1.4
1.3 y 1.4 y
f y = x² + 1
x
(−2;5) (2;5)
(−1;−3) (1;−3)
(0;1)
x
f y = –3x²
2 The graphs of f(x) = −x2 and g(x) = −2x − 3 are sketched below. A and B are the
points of intersection of f and g.
g y
x
A
g(x) = _____
x−6
5
6.2 f(x) = 2x2 − 1
____
g(x) = ± √_____
x+1
2
f(x) = _____
x+1
6.3 x
g(x) = _____
1
x−1
6.4 f(x) = 3x3 + 1
_____
g(x) = √______
3(x − 1)
3
SOLUTIONS
Figure 1 Figure 2
SOLUTIONS y
x = −4 x=1
1 Asymptotes: x = 1 and y = − 4 10 y=x
y-intercept: x = 0 ∴ y = _____
1
0−1
−4= f
−5
5
x-intercept: y = 0 ∴ 4 = _____
1
x−1 f²
y=1
2 Asymptotes: y = 1 and x = −4
y-intercept: x = 0 and y = __
5 x
5
−;0
4 −10 −5
4
5 10
x-intercept: y = 0 and x = −5
3 f −1(x) is a function because it is a −5 y = −4
one-to-one relation. The vertical
line test shows that the graph is cut f −2
f (x): x = ______
−1 1
(y − 1)
−4
∴ (x + 4) = ______
1
(y − 1)
∴ (y − 1) = ______
1
(x + 4)
∴ f −1(x) = y = ______ + 1
1
(x + 4)
3 f(x) = ______
−2
(x − 4)
+2
1 Say whether the statements that follow are true or false. Give a reason for
Questions marked with an
your answer.
asterisk are for enrichment
1.1 The inverse of f = {(2;3), (4;7)} is equal to {(3;2), (7;4)}. (2) and are not examinable.
1.2 f = {(2;3), (4;7), (4;−7), (2;−3)} is a many-to-one function. (2)
1.3 The inverse of the graph in A is a function.
1.4 The graphs in B are reflections in the x-axis, which means they are
also inverses. (2)
1.5 The graph in C is a one-to-many relation.
1.6 1.6.1 If the domain of the graph in D is restricted to y ≥ 1,
then the graph is a function. (2)
1.6.2 The minimum value of the inverse graph in D is (1;2). (2)
A y B y
f(x)
x x
–f(x)
y y
C D
(2;1)
x
x
43
3 Match the functions below with their inverse functions. There is one that does
not match.
3.1 (2)
A y B y C y
6 6 6
4 4 4
2 2 2
x x x
−6 −4 −2 2 4 6 −6 −4 −2 2 4 6 −6 −4 −2 2 4 6
−2 −2 −2
−4 −4 −4
−6 −6 −6
D y E y
6 6
4 4
2 2
x x
−6 −4 −2 2 4 6 −6 −4 −2 2 4 6
−2 −2
−4 −4
−6 −6
3.2 (2)
A y B C y
y
(1;2)
(−2;1)
x x x
(−2;−1)
D y E y
(2;1)
x x
(−1;–2)
44
4 The following inverse functions are given. Find the equation of each function.
1
4.1 q −1(x) = __
2 x__+ 3 (2)
−1
4.2 p (x) = x + 1
√ (2)
_____
4.3 r −1(x) = − √x − 2 − 3 (2)
5 The graphs of f(x) = 2x2 and g(x) = x + 3 are sketched alongside. A and B are the
points of intersection of f and g.
y
f
g
B
A
45
1
6 The graphs of f(x) = __
x and g(x) = 5x − 4 are
sketched alongside. A and B are the points of intersection of f and g.
y g
A
f
x
46
P(4;7)
A B y C
y y
x P(7;4)
P(−4;7)
x
P(4;−7) x
7.1 Match the graph with its function and write down the letter
corresponding to each function. (3)
7.2 State which graph (A, B or C) is not a function and how the range should
be restricted so that it becomes a function. (2)
47
x −4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3 4
___
1 __
1 __
1 __
1 0 2 4 8 16
y = 2x 16 8 4 2
1 x
y = 2−x = __ (2) 16 8 4 2 0 __
1
2
__
1
4
__
1
8
___
1
16
(−3;8) (3;8)
(−2;4) (2;4)
—1 1
− 4;16 (0;1) 4; —
16
x
When you compare y = a x and y = a −x you can see that the two graphs are reflections
in the y-axis.
The graph of y = ax + p has a horizontal asymptote y = p.
The focus of this unit is on y = a x, a > 0, a ≠ 1.
WORKED EXAMPLES y
f REMEMBER
1 Solve for x if 27.(3x+1) = ___
1 (a;8)
x 27 When working with
2 The graph of f(x) = 4x+1 is shown alongside. exponents and logarithms,
2.1 Find the coordinates of P, P remember that:
the y-intercept of f. 20 = 1
2.2 Find the value of a if (a;8) lies on f. 2 1 = 2; 2 −1 = __
1
2
2.3 Write down the equation g,
x 2 2 = 4; 2 −2 = __
1
4
the reflection of f in the x-axis
and the coordinates of Q. 2 3 = 8; 2 −3 = __
1
8
2 4 = 16; 2 −4 = ___
1
16
Q 2 5 = 32; 2 −5 = ___
1
32
3 The graphs of f and g are drawn in the figure alongside. 2 6 = 64; 2 −6 = ___
1
64
g is the reflection of f in the y-axis. g
f(x) = a x, (2;9) and p;___
1
81 ( )
are points on f.
g y f
3.1 Determine the values of a and p. REMEMBER
3.2 Determine the equation of g in the form (2;9)
Definition and laws of
y=…
exponents
3.3 Determine the equation of h, Definition:
the reflection of f in the x-axis. a x = a × a × a × a × a ... to x
1 factors
p; - (0;1)
SOLUTIONS 81 Laws:
x
a x × a y = a x+y
1 27.(3x+1) = ___
1
x
27 a x ÷ a y = a x−y
33.3x+1 = (3−3)x | Bring to the same base. (a x) y = a xy
33+x+1 = 3−3x | Use the laws of exponents. (a × b) x = a x × b x
4 + x = −3x | Drop the bases. a −x = __1
ax
4x = −4 __ __
x
√a x = a n
n
x = −1
a 0 = 1; a ≠ 0
2.1 y-intercept: x = 0 ∴ y = 40+1 = 4 ∴ P(0;4)
2.2 Substitute (a; 8) into y = 4x+1
8 = 4a+1 | Solve for a by writing each side to the same base.
3 2(x+1)
2 =2
3 = 2x + 2
x = __
1
2
2.3 g: −y = 4x+1 | For a reflection in the x-axis, (x;y) → (x;−y).
∴ g(x):y = −4x+1 and Q = (0;−4)
3.1 Substitute to (2;9) into y = ax: 9 = a2 ∴ a = 3
1
Substitute p;___ ( x
)
81 into y = 3 :
3p = ___
1 ∴ 3p = 3−4 ∴ p = −4
81
( )
x
3.2 g(x): y = 3−x ∴ y = __
1
3
3.3 h(x): y = −3 x
g y f
(2;4)
P(a;25) (0;1)
P (−4;a)
x
1
–3; (0;1)
125
x
g
2.3 f y
−2;−9
4
(0;1)
Calculator tips
WORKED EXAMPLES
Some calculators have the
Use the definition of a logarithm to convert logarithms to exponential form and feature logB A (the button
next to x −1).
exponents to logarithmic form.
1 Write these equations in exponential form and solve for x. If your calculator does not
have this feature, remember
1.1 logx 81 = 2 log A
1.2 log5 x = −2 that logBA = _____
log B
.
1.3 log2(x2 + 2x) = 3 This means that
log 8
2 Write the equations in logarithmic form and solve for x, correct to 2 decimal log3 8 = _____
log 3
= 1,89.
places where necessary. Note that log x = log10 x.
1.1 5x = 100
When the base is 10 you do
1.2 25 = 10(1,5)x not write it down.
1.3 2 × 3x−3 = 12 (This is similar to not writing
__ __
the 2 for √ x = √ 2
x or
SOLUTIONS the 1 for x = 1x.)
WORKED EXAMPLES
1 Draw the graph of f (x) = 2x and its inverse f −1(x) on the same set of axes.
2 Write down the inverse of f (x) in the form y = …
SOLUTIONS
y −4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3 4
___
1 __
1 __
1 __
1 0 2 4 8 16
x = 2y 16 8 4 2
: x = ( __
3)
∴ g− 1 1 y | Use the log definition.
∴ y = log__1 x
3
(9;2) y = log x
(0;1) 3
x
(1;0)
(4)
(x;y) → (y;x) and x
f (x) → f −1(x)
1.1 f(x) = 4x 1.2 f(x) = __
1
f(x) = ( __
2)
1.3 f(x) = 5x 1.4 1 x
WORKED EXAMPLE
( )
y
Use a table to plot the graphs of y = log2 x or x = 2 y and y = log __1 x or x = __
1 on
2 2
the same set of axes. The graphs are drawn on the next page.
SOLUTION
When using the table method to plot logarithmic graphs, it is easier to rewrite
the logarithmic equation in exponential form and choose the y values first.
y −4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 3 4
___
1 __
1 __
1 __
1
0 2 4 8 16
x = 2y 16 8 4 2
(2) __ __ __ ___
y 1 1 1 1
x = __
1 16 8 4 2 0
2 4 8 16
1
– ;4 (8;3) y = log 2 x
16
x
(1;0)
1 1
y = log −x
– ;– 4 (8;−3) 2
16
EXERCISE 4
1 Draw the graphs of f(x) and g(x) on the same set of axes. Show clearly the
intercepts with the axes and the coordinates of two points on each curve.
Write down the equation of the line about which f and g are symmetrical, if
there is one.
1.1 f(x) = log4 x and g(x) = log__1 x 1.2 f(x) = log3 x and g(x) = 3x
4
1.3 x
f(x) = 3 and g(x) = −3 x 1.4 f(x) = log2 x and g(x) = −log2 x
1.5 x
f(x) = 5 and g(x) = log __1 x
5
1.6 f(x) = log __1 x and g(x) = log__1 (−x), x < 0
3 3
WORKED EXAMPLES
SOLUTIONS
1 f : y = log3 x 2 f : y = log __1 x
−1 4
f : x = log3 y | Swap x and y. f −1: x = log __1 y | Swap x and y.
∴ y = 3x | Use log definition to 4
(4)
x
write in y form. ∴ y = __
1 | Use log definition to
write in y form.
y = log a x
(0;1) (x;y) (0;1)
x x
(1;0)
(1;0)
y = log−1 x
(x;y) a
EXERCISE 5
WORKED EXAMPLE y
y = log 1_ x
Use the graph alongside to answer the 2
following:
For which values of x is:
1 log2 x ≤ 3
S Q y =3
2 log__1 x ≤ −3
2
3 log2 x ≥ −3
x
4 log__1 x ≥ 3 P
2
T R y = –3
SOLUTIONS
At Q: log2 x = 3
∴ x = 23 = 8 y = log x
2
∴ log2 x ≤ 3 when 0 < x ≤ 8
At R: log __1 x = −3
2
1
∴ x = __ (2) −3
=8
∴ log__1 x ≤ −3 when x ≥ 8
2
At T: log2 x = −3
∴ x = 2−3 = __1
8
∴ log2 x ≥ −3 when x ≥ __
1
8
At S: log__1 x = 3
2
(2)
1 3 1
∴ x = __ = __
8
∴ log__1 x ≥ 3 when 0 < x ≤ __
1
2 8
EXERCISE 6
Draw the graphs of f(x) and g(x) on the same set of axes and use them to solve the
inequality.
1 f(x) = log3 x and g(x) = 2. Now solve log3 x ≤ 2
1 Solve for x:
1.1 log __1
2=x 8
(3) 1.2 logx 49 = 2 (3)
( )
x
3 The graphs of g(x) = __4
x and f(x) = __
1 2 1
4
are drawn alongside. a b y
3.1 The graphs are labelled a and b. Decide which is f and which is g. (2)
3.2 Write down the coordinates of P, the y-intercept of f. (1)
3.3 If Q(1;k) is the point of intersection of f and g, determine the value of k. (2)
3.4 For which values of x are the graphs of f and g both decreasing? (2) P
3.5 Write the equation of the inverse of g in the form y = … (2) Q(1;k)
x
3.6 Explain why the inverse of g is not a function. (2)
3.7 Write down two ways in which the domain of g could be restricted so
that g −1 is a function. (2)
3.8 Write down the equation of f −1 in the form y = … (2)
58
8 The graphs of f (x) = b x, b > 0, b ≠ 1 and g(x) = a(x − p) 2 + q are drawn. P and Q
are the points of intersection of the two graphs. Q(1;4) is also the turning point
of g(x) and P is the y-intercept of both graphs. y
8.1 Show that the coordinates of P are (0;1). (1) Q(1;4)
8.2 Find the values of a, b, p and q. (2)
8.3 Find the equation of f (−x) and describe the transformation that took
place from f (x). (2) P
8.4 Describe the transformation from f to h if h(x) = logb x. (2) f
x
8.5 Write down the range of f and g. (2)
8.6 For which values of x are the functions f and g both increasing? (2)
8.7 Explain why the inverse of g(x) is not a function. (2) g
8.8 Write down two ways in which the domain of g could be restricted so
that g −1 is a function. (2)
y
f
B(0;5)
A(1;3)
9 The graphs of f (x) = 3 x and g(x) = ax + p are drawn. A(1;3) is the points of
intersection of the two graphs. B(0;5) is the y intercept of g.
9.1 Find the values of a and p. (4)
x
9.2 Write down the range of f (x) + 1. (2)
g
9.3 Write the equation f −1(x), the inverse of f (x). (2)
9.4 For which values of x is:
9.4.1 f (x).g(x) < 0 (2)
9.4.2 f −1(x).g(x) ≤ 0? (2) y
f
59
EXERCISE 1
1 Determine the rate of depreciation (to one decimal place) for an item to become
a quarter of its original value after 9 years on:
1.1 the straight line method of depreciation
1.2 the reducing balance method.
2 Determine the length of time that it will take for an investment of R520 000 to
become R860 000 if the simple interest rate is 12% p.a. Give your answer correct
to two decimal places.
3 Tamryn will need R550 000 to buy a flat in 5 years’ time.
3.1 How much must she deposit now into an account offering 10% p.a.
compounded monthly to have the necessary funds in 5 years’ time?
3.2 What was the effective interest rate that Tamryn received each year (to two
decimal places)?
4 Shakir has R25 000 to invest over a period of 6 years. He is offered an interest
rate of 13% p.a. simple interest. What rate of interest, compounded annually,
should he be offered for the compound interest option to be better?
-
-
x This payment earns interest for (n – 1) time periods n–1
x (1 + i ) n – 2
x This payment earns interest for (n – 2) time periods x(1 + i) n – 3
x This payment earns interest for (n – 3) time periods x(1 + i)
2
Payments continue in this manner x x(1 + i)
x x(1 + i)
x This payment does
not earn interest as it
has only just been paid
Total future
value
accumulated
Remember these three important assumptions on which the derivation of the
annuity formula has been based:
• The first payment is made one time period from the present.
• The final payment is made at the time that the total accumulated is calculated
(that is, after n time periods).
• The regularity of compounding the interest is the same time period as the
regularity that the payments are made.
Use these assumptions as a ‘three-point check’ before applying the annuity formula in
any question.
To find the total future value accumulated, we must realise that the values to be added
form a geometric sequence (taking the terms from the last future value to the first):
x; x(1 + i); x(1 + i)2; … x(1 + i)n−3; x(1 + i)n−2; x(1 + i)n−1 where r = (1 + i).
= x [ ( 1 + i )n − 1
__________
i ] number pattern where each
successive term is obtained by
[
(1 + i − 1 )n
]
∴ F = x __________ where F = Total future value accumulated in an annuity situation
i
multiplying the previous term
by a constant value.
x = value of the regular fixed payment This value is called the
i = rate of interest constant ratio (r).
n = number of payments made
Consider the implications of having a payment at T0:
This payment would grow to x( 1 + i )n at Tn, which is the next term in the geometric
sequence mentioned earlier. You would calculate the sum of this sequence in the same
way, except that you will have one extra term. Thus, if you are given that the annuity
starts immediately, use the same future value annuity formula, but increase the value
of n by 1.
WORKED EXAMPLES
1 Suppose that Thandeka invests R500 every month for a period of 8 months,
starting one month from now. Her interest is 9% p.a. compounded monthly.
Calculate the value of her investment at the end of 8 months, after she has
made the 8th payment.
SOLUTION
[
( 1 + i )n − 1
F = x __________
i ]
where i = ____
9
100
0,09
per year = 0,09 per year = ____
12
per month
[ ( )
]
0,09 8
1 + ____ − 1
= 500 ______________
12
0,09 ____
12
= R4 106,59
2 Mr Klein opens a savings account for his son’s future education. On opening
the account he deposits R850, and then makes monthly payments of R850 at
the end of each month for a period of 10 years. The interest rate remains at Note:
12% p.a. compounded monthly. This question refers to the
amount of money that was
2.1 Calculate how much Mr Klein will have accumulated at the end of
gained overall due to interest
10 years.
received on the investment,
2.2 Calculate how much interest was earned. and not to the rate of interest.
[ ( 1 + ____ )
]
0,12 121
−1
2.1 [( 1 + i )n − 1
F = x __________
i ]
= 850 _______________
12
0,12 ____
n = (10 × 12) + 1
12 = 121
= R198 338,21
2.2 Interest earned = Future value received − payments made
= R 198 338,21 − (R850 × 121) = R95 488,21
3 On her 25th birthday, Sarah decides to accumulate R5 000 000 by her 50th
birthday. She plans to make equal monthly payments into an account
that pays 10% interest p.a. compounded monthly. If Sarah makes her first
payment a month after her 25th birthday and her last payment on her
50th birthday, determine how much she will need to deposit monthly to
accumulate R5 000 000 on her 50th birthday.
SOLUTION
[
( 1 + i )n − 1
F = x ___________
( 1+i ) ]
(
[ 12 )
]
0,1 300
1 + ___ − 1
5 000 000 = x ______________ n = (50 − 25) years
0,1
___
12 = 25 × 12 months
= 300 payments
0,1
∴ 5 000 000 × ___
12
0,1
= x 1 + ___
12 [( )
300
− 1 ]
0,1
5 000 000 × ___
∴ ________________
12
= x
[ ( 1 + ___
12 )
0,1 300
− 1 ]
∴ x = R3 768, 37 per month
SOLUTION
( )
i( m ) m
1 + ieff = 1 + ___
m
(
i( 12 )
∴ 1 + 0,1 = 1 + ____
12 )
12
___
∴ ( 12√ 1,1 − 1 ) × 12 = i( 12 )
∴ i( 12 ) ≈ 9,57 %
[ ( 1 + ______ )
]
0,0957 120
−1
[
( 1 + i )n − 1
F = x __________
i ]
= 1 000 _________________
12
0,0957
= R199 875,60
______
12
EXERCISE 2 REMEMBER
1 Calculate how much will be in a savings account after seven years if monthly Interest earned = Future value
payments of R1 000 are paid into the account, starting in one month’s time. received − payments made
Interest on the account is calculated at 12% p.a. compounded monthly.
2 Nusrah opens a saving account and deposits R5 000 every year, starting
immediately.
2.1 How much will she have accumulated after 8 years if interest is
compounded at 8,5% p.a.?
2.2 How much interest will Nusrah have earned after 8 years?
3 Tim plans to have R3 000 000 in his account when he turns 50 in 20 years’
time.
3.1 Calculate how much Tim must pay into the account each month,
starting in one month’s time if the interest is calculated at 9,5% p.a.
compounded monthly.
3.2 Calculate how much interest Tim earns over the 20-year period.
T0 T1 T2 T3 Tn – 2 Tn – 1 Tn
-
-
-
-
-
x(1 + i) – 2
–1
x Divide by one period of interest to find the
x(1 + i) – 3 x present value of this payment
x(1 + i) x
Payments continue
in this manner
– ( n – 2)
x(1 + i) – ( n – 1) Divide by (n – 2) periods of interest to find the present value of this payment x
x(1 + i) – n Divide by (n – 1) periods of interest to find the present value of this payment
x(1 + i) x
Divide by n periods of interest to find the present value of this payment x
Total present
value
available
a(r n − 1)
Sn = ________
r−1
where a = first term = x( 1 + i )−1 and r = ( 1 + i )−1
x( 1 + i )−1[ { ( 1 + i )−1 }n − 1 ]
∴ Total present value available = ______________________
( 1 + i )−1 − 1
x( 1 + i )−1[ ( 1 + i )−n − 1 ]
= ____________________
( 1 + i )−1 − 1
______
x [ ( 1 + i )−n − 1 ] (1 + i)
= __________________ × ______
(1 + i)
______
1
− 1
(1 + i)
(1 + i)
x[ ( 1 + i )−n − 1 ]
= _____________
1 − (1 + i)
x[ ( 1 + i )−n − 1 ]
= ______________
−i
[
1 − ( 1 + i )−n
= x ____________
i ]
[
1 − (1 + i
∴ P = x ____________
i
)−n
] P = Total present value available in an annuity situation
x = value of the regular fixed payment that will cover the
value of P and interest growth
i = rate of interest
n = number of payments made
It is important to remember that the formula derived above for P gives the value of
the loan one time-period before the first payment is made. If payments are started
immediately, consider this as a deposit which is subtracted from the amount owed.
The difference becomes the value of the loan.
SOLUTIONS
[ ( )
]
0,14 −36
1 − 1 + ____
[ i ]
1 − ( 1 + i )−n
P = x ____________ = 2 000 ________________
0,14
12
____
= R58 517,81
12
0,14
n = 3 years = 36 months and i = ____
14
100
per year = ____
12
per month
∴ i( 12 ) = 12 ( √(
12 0,15
1 + ____
4
4
− 1 ≈ 14,82% ) )
formula:
( )
i( m ) m
(
1 + ___ = 1 + ___
m )
i( n ) n
n
[ ]
−n
1 − (1 + i)
P = x ___________
i
[ ( )
]
0,1482 −240
1 − 1 + ______
640 000 = x _________________
12
0,1482
n = 20 years
______
12 = 20 × 12 months
= 240 monthly payments
0,1482
∴ 640 000 × ______
12
0,1482
= x 1 − 1 + ______
12 [ ( ) ]
−240
0,1482
640 000 × ______
∴ _________________
12
=x
(
0,1482 −240
______
1 − 1 + 12 )
∴ x = R8 342,46 per month
3 You should recognise these important aspects:
• James pays back the loan with regular payments of a fixed amount.
It is therefore an annuity situation.
• Since James receives the loan money now, it is a present value annuity.
• When you consider the three-point check, notice that both the payments
and the interest compounding are quarterly as expected. However, the first
payment should be made after one time period (that is, after one quarter,
which is in 3 months’ time as quarter years are every 3 months). Since
James made the first payment immediately, there is one more payment
than expected and you deduct that first payment from the loan.
x[ 1 − ( 1 + i )−n ]
3.1 P = _____________
i 10 years = 10 × 4 quarters
( )
= 40 quarters
62 500 − x = x
0,12
1 − 1 + ____
4
−40
( )
[ ]
0,12 −40
1 − 1 + ____ i = ____
12
= 0,12 per quarter
62 500 = x ________________ + 1
4 100
0,12
____ 0,12
4 = ____ per quarter
4
x = R2 591,77
1 Mrs Ndlovu takes out a mortgage bond of R980 000 on a property at a rate of
14% p.a. compounded monthly over 25 years. Calculate the monthly payments
required to settle the bond if Mrs Ndlovu makes the first payment in one
month’s time.
2 Determine the loan that Kaleb will receive if he plans to pay R1 200 per month
for a period of 10 years to amortise the loan. He makes his first payment in one
month’s time and interest on the loan is 8,5% p.a. compounded monthly.
3 Mr Taylor takes out a mortgage bond of R1 800 000 to help pay for his house.
The bond is repayable in equal monthly instalments over 20 years at a rate of
12,5% p.a. compounded monthly.
REMEMBER 3.1 Calculate Mr Taylor’s monthly payments if he starts his payments in
one months’ time.
Interest paid = payments
3.2 Determine how much interest Mr Taylor will pay altogether.
made − loan received
4 Laeeqa takes out a loan to buy a car. She pays R2 250 every six months towards
her loan for the next 4 full years, starting immediately (that is, 9 payments).
How much can she borrow if the interest charged is 12% p.a. compounded
half-yearly?
5 Abraham buys a car for R163 500. He pays a 10% deposit and settles the rest of
his debt with quarterly payments over 5 years, starting in three month’s time.
5.1 Calculate the value of his quarterly payments if interest on the loan is
charged at a rate of 13% p.a. compounded quarterly.
5.2 Calculate how much interest Abraham pays on his loan.
6 Alison borrows R120 000 to pay for renovations to her house. She pays monthly
instalments over 4 years to amortise the loan, starting in one months’ time.
Interest on the loan is compounded at 12% p.a. effective.
REMEMBER 6.1 Determine the interest rate compounded monthly that would be
(
i( m )
1 + ieff = 1 + ___ )
m equivalent to a compound interest rate of 12% p.a.
m
6.2 Calculate the monthly payment required to settle the loan.
7 A car dealership sells Mr Matabane a car on these conditions:
He will pay a 15% deposit and monthly payments of R800 for a period of 6 years,
starting in one month’s time. Interest on the loan will be charged at 10% p.a.
compounded half-yearly.
REMEMBER 7.1 Show that the equivalent monthly interest rate on the loan is 9,8%
( 1 + i___
m ) ( )
m n
(m)
i( n )
= 1 + ___ (to 1 decimal place).
n
7.2 Determine the value of the loan.
7.3 Calculate the original cash price of the car.
7.4 Calculate how much Mr Matabane will pay in total for his car.
7.5 Calculate how much interest Mr Matabane will pay if he agrees to
this plan.
Sinking funds
KEY WORDS
Companies often purchase expensive equipment they will use for a specified time.
They then sell the old equipment at scrap value and purchase a new replacement scrap value – the depreciated
item. To have the money available to purchase new equipment, the company usually value of an item once it has
reached the end of its useful
plans ahead and sets up a fund (called a sinking fund). They make regular payments
life
into the sinking fund to save for the lump sum required to replace the equipment
when it reaches the end of its useful life. The company uses the scrap value of the old
equipment and the money available in the sinking fund to purchase the replacement
item.
Remember these three important aspects of a sinking fund situation:
REMEMBER
• Since this sinking fund involves a regular fixed payment providing money for
[ ]
n
(1 + i) − 1
the future, it is a future value annuity. To determine the amount available in the F = x __________
i
➀
account, you can apply the future value annuity formula. (See Remember 1.) F = P(1 − i)n ➁
• To determine the scrap value of the old piece of equipment, use the formula for
compound decay. (See Remember 2.) F = P(1 + i)n ➂
• To determine the expected cost of the replacement item, use the formula for
compound growth. (See Remember 3.)
WORKED EXAMPLE
1 F = P( 1 + i )n
= 270 000( 1 + 0,16 )5
= R567 092,25
2 F = P( 1 − i )n
100 000 = 270 000( 1 − i )5
______
√
5 _______
100 000
270 000
= 1 − i
______
∴ i = 1 − √_______
5100 000
270 000
= 18,02% p.a.
3 The amount required = Cost of new machine − scrap value obtained for old
machine
= R567 092,25 − R100 000
= R467 092,25
4 [
( 1 + i )n − 1
F = x ___________
i ]
[ ( 1 + ___ )
]
0,1 60
− 1
467 092,25 = x ______________
12
0,1 ___
12
0,1
467 092,25 × ___
_______________
12
= x ∴ x = R6 031,89
( 1 + ___
12 )
0,1 60
− 1
EXERCISE 4
1 A company buys a machine for R370 000. They expect the cost of a new machine
to rise by 14% p.a., while the rate of depreciation is 16% p.a. on the reducing-
KEY WORDS balance. The life span of the machine is 8 years.
1.1 Calculate the scrap value of the old machine.
book value – the depreciated 1.2 Calculate the cost of a new machine in 8 years’ time.
value of a vehicle at a point
1.3 Calculate the value of the sinking fund required to purchase a new
in time
machine in 8 years’ time if the proceeds from the sale of the old machine
(at scrap value) will be used as part of the payment of the new machine.
1.4 The company sets up a sinking fund to pay for a new machine. They make
their payments into a savings account that pays 7% p.a. compounded
monthly. Calculate the monthly payments if they start payments one
month after they purchase the present machine and continue paying until
the end of the 8-year period.
2 A school buys a new bus for R450 000. The governing body decides that they will
replace the bus in 10 years’ time.
2.1 Use the reducing-balance method to calculate the annual depreciation rate
if the expected book value of the bus in 10 years’ time is R125 325,44.
2.2 Determine the rate of inflation if the estimated cost of the replacement
bus in 10 years’ time is R971 516,25.
2.3 Calculate the future value required in a sinking fund to pay for the
replacement bus in 10 years’ time. Assume that the current bus will be
traded in for the replacement.
WORKED EXAMPLES
SOLUTION
[ ( 1 + ____ )
]
0,09 360
− 1
[
( 1 + i )n − 1
F = x ___________
i ]
= 1 500 _______________
12
0,09 ____
n = 30 × 12 = 360
12
To determine the amount accumulated after a further 2 years of compound
growth, consider the situation on a time line:
2 years of
30 years of monthly payments compound
growth
T0 T1 T2 T3 T360 T384
-
-
-
1 500
1 500
1 500
Therefore:
F1 F2
F = P( 1 + i )n 1 500
( [( ) ]
)(
0,09 360
1500 1 + ____ − 1
= _____________________
12
0,09
____
0,09
1 + ____
12 )24
F 1 of annuity
becomes P of
12
compound
= R3 285 489,41 growth calculation
SOLUTION
You should recognise that there are two annuity calculations involved. The first
annuity stops before the total future value is calculated, which means that it will
continue to grow with compound interest for the remaining time period. It is
easiest to understand this on a time-line:
-
-
R1 000 36
F1 F 1 1 + 0,1
R1 000 12
R2 500
F2
R2 500
[ ( 1 + ___ )
] [ ( 1 + ___ )
]
0,1 37 0,1 36
−1 −1
F1 = 1 000 _____________ and F2 = 2 500 _____________
12 12
0,1 ___ 0,1 ___
12 12
[ ( 1 + ___ )
] [ ( 1 + ___ )
]
0,1 37 0,1 36
− 1 − 1
∴ Total future value = 1 000 ______________
12
0,1
0,1
1 + ___
12 ___
( )
36
+ 2 500 _____________
12
0,1 ___
12 12
= R162 601,64
EXERCISE 5
T 0 T1 T 2 T3 Tk Tn
-
-
-
L L(1 + i)
k
x
x k
x F = x (1 + i) – 1
i
x
The loan debt grows with compound interest. You can determine the total of the
payments made (including the interest growth on those payments) using the future
value annuity formula.
[
( 1 + i )k − 1
∴ Balance outstanding = L( 1 + i )k − x ___________
i ]
L = loan
k = number of payments
made
x = value of payments
The second method is a simpler calculation based on the understanding that the
balance outstanding is the value of the debt at a particular time. This means that the
loan value will be fully paid back by the remainder of the payments left to pay. So,
if there were n payments to amortise the loan originally, after k payments have been
paid, the remainder of the loan (balance outstanding) will be amortised after (n − k)
payments. As the variable P in the present value annuity formula signifies the value of
the loan debt, use the present value annuity formula to find the balance outstanding.
T0 Tk Tk + 1 Tn
-
-
x x x
x
B.O. at Tk x
(amount
still owing) x
WORKED EXAMPLE
Nigel takes out a loan of R3 000 000 from the bank to start his own business. The
loan will be amortised after 15 years and the monthly repayments will start one
month after the loan is granted. The interest rate is 9% p.a. compounded monthly.
Determine:
1 the value of the monthly payments (to the nearest Rand)
2 the balance of the loan at the end of 5 years.
SOLUTION
[ ( )
]
0,09 −180
1 − 1 + ____ Note: The reason for
3 000 000 = x ________________
12
1 0,09 the slight difference in
____
12 the answers is due to
[ ( )
]
0,09 −180 rounding off the monthly
1 − 1 + ____
∴ x = 3 000 000 ÷ ________________ payment
12
0,09
= R30 428
____
12
[ ( 1 + ____ )
]
0,09 60
−1
( 0,09
= 3 000 000 1 + ____
12 )60
− 30 428 ______________
12
0,09
= R2 402 037,44
____
12
[ ( )
]
0,09 −( 180−60 )
1 − 1 + ____
or B.O. = 30 428 ___________________
12
0,09
= R2 402 037,83
____
12
1 Martha takes out a loan of R250 000 to finance a car. She repays the loan over
a period of 6 years, starting one month after she bought the car. The interest
charged is 9% p.a. compounded monthly.
1.1 Determine her monthly payments to repay the loan over the required
period.
1.2 If she sells the car after 3 years, calculate how much money she owes on
the loan.
2 Mr Sebeko retired on 31 December 2005. He has a guaranteed pension of
R10 325 paid monthly for a period of 15 years. If he dies before he has received
15 years of pension, his beneficiaries will receive the balance outstanding.
If Mr Sebeko dies on 31 December 2012, calculate the amount that the
beneficiaries receive if the interest was 8,5% p.a. compounded monthly.
3 Stefan takes out a five-year loan of R900 000 that he can repay by monthly
payments of R18 248,75 at an interest rate of 8% per annum compounded
monthly. Stefan decides to pay monthly amounts of R20 000, starting in one
month’s time. Calculate his balance outstanding after the 30th payment.
L L(1 + i)
k–1
loan. Therefore if payments
x start at Tk, the loan grows
x in interest for (k − 1)
x
time periods.
x
WORKED EXAMPLE
Clifford borrows R500 000 to buy furniture for his new flat. The loan is to be
repaid by monthly payments, and amortised at the end of five years from now.
Clifford will make the first payment after 3 months, and the interest charged is
10% p.a. compounded monthly. Calculate the amount of money that he will pay
each month.
SOLUTION
As payments start after 3 months instead of after 1 month, Clifford has missed the
first 2 payments. This means that there will be (5 × 12) − 2 payments, and the
loan will grow by 2 months of compound interest before the repayments start.
[ ( )
]
0,1 −58
1 − 1 + ___
( 0,1 2
∴ x = 50 000 1 + ___
12 )
÷ _______________
0,1
12
= R1 108,89
___
12
EXERCISE 7
1 How much can be borrowed from a bank if the borrower repays the loan by
means of 48 equal monthly payments of R1 000, starting six months from now,
if interest is 10,5% p.a. compounded monthly?
2 Jacob saves for a deposit on a house. He estimates that he will need R350 000 in
REMEMBER five years’ time. He plans to make monthly payments into a savings account that
When payments start late, earns 9% interest per annum compounded semi-annually.
multiply the number of years 2.1 Show that i(12) ≈ 8,8% (to 1 decimal place).
by the number of payments 2.2 Calculate his monthly payments if he makes his first payment in
per year, and then subtract 6 months’ time.
the number of missed 2.3 Calculate how much Jacob will have in his account after 3 years from now.
payments to determine n. 2.4 If Jacob stops his payments after 3 years from now and makes no further
payments, calculate by how much he will be short of the required
R350 000 in 5 years’ time.
3 A loan of R200 000 will be amortised in 2 years. Monthly payments are made,
starting five months from now, in order to repay the loan. What is the value of
each payment if interest is 9,6% p.a. compounded monthly?
4 Susan and Pieter both plan trips around Europe in 12 months’ time. They both
REMEMBER save money for their holidays by opening savings accounts. Susan deposits
R500 immediately and continues to do so monthly until the end of the
When payments on a loan
start late, the loan increases 12 months. Pieter pays monthly amounts of R600 into his savings account, but
with compound interest for starts after 3 months have passed. If both Susan and Pieter have accounts with
the same number of time interest of 10% p.a. compounded monthly, who will have saved the most at the
periods as the number of end of 12 months, and by how much?
missed payments. 5 The bank granted Thebogo a loan of R3 500 000 to start a business. The bank
required him to amortise his loan 12 years after the loan was granted, and
agreed that he could start his monthly payments after 12 months had passed.
Interest on the loan was 9% p.a. compounded monthly. Determine the value of
Thebogo’s monthly payments.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
How long will it take an amount of money to halve in value when it is depreciated
at 12% p.a. on the reducing-balance?
SOLUTION
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
Gail saves money to buy a new computer. Calculate how long it will take her to
accumulate R10 000 if she deposits R300 each month into a savings account that
gives interest at 10,5% p.a. compounded monthly. Her payments will commence
in one month’s time.
SOLUTION
Note: It is important to recognise that the time period for the value of n will be the
same as that of the interest compounding. So in this case, the answer that we
obtain for n will be the number of months that must pass. If we want an answer in
years, divide by 12.
[ ( 1 + _____ )
]
0,105 n
−1
[
( 1 + i )n − 1
F = x __________
i ]
∴ 10 000 = 300 ______________
12
0,105 _____
12
( ) ( )
0,105 0,105 n
∴ ______ × _____ + 1 = 1 + _____
10 000
300 12 12
___
31
(
807 n
____
∴ 24 = 800 )
∴ n = log( ____ ___
31
800 ) 24
807 ( )
≈ 29,38 months (or 2,45 years)
Rafael buys a car that costs R280 000. He pays a 10% deposit and takes a loan at an
interest rate of 11% p.a. compounded monthly for the balance. He agrees to pay
R8 000 at the end of each month, starting in one month’s time.
1 Calculate the value of Rafael’s loan.
2 How many payments of R8 000 will he have to make?
3 If Raphael clears his debt with one final payment one month after his last
payment of R8 000, calculate the value of his final payment.
SOLUTIONS
[ ( )
]
0,11 −n
1 − 1 + ____
2 P=x [
1 − ( 1 + i )−n
___________
i ]
∴ 252 000 = 8 000 ______________
0,11
____
12
12
( ) ( )
0,11 0,11 −n
∴ _______ × ____ − 1 = − 1 + ____
252 000
8 000 12 12
= ( 1 + ____
12 )
−n
∴ ____
569
800
0,11
∴ log( _____ ____
569
1 200 ) 800
1 211 =−n ( )
∴ − n ≈ − 37,34 ∴ n ≈ 37,34 months (or 3,11 years)
So he will make 37 monthly payments of R8 000.
3
T0 T1 T37 T38
-
-
-
Loan
P1 8 000
8 000
P2 y
If the payments of R8 000 had fully covered the loan, then the loan value
would equal the value of P1. If that were the case, then:
[ ( )
]
0,11 −37
1 − 1 + ____
Loan = P1 = 8 000 _______________
12
0,11 ____
12
But an extra payment, y is required to fully cover the loan. Whenever you
want to create an equation with regard to money transactions, ensure that
the values being equated are at the same moment in time. Therefore, add the
0,11 −38
present value of the final payment, that is, y 1 + ____ ( 12 )
[ ( )
]
0,11 −37
1 − 1 + ____
252 000 = 8 000 _______________
0,11
____
12
+ (
y 1 + ____
12
0,11
)−38
12
( [ ( )
])
0,11 −37
1 − 1 + ____
∴ y = 252 000 − 8 000 _______________
0,11
12
____
( 1 + ____
12 )
0,11 38
= R2 734,55
12
Note: We found in worked example 3, question 2 that 37,34 payments were
required. The value of this last payment is more than 0,34 × 8 000 because there
was interest during the last month before the final payment is made.
Greg borrows R1 000 000 from a bank. He plans to pay R9 000 per month on the
loan. Interest is 12% per annum compounded monthly. Decide whether the bank
will grant him the loan. Explain your answer.
SOLUTION
If we try to determine how long it would take to repay the loan under these
conditions we discover: REMEMBER
[ ( )
]
0,12 −n
1 − 1 + ____
( ) ( )
0,12 0,12 −n
1 000 000 = 9 000 ______________ ∴ _________ × ____ − 1 = − 1 + ____
1 000 000
12 loga b is only defined for
0,12
____ 9 000 12 12
12 a > 0; a ≠ 1 and b > 0
EXERCISE 8
1 Vusi invests R1 000 at an interest rate of 10% p.a. compound interest. Calculate
how many years it will take for this investment to be worth R1 610,51.
2 A new car costs R375 000. Calculate how long it will take to reach a scrap value of
R176 344,70 if the rate of depreciation on the reducing balance method is 9% p.a.
3 Sydney borrows R300 000 at 10% p.a. compounded monthly. He pays back
R1 000 per month for the first year, starting in one month’s time, and R5 000
per month for the remaining time until he has repaid the loan in full (including
interest).
Determine:
3.1 the balance outstanding at the end of the first year
3.2 how many payments of R5 000 Sydney must pay
3.3 the value of his final payment
3.4 whether the bank would have allowed him to continue paying R1 000 on
an on-going basis.
Investments
Compound interest results in exponential growth whereas simple interest results in
linear growth. It will almost always be advantageous to choose a compound interest
investment, unless the simple interest offered is much higher than the compound
interest and the investment is short term. Also, because of the affect of exponential
growth, the more frequently the interest is compounded, the better for the investor.
WORKED EXAMPLE
Alice, Ben and Fatima each win R500 000 in a competition. Alice invests her
money in an investment offering 20% p.a. simple interest. Ben invests his money
at 10% p.a. compound interest and Fatima invests her money at 9,8% p.a.
compounded daily. Determine how much money each person has after 15 years.
Then decide who made the best choice.
SOLUTION
( 0,098
Fatima: F = 500 000 1 + _____
365 ) 5 475
= R2 174 188,55
Fatima has the most money after 20 years, although she had the lowest interest
rate. However, the difference is not great, so the choice will depend on the length
of the investment.
KEY WORD
Retirement annuities
When you save for retirement, a retirement annuity is a good option. The longer an
retirement annuity – a future
investor pays into such an annuity without withdrawing from the investment, the
value annuity where regular
payments are invested into an better. Some people prefer to invest their money in the stock exchange; here you can
account to save for retirement buy partial ownership in a company and benefit from the profits of that company.
A stock exchange investment can be risky since it relies on the performance of the
company in which you have chosen to invest. A less risky way of investing in the
stock exchange is to buy units in a unit trust. A unit trust is the pooled money of
many investors that is invested in the financial markets through a single collective
investment scheme. An investor can choose to buy units as a once-off investment or
can put aside monthly amounts into a unit trust. Unlike an annuity, however, there
is no guarantee on the rate of return you will have on your investment. If the market
hits a low or crashes, then your investment will suffer; but if you can leave your
money in the trust until the market has stabilised, you can sometimes do well in this
kind of investment. Generally, the longer your money can stay invested, the more
likely you are to have a good investment return.
Kamil and Ismail are twins. On their 30th birthday they decide to save for their
retirement. Kamil invests R1 000 each month into a retirement annuity that gives
him 10% p.a. compounded quarterly. Kamil’s first payment starts one month after
his birthday. Ismail invests R1 000 each month into a unit trust.
1 They both consider retiring on their 60th birthdays, and investigate the
amount their investments have yielded. Since the world money market is at
a low at that time, Ismail’s investment is worth only R1 500 000. Determine
the value of Kamil’s investment on his 60th birthday after he has made his
monthly payment for that month. Compare Kamil’s investment with Ismail’s
investment at that stage.
2 The twins both decide to work for a further 5 years. On his 65th birthday
Ismail receives a payment of R3 500 000 from his unit trust investment.
Determine whether he will be better off than Kamil, who has continued
paying into his annuity for a further 5 years.
SOLUTION
[ ( 1 + _____ )
]
0,092 360
−1
F = 1 000 _______________
12
1 0,092 _____
12
= R1 908 835,09
∴ R408 835,09 more than Ismail
( 1 + ____
12 )
12
( 0,1
) 4
( 12 )
= 1 + ___
i
4
∴ i( 12 ) ≈ 9,92%
[ ( 1 + _____ )
]
0,092 420
−1
F = 1 000 _______________
12
0,092 _____
12
= R3 094 257,30
∴ R405 742,70 less than Ismail
Pyramid schemes
A pyramid scheme is a risky way of trying to make money quickly. There are various
forms of pyramid schemes, and some have variations to hide their true nature. These
schemes promise money to people who choose to participate by enrolling other
people into the scheme, rather than supplying real investment themselves. The
schemes are not sustainable, and are illegal in many countries, including South Africa.
The idea behind this money-making formula is that a person starts a ‘business’ by
recruiting people to make a payment and to then recruit other people. This continues
until there is a pyramid of people. Each new recruit makes a payment to the person at
the top of the list, and continues the pyramid by recruiting further people. There is
seldom any sale of real products involved, or services. Often these scams are made to
look more creditable by including false testimonials. Only the original ‘investor’ and a
“Captain”
(paid by new passengers)
“Co-pilot”
“Crew”
“Passengers”
(pay the “captain”
when they join the
scheme)
WORKED EXAMPLE
Mr X starts an ‘aeroplane game’. He sets up the first three levels using false names,
and sends an e-mail to enlist recruits. Each new recruit will become a ‘passenger’
by paying R1 000 to the captain (Mr X).
1 How much money will Mr X make by the time that the first real investors
become ‘captains’, assuming that he receives all the money paid to the false
names that he made up?
2 How many further new recruits will he need for the first round of ‘passengers’
to receive R8 000 from their ‘passengers’ once they have become ‘captains’?
A B
C D E F
G H I J K L M N
Figure 2
Figure 3 shows how Mr X will receive another R32 000 when the false names
C, D, E and F become ‘pilots’.
He will therefore receive R56 000 in total without pay in any money himself.
C D E F
G H I J K L M N
Figure 3
2 G to N are the first paying recruits. They must each recruit two new members
as shown in Figure 2 (there are 16 recruits in total). Figure 3 shows how
32 further recruits would be necessary for G to N to become ‘co-pilots’.
Each new recruit would need to recruit a further two recruits (thus 64 more
REMEMBER
recruits) for G to N to become ‘pilots’. So there would need to be 112 recruits
in total. A hire purchase agreement
is a loan agreement made
with a company, that allows
the buyer to take the item
Loan options purchased on loan, often
after paying a deposit. The
In a loan situation, instead of benefitting from the interest, the borrower pays the
buyer pays the remainder
interest. It is always important as a borrower to choose an option where the interest
of the cash price in monthly
paid is minimised. These points should be taken into account: instalments over time. Simple
• In a simple interest loan agreement, interest is calculated on the original debt, interest is calculated and
whereas in compound interest the interest is calculated on the reducing balance, added to the cash price, and
which benefits the borrower. the total debt owed is divided
between the number of
• The more frequently the interest is compounded, the more the borrower will
benefit from the balancing reducing. payments.
WORKED EXAMPLE
Len takes out a loan of R300 000 at an interest rate of 11% p.a. compounded
monthly. He must amortise the loan within 5 years with equal monthly payments
starting in one month’s time. Len calculates his monthly payments to be
R6 522,73 if he pays the loan over 5 years.
1 Determine how much interest Len would pay under this agreement.
2 Len decides to pay R7 000 per month. Determine how many payments of
R7 000 he must pay.
3 Determine the value of Len’s final payment.
4 Calculate how much Len will save in terms of interest paid by paying
R7 000 instead of R6 522,73.
SOLUTION
[ ( )
]
0,11 −n
1 − 1 + ____
300 000 = 7 000 ______________
12
2 0,11 ____
12
( )
−n
∴ ___ = _____
17 1 211
28 1 200
∴ −n = log( _____
1 200 ) 28
1 211 ( )
___
17
[ ( )
]
0,11 −54
1 − 1 + ____
3 300 000 = 7 000 _______________
0,11
12 0,11
+ y 1 + ____
____ 12 ( )−55
12
( [ ( )
]) (
0,11 −54
1 − 1 + ____
∴ y = 300 000 − 7 000 _______________
0,11
12
____
0,11
1 + ____
12 )
55
12
= R4 798,51
1 Keith takes out a retirement annuity on his 35th birthday for R1 500 per month.
He makes his first payment immediately on his 35th birthday. Interest on the
annuity is 10,2% p.a. compounded quarterly. On Keith’s 35th birthday, his
friend, Barry, invests R80 000 as a once-off payment into a unit trust for his
own retirement.
1.1 Determine the monthly interest rate that is equivalent to 10,2% p.a.
compounded quarterly.
1.2 Determine how much Keith will have saved by his 50th birthday just after
he has made his payment.
1.3 On his 50th birthday Keith increases his payments to R2 500 from the
following month. Calculate how much he will be paid out from the
annuity when he retires on his 65th birthday.
1.4 At the end of the 15-year period Barry averages 14% p.a. compound
interest on his investment. Determine how much Barry receives at the end
of 30 years. Compare his final value with Keith’s final value.
2 Nina bought an apartment for R1 400 000. She was offered these options:
Option 1: Pay a 15% deposit and have a mortgage bond over a 20-year period for
the balance at an interest rate of 9,5% p.a. compounded monthly.
Option 2: Take out a mortgage bond for the full amount at an interest rate
of 9,5% compounded monthly over a 15 year period.
In both options payments will commence in one month’s time.
2.1 Determine Nina’s monthly payment for each option.
2.2 Determine the interest Nina pays in each option.
2.3 Which option is better for Nina?
1 Calculate how long it would take for an investment to triple in 5 years if the
interest rate is:
1.1 10% p.a. simple interest (3)
1.2 10% p.a. compound interest. (4)
3 Mpho invests R12 000 now. Determine the annual rate of interest,
compounded quarterly, that yields the same amount in 5 years’ time as
investing R12 000 at 15% simple interest per year. (6)
5 Mr Dumani pays R550 000 for a minibus taxi in June 2013. He plans to
replace it in June 2020. He estimates that the cost of a new minibus will
escalate at a of rate 9% compound interest each year.
5.1 Calculate what Mr Dumani expects to pay to replace his minibus
in 2020. (3)
5.2 In 2020 he hopes to sell his present minibus for its depreciated value
at that time, and to use the money to partly finance his new minibus.
He estimates the rate of depreciation as 14% p.a. on the reducing
balance. Calculate the book value of his present minibus when he
sells it. (3)
5.3 Mr Dumani sets up a sinking fund to finance his new minibus in
2020. Determine the amount that he needs to save in the sinking fund. (2)
5.4 He makes equal monthly payments into the sinking fund on the first
day of each month, starting in one month’s time (1 July 2013).
He makes the last payment into the account on 1 June 2020. The
bank pays interest at a rate of 8% p.a. compounded monthly.
Determine the value of the monthly payment that Mr Dumani must
make to save what he needs by 1 June 2020. (6)
6 A loan of R50 000 is amortised over a period of 5 years. Payments are made
monthly starting six months after the loan is granted. The interest rate is
10,5% p.a. compounded monthly.
6.1 Calculate the monthly repayments. (6)
6.2 Determine the balance outstanding after 2 years. (6)
88
11 Bushrah and Philip plan to renovate their house. They take out a loan of
R55 000 immediately and a second loan of R78 000 two years later. They
plan to repay the loan in three equal instalments. The first payment must
be made after 4 years, the second instalment must follow 3 years later and
the final payment at the end of 10 years. The interest is 10,5% p.a. for
the first 3 years, 10% p.a. compounded quarterly for the next 6 years and
9% compounded half-yearly for the last year. Calculate the value of each
instalment. (10)
89
180° – θ θ
Reduction formulae:
y
Quadrant 2 Quadrant 3 Quadrant 4
x
x x sin (180° − θ) = sin θ sin (180° + θ) = −sin θ sin (360° − θ) = sin (− θ) = −sin θ
–y cos (180° − θ) = −cos θ cos (180° + θ) = −cos θ cos (360° − θ) = cos (− θ) = cos θ
180° + θ 360° – θ
tan (180° − θ) = −tan θ tan (180° + θ) = tan θ tan (360° − θ) = tan (− θ) = −tan θ
4
y
y y
1-
1- 5-
4-
3-
2-
1-
0- x
-
90° + θ
Co-ratios θ θ
cos(90° − θ) = __ sin(90° − θ) = __
c b
a = sin θ a = cos θ a b
θ x
cos(90° + θ) = −sin θ sin(90° + θ) = cos θ
90° – θ
Identities c
sin θ 1 cos θ
tan θ = _____ _____ _____
cos θ or tan θ = sin θ
sin2 θ + cos2 θ = 1 or sin2 θ = 1 − cos2 θ or cos2 θ = 1 − sin2 θ
EXERCISE 1
You have now proved the first of the compound angle formulae.
WORKED EXAMPLE
SOLUTION
Let α = 90°:
cos(90° − β) = cos 90° cos β + sin 90° sin β
cos(90° − β) = (0) cos β + (1) sin β
cos(90° − β) = sin β
Co-ratios:
Derivation of sin(α + β) = sin α cos β + cos α sin β:
sin(90° − θ) = cos θ
sin(α + β) = cos(90° − (α + β))
cos(90° − θ) = sin θ
sin(α + β) = cos((90° − α) − β) sin(90° + θ) = cos θ
sin(α + β) = cos(90° − α)cos β + sin(90° − α) sin β cos(90° + θ) = −sin θ
Numerical example:
but cos(90° − α) = sin α and sin(90° − α) = cos α sin 70° = cos 20°
∴ sin(α + β) = sin α cos β + cos α sin β cos 30° = sin 60°
SOLUTIONS
2 2 cos 50°
2 cos 140° − sin 130° sin 220°
1 = cos 50°(−cos 40°)
1 − sin 50°(−sin 40°)
= −cos 50° cos 40° + sin 50° sin 40°
= −(cos 50° cos 40° − sin 50° sin 40°)
30° 45°
= −cos(50° + 40°) = −cos(90°) = 0
3 1
3 cos 3A cos A + sin 3A sin A
= cos(3A − A)
= cos 2A
0° 45°
2
4 sin( A + B ).sin(A − B)
1 1
= (sin A cos B + cos A sin B)(sin A cos B − cos A sin B) | Difference of two
squares
45° 2 2 2
= sin A cos B − cos A sin B 2 | cos x = 1 − sin2 x
2
2 2 2
= sin A(1 − sin B) − (1 − sin A)sin B 2
1
Special angle triangles = sin2 A − sin2 A sin2 B − sin2 B + sin2 A sin2 B
= sin2 A − sin2 B
WORKED EXAMPLES
= 2 sin 5A cos 5A
= 1 − 2 sin2 4A y
or
cos 2A = cos2 A − sin2 A
−5 2
( 13 ) ( 13 )
= ___ − ____
−12 2
1 Use the double angle identities to write each ratio or expression in terms of the
angle and ratio in the bracket.
1.1 sin 4A (2A) 1.2 cos 12A (6A)
1.3 cos 6A (3A) 1.4 cos 8A (cos 4A)
1.5 sin 4A (sin A) 1.6 cos 10A (sin 5A)
1.7 __
1 __
1
2 sin 2 x.cos 2 x sin(x) 1.8 2 cos2 __
B
2 ( )
− 1 (B)
1.9 4 sin 3A.cos 3A (6A) 1.10 sin x.cos x (2x)
2 Write each expression as a single angle and evaluate if possible.
2.1 2 sin 30°.cos 30° 2.2 cos2 45° − sin2 45°
2.3 2
1 − 2 sin 30° 2.4 2 sin 22,5°.cos 22,5°
2.5 2 sin 150°.sin 300° 2.6 2 cos2 15° − 1
4 − 8 sin2 15
___________
2.7 4 2.8 4 sin 75°.cos 75°
3 Simplify each expression as a single trigonometric ratio in x or 2x.
3.1 (cos2 x − sin2 x)(cos2 x + sin2 x) 3.2 cos4 x − sin4 x
2 sin x. cos x
___________
3.3 (cos x + sin x)2 − 1 3.4
2 cos2 x − 1
3.5 sin 2x. tan x + sin2 x 3.6 cos 2x + sin2 x
3.7 2 2
(1 − tan x)(1 − sin x) 3.8 __
1
(1 − cos 2x)
2
4 If sin 20° = a, find these expressions in terms of a. [Hint: Draw a diagram.]
4.1 sin 160°
4.2 cos 70°
4.3 tan 200°
4.4 sin 40° [Hint: Use double angles.]
4.5 4 sin 10°.cos 10°
4.6 1 − 2 sin2 35°
4.7 sin 80° [Hint: Use a special angle.]
4.8 cos 50°
5 Use compound and double angles to prove that:
5.1 sin 3x = 3 sin x − 4 sin3 x
5.2 cos 3x = cos x (1 − 4 sin2 x)
5.3 cos 4x = 8 cos4 x − 8 cos2 x +1
5.4 1 − cos 4x = 2 sin2 2x
5.5 sin 4x = cos x(4 sin x − 8 sin3 )
5.6 sin 4x = 4 sin x cos3 x − 4 cos x sin3 x
6 Prove that:
6.1 ______
sin 3x ______
cos 3x
− cos x = 2
sin x
______
cos 3x ______ (cos x + sin x)(cos x − sin x)
sin 3x _______________________
6.2 sin x
+ cos x= sin x cos x
tan α − tan β
Derivation of tan(α − β) = _____________
1 + tan α tan β
sin(α − β)
tan(α − β) = __________
cos(α − β)
1
___________
sin α cos β − cos α sin β ___________
______________________ cos α cos β
= ×
cos α cos β + sin α sin β ___________
1
cos α cos β
sin α cos β
___________ cos α sin β
− __________
cos α cos β cos α cos β
________________________
=
cos α cos β sin α sin β
___________ + ___________
cos α cos β cos α cos β
tan α − tan β
= ______________
1 + tan α tan β
2 tan α
Derivation of tan 2α = _________
2 1 − tan α
tan 2α = tan(α + α)
tan α + tan α
= ______________
1 − tan α tan α
2 tan α
= __________
1 − tan2 α
1 Use the formula for tan(α − β) to find the value of tan 165°.
2 If cos x = k, find tan 2x in terms of k.
SOLUTIONS
(
= − ____________________________
sin 45° cos 30° − cos 45° sin 30°
) (
= − ________________
tan 45° − tan 30°
)
( ) ( )
cos 45° cos 30° + sin 45° sin 30° 1 + tan 45° tan 30°
__
___ .
√3
1__ ___
− ___
1__ __
.1 __ 1 − ___
1__
√3
__
√3
__________ ___
√2 2 √2 2 2√__
2
= − _____________
__ × ____ =− × __
√3
√ ___ 3
1__ ___ √ 2 2 1 + 1 × ___
1__
+ ___
1__ __
√2
. 2
.1 √2 2
√ 3
__ __
__ __ (√3 − 1)
−(√ 3 − 1) ________
(√3 − 1) (√ 3 − 1) = _________
__ × __
== −________
__ × ________
__ √3 + 1 (√3 − 1)
√3 + 1 (√ 3 − 1)
__ __
√
(3 − 2 3 + 1)
_____________ (3 − 2√3 + 1)
=− 3−1
= −____________
3−1
__ __
= − 2 + √3 = −2 + √ 3
sin 2x
2 tan 2x = _______
cos 2x
Alternative solution using
sin 2x tan 2A formula: _____
= _______
cos 2x cos x = k ∴ sin x = √ 1 − k2
2 sin x. cos x
= _____________ tan 2x = _________
2 tan x
cos2 x − sin2 x 2
1 − tan x
______ _____
2√1 − k2 .k √ 1 − k2 1
= ______________
______ 2_______ 1 – k²
k2
k − (√1 − k ) = __________ × __
2 2 2 k
______
2k√1 − k 2
(
1 − k2
1 − ______
2
k ) k2
= ___________ _____
2 k −1+k 2
2k√ 1 − k2 x
______ = _________
k2 − 1 + k2 k
2k√1 − k2
= __________ _____
2
2k − 1 2k√ 1 − k2
= _________
2k2 − 1
prove that in any △ABC, tan A.tan B.tan C = tan A + tan B + tan C.
Unit 3 Prove identities using compound and double angle identities 101
1.2 ___________
1 − sin 2x
= sin x − cos x
sin x − cos x
1.3 _______________
sin x + sin 2x
= tan x
1 + cos x + cos 2x
(cos2 x − sin2 x)2
______________
1.4 = cos 2x
cos4 x − sin4 x
1.5 _________
1 − cos 2x
= tan x
sin 2x
1.6 _______________
sin 2x − cos x
= _____
cos x
1 − cos 2x − sin x sin x
1.7 ________________
1 − cos 2x + sin 2x
= tan x
1 + cos 2x + sin 2x
1.8 ____________
sin x − cos 2x ________
=
sin x + 1
sin 2x − cos x cos x
2
(cos x + sin x) − 1
1.9 _______________________ = tan 2x
(cos x + sin x)(cos x − sin x)
2
1 − cos x − sin(−2x)
__________________
1.10 sin x + 2cos x = sin x
2 Prove the identities using compound angles and double angle identities.
sin(x + y)
_________
2.1 cos x cos y= tan x + tan y
2.2 ______
sin 2x ______
−
cos 2x _____
=
1
sin x cos x cos x
2.3 sin(45° + x)sin(45° − x) = __
1
2
− sin2 x
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
y
Solve for x if 3 cos(x − 25°) + 2 = 0
KEY WORDS
and −360° ≤ x ≤ 360°.
x – 25°
solution – a value of the
SOLUTION 2 1 angle which satisfies a given
trigonometric equation
3 cos(x − 25°) + 2 = 0 specific solutions –
x – 25°
cos(x − 25°) = −__
2
3
solutions that satisfy a given
48,19° trigonometric equation in a
x restricted interval, such as
48,19° –360° ≤ x ≤ 360°
general solution – a formula
– ( x – 25°) that lists all possible solutions
to a trigonometric equation;
3 4
it takes into account the
period of the trigonometric
functions, so the angle can be
positive or negative
Method 1: Use the positive ratio, acute angle and quadrant method.
Calculator angle = 48,19° | Find the acute angle by keying in shift cos−1 __
2
3 ( )
.
Quadrant 2 (positive angle): | Determine the quadrants in which cos is
negative (2 and 3). Note: This is a Grade 11 type
question.
(x − 25°) = 180° − 48,19° + n.360° | The solution will be (x − 25°) = 180° −
calculator angle (Quadrant 2).
x = 131,81° + 25° + n.360° | Do not leave out the general solution (n.360°).
x = 156,81° + n.360°, n ∈ ℤ | Solve for the unknown x.
Quadrant 3 (positive angle):
(x − 25°) = 180° + 48,19° + n.360° | The solution will be (x − 25°) = 180° +
calculator angle (Quadrant 3).
∴ x = 228,19° + 25° + n.360° | Solve for the unknown x.
x = 253,19° + n.360°, n ∈ ℤ
For the negative angles:
x = 156,81° + (−1).360° = −203,19°
x = 253,19° + (−1).360° = −106,81°
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
SOLUTION
sin 3x cos x − cos 3x sin x = 0,4 | Recognise this as sin(A − B) where A = 3x and B = x
sin(3x − x) = 0,4
sin 2x = 0 ,4 | To solve sin A = 0,4 press shift sin−1(0,4)
1) 2x = 23,58° + n.360 | Remember that two options are required (quadrants
1 and 2).
x = 11,79° + n.180°
-
90° 180° 270° 360°
x = 25° + n.90°
y = sin x
–1 -
EXERCISE 6
If cos x = 0
Determine the general solution for each equation. x = 90° + n.180°
1 sin x cos 20° − cos x sin 20° = 0,38 If cos x = 1
2 cos x cos 25° − sin x sin 25° = 0,65 x = 0° + n.360°
If cos x = −1
3 sin x cos 60° + cos x sin 60° = 0,66__
√3 x = 180° + n.360°
4 cos 2x cos 40° + sin 2x sin 40° = ___
2 y
5 2sin x cos x = −0,42
6 sin x cos x = 0,25 1-
7 cos2 x − sin2 x = 0,66 y = cos x
8 2 cos2 x − 1 = −0,75
9 sin2 x − cos2x = 0,67
10 sin x + ______
_____
cos x sin 4x 0- x
=0 -
-
cos 4x 90° 180° 270° 360°
Use the identities sin 2x = 2 sin x cos x, cos 2x = 1 − 2 sin2 x or cos 2x = 2 cos2 x − 1
4. Find the general solution and solve for the given interval.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTION
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
SOLUTION
x = 60° + n.180°, n ∈ ℤ
SOLUTION
EXERCISE 7
Solve for x, giving the general solution first and specific solutions if an interval
is given.
1 cos 2x + cos x = 0
2 sin2 x + sin 2x = 0, and −360° ≤ x ≤ 360°
3 3 cos 2x + cos x + 2 = 0
4 2 sin 2x − 2 sin x = 6 cos2 x − 3 cos x, and x ∈ [−360°;360°]
5 cos 2x + cos x + 1 = 0
6 cos 2x + sin x − 1 = 0
7 11 cos2 x − 4 cos 2x = 6 + cos x
8 cos 2x − 4 sin x + 5 = 0
9 sin 2x = 2cos2 x
10 cos 2x + 3 cos x − 1 = 0 and −180° ≤ x ≤ 180°
11 sin 2x − sin x = 1 − 2 cos x
12 2 cos 2x + __
1
2
sin 2x = sin2 x and 0° ≤ x ≤ 360°
13 4 sin x sin 2x + sin 2x − cos x = 0
14 sin 2x + cos 2x − 1 = 0 and −180° ≤ x ≤ 180°
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
Find the general solution of cos 2x cos 30° − sin 2x sin 30° = sin x.
SOLUTION
cos 2x cos 30° − sin 2x sin 30° = sin x | Recognise the compound angle cos(A + B).
cos(2x + 30°) = sin x | Use the co-ratio sin x = cos(90° − x).
cos(2x + 30°) = cos(90° − x)
Consider the two options where cos is positive (Quadrants 1 and 4).
REMEMBER Quadrant 1 Quadrant 4
Remember the rule for 2x + 30° = 90° − x + n.360° 2x + 30° = −(90° − x) + n.360°
cosA = cosB 3x = 60° + n.360° 2x + 30° = −90° + x + n.360°
A = B + n. 360° x = 20° + n.120°, n ∈ ℤ x = −120° + n.360°, n ∈ ℤ
or A = −B + n.360° For Quadrant 4 you may also use
2x + 30° = 360° − (90° − x) + n.360°
x = 240° + n.360° (which is the same as −120°)
EXERCISE 8
Solve for x, giving the general solution first and specific solutions if an interval
is given.
1 sin x cos 25° + cos x sin 25° = sin 2x and −180° ≤ x ≤ 180°
2 cos x cos 30° + sin x sin 30° = sin 2x
3 cos x cos 330° + sin x cos 120° = cos 2x and 0° ≤ x ≤ 360°
4 cos(45° + x)cos(45° − x) + sin(45° + x)sin(45° − x) = cos(45° + x)
5 sin(50° + x)cos 20° + cos(50° + x) sin 200° = cos(10° + x) and −180° ≤ x ≤ 180°
6 cos x sin 63° + sin x sin 27° = 2 sin x cos x
7 _______
cos 2x
+ _______
sin 2x
= −1
sin 45° cos 45°
8 _______
sin 40° _______
−
cos 40°
=2
sin x cos x
6.2 ______________________
sin 105° cos 75°. tan 135°
= −__
1
(4)
sin(−330°) 2
6.3 sin 80° − sin 40° = sin 20° [Hint: 80° = 60° + 20° and 40° = 60° − 20°] (4)
sin2 20° + sin2 40° + sin2 80 = __
3
6.4 2
(6)
109
7 Prove that:
7.1 sin(45° + x).sin(45° − x) = __
1
2
cos 2x and hence
determine the value of sin 75°. sin 15° (5)
7.2 sin 105° + cos 105° = cos 45°. (5)
8.5 ________
1
+ ________ = ___________
1 sin 2x tan x
(6)
1 + cos x 1 − cos x sin4x
8.6 ____________
cos 2x − cos x _____
=
1
− _____
1
(5)
sin 2x + sin x tan x sin x
cos4 x + sin2 x cos2 x
__________________
8.7 1 − sin x = 1 + sin x (4)
8.8 2(
(1 − cos 2x) 1 + _____
1
=2
tan x ) (4)
8.9 cos 2x + 2 sin 2x + 2 = (3 cos x + sin x)(cos x + sin x) (3)
8.10 For which values of x ∈ [0°; 360°] are the identities in 8.2, 8.3 and 8.6
undefined? (5 × 3)
110
Time: 2 hours
Total marks: 70 or 75
The problem: To investigate the polygon that has the largest area with a
fixed perimeter
Instructions
1) Use a pencil and ruler to draw the polygons, which you do not
have to construct accurately.
2) Use simple geometry and trigonometry to calculate the areas of
the polygons.
3) Try to keep the answers in surd form as long as possible and round
off to two decimal places at the end.
4) All calculations and diagrams must accompany your investigation.
5) When comparing areas it may be to your advantage to set your
work out in a table.
6) You may use Geogbra software in this investigation to assist you
with drawing the polygons. You may also use an Excel spreadsheet to do
the area calculations. But we recommend that you use pen and paper.
7) Your investigation will be marked according to the given rubric (70 marks)
or with a mark scheme (75 marks).
Use Heron’s formula when you know the lengths of all three sides of a triangle.
Heron’s formula states that:
_________________
Area △ABC = √ p(p − a)(p − b)(p − c)
where a, b and c are the lengths of the sides of the triangle and p is half the perimeter
of the triangle: p = ________
a+b+c
2
.
Option 1: Investigation: Find the maximum area of polygons with a fixed perimeter 111
Task 1
1 How many different triangles can you make with a perimeter of 12 units? (3)
2 Use integer values for the lengths of the sides or use 12 matchsticks to
investigate how to make up your triangles. (6)
3 Find the area of each triangle and decide which has the greatest area. (9)
Task 2
1 How many different rectangles can you make with a perimeter of 12 units? (3)
2 Use integer values for the lengths of the sides or use 12 matchsticks to investigate
how to make up your rectangles. (3)
3 Find the area of each rectangle and decide which has the greatest area. (7)
Task 4
1 Investigate the areas of regular polygons with a fixed perimeter of 12 units. (5)
2 Calculate the length of the side of each polygon. This does not have to be
an integer value; use this information to find the area. (5)
(Hint: divide the polygons into triangles and use these to find the area of each
polygon.)
3 Investigate polygons with 3, 4, 6, 8 and 12 sides. (22)
4 Lastly, calculate the area of a circle with a perimeter or circumference of
12 units. (4)
Task 5
1 If you knew that two regular polygons had the same perimeter, describe
in words how you would predict which one had the greater area. (2)
2 Use your results from Task 4 to make a conjecture about the type of polygon
or figure that yields a maximum area, given a fixed perimeter. (3)
Option 1: Investigation: Find the maximum area of polygons with a fixed perimeter 113
Time: 2 hours
Total marks: 100
Topic 1 Topic 2
Patterns and sequences Functions and inverse functions
Note: It is important to know the derivations of A function is a relationship or rule between two
formulae for the examinations. sets, the domain (x) and the range (y), where every
• Arithmetic sequences: a sequence of numbers with element of the domain is assigned to one and only one
a common difference between consecutive terms (a element of the range.
linear pattern) • Functions can be one-to-one (for example, straight
• Tn = a + ( n − 1 )d; d = Tn+1 − Tn lines) or many-to-one relations (for example,
• where a = first term; d = common difference; parabolas).
n = number of terms; • You can use the vertical line test (which must cross
Tn = value of nth term. the graph once) to determine whether a graph is a
• Geometric sequences: a sequence of numbers with function, but the definition of a function must be
a common ratio between consecutive terms (an given as the reason for it being a function or not.
exponential pattern) The inverse of a function is the graph obtained by
Tn+1 reflecting the function about the line y = x.
• Tn = ar n−1 ; r = ____
T n • This means swapping the x and y values:
• where a = first term; r = constant ratio; (x;y) → (y;x)
n = number of terms; • f −1 is used to represent the inverse of f (x).
Tn = value of nth term. • The inverse of a many-to-one function will not be a
• Arithmetic series: sum of an arithmetic sequence function, unless its domain is restricted.
__
n
• Sn = 2 ( a + l ) if last term (l) is know OR
S = __[ 2a + ( n − 1 )d ]
n
n 2
• Geometric series: sum of a geometric sequence
a( 1 − r n ) ________
________ a( r n − 1 )
• Sn = ( )
=
r−1
,r≠1
1−r
n
• If − 1 < r < 1, then r → 0 as n → ∞, and a sum to
infinity can be determined: S∞ = = ____
a
1−r
• Sigma notation: The answer always represents the
n
sum: ∑ Tk = Sn
k=1
Topic 3 Topic 4
Exponential and logarithmic Finance, growth and decay
functions • In Grade 11 you learnt how to use the simple and
Exponential graphs have the form y = ax,a > 0, a ≠ 1 compound interest formulae and to solve for any
• The y-intercept is (0;1). variables in those formulae, except for finding n,
• The x-axis is a horizontal asymptote. the time period. Knowledge of logarithms in
• The domain is x ∈ ℝ and the range is y ∈ ℝ, y > 0. Grade 12 enables you to apply logs to solve for n
• If a > 1, the graph increases and if 0 < a < 1, the in any of the finance formulae.
graph decreases. • Effective interest is extended so that you can
• The graph is a one-to-one function. compare interest rates that are compounded at
The graph of y = ax + p has a horizontal asymptote different frequencies.
• 1 + i = (1 + ) for effective annual interest
(m) m
i___
y = p. eff m
loga x = y if and only if x = ay where x > 0 and a > 0,
( 1 + i___
m ) ( )
(m) m i( n ) n
a≠1 • = 1 + ___
for comparing interest
n
The logarithmic function is defined as y = loga x, a > 0, rates at different compounding frequencies.
a ≠ 1, x ∈ ℝ • An annuity is a number of regular payments of
• The x-intercept is (1; 0). a fixed amount made over a determined time
• The y-axis is a vertical asymptote. period.
x[ ( 1 + i )n − 1 ]
____________
• The domain is x ∈ ℝ, x > 0 and the range is y ∈ ℝ. • Future value annuities: F = i
• If a > 1, the graph increases and if 0 < a < 1, the x[ 1 − ( 1 + i )−n ]
_____________
• Present value annuities: P = i
graph decreases.
where x = the regular payment,
• The graph is a one-to-one function
i = interest rate (which must have the
• When you compare y = loga x and y = log__1 x you can
a same regularity of compounding as
see that the two graphs are reflections in the x-axis. the payments are made),
• If f(x) = y = ax, a > 0, a ≠ 1 then for f −1: x = ay and n = number of payments made (which
f −1(x) = y = loga x should start one time period after the
1 x
__ ( ) __( )
1 y
• If f(x) = y = a , 0 < a < 1 then for f −1: x = a and process starts).
f −1(x) = y = log__1 x • If payments start immediately, add 1 to the value
a
of n; if payments start late, subtract the number
of missed payments from what should have been
the value of n. For loans, add interest to the loan if
payments start late.
• Sinking funds are an application of future value
annuities.
• Balance outstanding on loans after k payments
have been made:
[
( 1 + i )k − 1
B.O. = L( 1 + i )k − x __________ i ]where
L = loan amount
or
[1 − ( 1 + i )−( n−k )
B.O. = x _____________
i ]
Topic 5
Trigonometry: compound and
double angles
Note: You must know the derivations of formulae for
examination purposes.
• Compound angle formulae:
cos(α − β) = cos α cos β + sin α sin β
cos(α + β) = cos α cos β − sin α sin β
sin(α − β) = sin α cos β − cos α sin β
sin(α + β) = sin α cos β + cos α sin β
tan α + tan β tan α − tan β
tan(α + β) = ____________tan(α − β) = ____________
1 − tan α tan β 1 + tan α tan β
• Double angle formulae:
sin 2θ = 2 sinθ cos θ cos 2θ = cos2 θ − sin2 θ
or cos 2θ = 1 − 2 sin2 θ or cos 2θ = 2 cos2 θ − 1
2 tan α
tan 2α = ________2
1 − tan α
• Other identities
sin θ
tan θ = _____
cos θ
sin2 θ + cos2 θ = 1
cos2 θ = 1 − sin2 θ
sin2 θ = 1 − cos2 θ
• When solving a general solution:
For cosA = k → A = ± B + n. 360° where B is any
acceptable solution for the sign of k and B = cos−1 k.
For tan A = k → A = B + n. 180° where B is any
acceptable solution for the sign of k and B = tan−1 k.
For sinA = k → A = B + n. 360° or 180° − B + n.
360° where B is any acceptable solution for the sign
of k and B = sin−1 k.
118
119
SOLUTION
Q R S
d
^R = θ
QP | Isosceles △
^
PRS = 2θ | Exterior angle of △
^ S = P^SR = 90° − θ
RP | Angles in isosceles △
a = __________
d sin 2θ
sin(90° − θ)
d × 2 sin θ cos θ
a = ______________
cos θ
| Use co-ratio and double angle identities.
a = 2d sin θ
You could also have solved this question by P
^ S = 90° − θ + θ = 90°.
observing that QP
90° – a
△QPS is therefore a right-angled triangle
and you can use the basic definitions to
2 90° –
find a. S
Q d R
___
PS ___
=
a
= sin θ
QS 2d
∴ a = 2d sin θ, which is simpler!
EXERCISE 1
x x
120°
D
Unit 1 Problems in two dimensions 121
60°
Q S
6 In△ABC, AB = AC = d and AB ^B = θ
^ C = AC
A
^ D = β,BC = x and DC = k
^ D = θ,BC
In △BCD, CB
6.1 Use the cosine rule to show x = 2d cos θ d d
Now show that k = ________
d sin 2θ
6.2 sin(θ + β)
B x C
c b
B C
a
1 If in △ABC, AC = CB, find a2 in terms of c and cos C using the cosine rule.
2 If in △ABC, AB = AC, find a in terms of c and cos C using the sine rule.
b2
3 If in △ABC, AB = BC, prove that cos B = 1 − ___
2a2
4 ^=C
If in △ABC, B ^ prove that area △ABC = b2 sin B.cos B
4.Area △ABC ^
5 If △ABC is scalene prove that tan B = ____________ B ≠ 90°
a2 + c2 − b2
b2 + c2 − a2
If △ABC is scalene prove that ______
2 sin B __________
6 tan A
= ac
7 ^ ^
If in △ABC, B = C prove that tan 2B = 2________
2ab sin B
a − 2b2
8 If △ABC is scalene prove that tan A = __________
a sin C ^ ≠ 90°).
(on condition that A
b − a cos C
9 If △ABC is scalene prove that:
a + b + c = (b + c) cos A + (c + a) cos B + (a + b) cos C
A A
B
B D
B
C D
C
WORKED EXAMPLE A
SOLUTION
C
AB^ D = 90° and AB
^ C = 90°
___
12
= tan 45°
BC
∴ BC = _______
12
tan 45°
= 12
___
12
= tan 40°
BD
∴ BD = _______
12
tan 40°
= 14,30
DC2 = BC2 + BD2 − 2BC.BD cos 55°
DC2 = 122 + (14,30)2 − 2(12)(14,30) cos 55°
DC2 = 151,6386
DC = 12,31 m
Three-dimensional problems can involve prisms and pyramids which you worked
with in Grades 10 and 11. Remember that right angles will not always look like
right angles.
EXERCISE 3
E F
1 The figure represents the top of a sloping
school desk. ABCD represents the
D C
horizontal plane with dimensions 60 cm
15°
by 40 cm. ABFE represents the sloping desk 40 cm
top. Calculate the angle between the A 60 cm B
horizontal plane and AF, the diagonal of A
^ C = 15°.
the sloping desk top if FB 70° C
2 The figure represents a triangular prism with
AB = AC = 10 cm and BA ^ C = 70°.
B
2.1 Calculate the area of △ABC. 40°
D
2.2 Calculate the length of BC.
F
2.3 Calculate the height CF of the prism if
^ F = 40°.
CB
3 Xandi is standing at point X. She observes
two vertical poles AB and CD. The angle of E
A
elevation from X to C is 20° and from X to A is
25°. The distance between Xandi and the foot of C
pole AB is 15 m. Pole CD is 5 m high.
3.1 Calculate the distance from X to A. 5m
3.2 Calculate the distance from X to C.
3.3 Calculate the distance, AC, between B
^ C = 46°.
the two poles if AX 15 m
25° 46°
20° D
X
A
200 m B
36°
C D
350 m
96 m 20°
C
A
7 In the diagram B, C and D lie in the same
horizontal plane. AB is a vertical pole. The angle
of elevation from C to A is 41°, BC^ D = 54°,
Prove that:
1 BD = __2(
x √__ _____
1
3 + tan θ )
(
1 2 √__ _____
)
60°
2 Area △BDC = __ 8
x 3+ 1 tan θ B 30°
D
__
3 __
x
( √3
_____
AB = 2 3 + tan θ ) x
SOLUTIONS
C
1 ^ D = 180° − (θ + 30°)
BC
_________________
BD
= _____
x
sin(180° − (θ + 30°)) sin θ
x sin(θ + 30°)
BD = ____________
sin θ
| Use compound angle formula.
x(sin θ cos 30° + cos θ sin 30°)
= _________________________
sin θ
| Divide by sin θ.
2(
x √__ _____
= __ 3 + tan 1
θ )
2 Area △BCD = __
1
2
x.BD. sin 30° 3 ___
AB
BD
= tan 60°
Area △BCD = __
1
2
x.BD.__
1
2
AB = BD tan 60°
( )
__ x __
AB = √ 3 .__ √ 3 + _____
( )
__ 1
Area △BCD = __
x __
. √3 + _____
x 1 tan θ
2 __
( )
4 2 tan θ √3
AB = __ _____
( )
__ x
2 3 + tan θ
Area △BCD = __ 3 + _____
x √ 1 2
8 tan θ
D
EXERCISE 4
A E
x
B y D
120°
B y D
2p
k
x
C C
Question 4 Question 5
5 In the diagram B, C and D lie in the horizontal plane with BC = k. DC^ B = x and D
^
CBD = y. FAB and ED are vertical to the plane. The angle of elevation from
E to point F is θ.
5.1 Write BD^ C in terms of x and y. h
Show that EF = __________________________
k sin x
5.2 cos θ(sin x cos y + cos x sin y)
5.3 Calculate the value of EF if x =48°, y =38°, θ = 28° and k = 30 m.
A C
6 In the figure alongside A, B and C lie in the same horizontal plane. The vertical
pole DC is h metres high and the angle of elevation from B to D is θ.
sin(α + β)
^ B = β show that AC = h__________
^ B = α, AC
6.1 If CA sin α tan θ
6.2 If α = θ and β = 30° use 6.1 to show that:
( )
__
AC = ______ √ 3 + _____
h 1
2 tan α tan α B
2h cos2 α
6.3 If α = θ = β use 6.1 to show that AC = ________ sin α
W
7 A rectangular block of wood has vertices P, Q, R,
S, T, U, V and W. The dimensions of this block T
____ V
of wood are √ 200 cm × 12 cm × 5 cm. A cut is
made through the vertices Q, T and V, revealing a 5
triangular plane QTV.
^ V. P
7.1 Determine the magnitude (size) of TQ
R
7.2 Determine the area of the triangular plane 200 12
QTV. Q
2 The figure represents a triangular prism. It is placed on one of its faces, ABCD, a
square with sides 50 cm. Face AEFD is a rectangle which is inclined at 30° to the
horizontal plane ABCD. Calculate the size of the angle that line DE makes with B
C
plane ABCD. (6)
30°
If △ABC is scalene prove that AC = ______
c sin B 50 cm
3. 3.1 sin C
(2) A
3.2 If △ABC is scalene prove that area
c2 sin B.sin(B + C) D A
△ABC = ________________
2 sin C
(2) 50 cm
130
131
2 7 Polynomials
Unit 1: Factorise third degree polynomials
A polynomial is an algebraic expression in which the powers of the variable
(let’s use x) must be integers greater than or equal to 0, and the coefficients of
the variable must be constants which are real numbers.
Examples:
3x2 − 4x + 2 is a polynomial of degree 2 and has 3 terms.
REMEMBER 3x__4 − 7x3 + 2x2 − 11 is a polynomial of degree 4 and has 4 terms.
√ 3 x3
_____
• The degree of a polynomial − x is a polynomial of degree 3 and has 2 terms.
2
is the degree of the term
with the highest power. Division by a variable will not give you a polynomial.
• The constant term has no The following expressions are not polynomials:
variable so its value does
___
3x + y + 3xy−2 + y There is a power that is not a positive integer, (−2).
y2__ __
1 −__
1
not change. You could √x + ___
2
√x
__ + x + 2x
2 2 There are powers that are not positive integers, __
1
and −__
2
1
. 2
think of the degree of the
_____
2x + 2x(x − 1)−1 There is a power that is not a positive integer, (x − 1)−1.
constant term as being x−1
0 because 5x° = 5 because The standard form of a polynomial shows the terms of all y
x° = 1.
possible degree combinations.
• Positive integers are the
numbers 1, 2, 3, 4 … For a linear or 1st degree polynomial the standard form is ax + b.
For a quadratic or 2nd degree polynomial the standard form is
ax2 + bx + c. x
y = ax + b
x
y = ax² + bx + c
y = ax³ + bx² + cx + d
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTION
f(1) = 12 − 2(1) + 1 = 0
f(−3) = (−3)2 − 2(−3) + 1
= 9 + 6 + 1 = 16
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTION
EXERCISE 2
A cubic polynomial can be the product of a linear and a quadratic function plus
another term or constant:
(x − 2)(x2 − 2x + 6) + 3 = x3 − 2x2 − 2x2 + 4x + 6x − 12 + 3 = x3 − 4x2 + 10x − 9
WORKED EXAMPLES
1 If f(x) = x3 + 3x2 − 6x − 8
1.1 Show that x − 2 is a factor of f(x).
1.2 Find the remainder when f (x) is divided by x − 1.
SOLUTIONS
Unit 2 Factorise and solve cubic polynomials using the remainder or factor theorem 135
SOLUTION
EXERCISE 3
When you factorise cubic (3rd degree) polynomials using division by inspection,
follow these steps:
a) Test for linear factors using the factor theorem. Possible factors are factors of
the constant term 6: x ± 1; x ± 2; x ± 3; x ± 6
b) Use division by inspection to find the quadratic factor ax2 + bx + c.
c) Factorise the quadratic factor if possible.
2x3 − 5x2 − x + 6
_______________
SOLUTIONS = Q(x)
x−2
or
1 a) Using the factor theorem: 2x3 − 5x2 − x + 6 = (x − 2)Q(x)
f(x) = x3 − 2x2 − 5x + 6 where Q(x) is a 2nd degree
polynomial
f(1) = (1)3 − 2(1)2 − 5(1) + 6 = 0
2x3 − 5x2 − x + 6
∴ (x − 1) is a factor
= (x −2)(ax2 + bx + c)
b) Using division by inspection: a = 2 (x × 2x2 = 2x3) and
x3 − 2x2 − 5x + 6 = (x − 1)(x2 + bx − 6) c = −3
−x2 (−2 × −3 = +6)
bx2 −3x
−2bx
−x2 + =bx2 −2x2
∴ b = −1
2x3 − 5x2 − x + 6 = (x − 2)(2x2 + bx − 3)
x3 − 2x2 − 5x + 6 = (x − 1)(x2 − x − 6)
−4x2
c) Factorising the 2nd bracket: bx2
x3 − 2x2 − 5x + 6 = (x − 1)(x − 3)(x + 2) − 5x2 = −4x2 + bx2
∴ b = −1
Check: − x = −3x − 2bx ∴ b = −1
2 a) Using the factor theorem:
2x3 − 5x2 − x + 6
f(x) = 2x3 + x2 − 13x + 6
= (x − 2)(2x2 − x − 3)
f(1) = 2(1)3 + (1)2 − 13(1) + 6 ≠ 0 2x3 − 5x2 − x + 6
f(2) = 2(2)3 + (2)2 − 13(2) + 6 = 0 = (x − 2)(2x − 3)(x + 1)
∴ (x − 2) is a factor.
b) Using division by inspection:
2x3 + x2 − 13x + 6 = (x − 2)(2x2 + bx − 3)
−4x2
bx2
2 2 2
−4x + bx = x ∴ b = 5
2x3 + x2 − 13x + 6 = (x − 2)(2x2 + 5x − 3)
c) Factorising the 2nd bracket:
x3 − 2x2 − 5x + 6 = (x − 2)(x + 3)(2x − 1)
EXERCISE 4
1 Use division by inspection to factorise these cubic polynomials where one factor
is given. Not all these polynomial have three linear factors.
1.1 x3 − x2 − 10x − 8 and x + 1 is a factor
1.2 x3 + 3x2 − 3x − 10 and x + 2 is a factor
1.3 −x3 − 3x2 + 10x + 24 and x + 2 is a factor
1.4 2x3 − 7x2 + 9 and x − 3 is a factor
1.5 x3 − 13x + 12 and x − 1 is a factor
1.6 −x3 − 3x2 + x + 3 and x + 3 is a factor
1.7 2x3 + 2x2 − 18x − 18 and x + 3 is a factor
1.8 4x3 − 7x − 3 and 2x − 3 is a factor
Unit 2 Factorise and solve cubic polynomials using the remainder or factor theorem 137
x=
−b ± √ b2 − 4ac
______________ Solving third degree polynomial equations
2a
This is used to find the roots In Topic 8 you learn to plot the graph of a cubic (3rd degree) function. You will find
of ax2 + bx + c = 0 the x intercepts of the graphs. This means you must be able to solve equations of the
type ax3 + bx2 + cx + d = 0.
You have seen that a cubic polynomial has three factors.
A cubic equation will therefore have three solutions or a graph will have three roots.
A cubic equation will always have at least one root.
The other two roots may be real and rational or real and irrational.
A cubic equation may have one real root if the solutions to the quadratic factor are
non-real.
In the graphs below:
KEY WORDS Graph A has three real roots, where two are equal.
For ax2 + bx + c = 0: Graph B has three real, unequal roots.
real roots − occur when Graph C has three real roots that are all resulting in one x-intercept.
b2 − 4ac ≥ 0 and can be
Graph D has one real root and two non-real roots.
rational or irrational; for
A B C D
example x2 − 3x + 1 = 0__has
3 ± √5
irrational roots x = _______
2
y y y y
rational roots − occur when
the equation factorises
or b2 − 4ac is a perfect
square; for example (x − 2)
(2x + 3) = 0 ∴ x = 2 or −__3
2
x x x
or for the___
same equation x
1 ± √ 49
________
x= 4
non-real roots − occur when
b2 − 4ac < 0; for example
___
x = 3 ± √ −4
WORKED EXAMPLES
Solve for x and in each case say what type of roots the polynomial has.
1 x3 − 2x2 − 4x + 8 = 0
2 2x3 − 5x2 − x + 6 = 0
3 x3 + x2 − 11x − 3 = 0
4 x3 + 2x2 − 3x − 10 = 0
EXERCISE 5
Solve for x and in each case say what type of roots the polynomial has.
1 (x + 1)(x − 2)(2x − 3) = 0 2 −x3 + 4x2 = 0
3 x3 − 2x2 + x = 0 4 2x3 − x2 − 15x + 18 = 0
5 2x3 + 9x2 − 17x + 6 = 0 6 −x3 + 6x2 − 5x − 6 = 0
7 x2 + 4x + 1 = __
6
x 8 x3 + 4x2 − 2x − 3 = 0
9 −x3 + 2x2 + 9x − 18 = 0 10 x3 − 2x2 − 5x + 6 = 0
11 x3 − 6x2 + 9x − 2 = 0 12 −x3 + 5x2 = 6x + 12
Unit 2 Factorise and solve cubic polynomials using the remainder or factor theorem 139
3 Use the remainder and factor theorems to answer the questions that follow.
3.1 If f(x) = 2x3 + x2 − 13x + 6:
3.1.1 show that 2x − 1 is a factor of f(x) (3)
3.1.2 find the remainder when f(x) is divided by x + 1. (2)
3.2. Given f(x) = x3 + 2x2 + kx − 6 find k if:
3.2.1 the remainder is 6 when f(x) is divided by x + 2 (4)
3.2.2 x − 3 is a factor of f(x) (4)
3.3. Given f(x) = 4x3 − 7x2 − 7x + 30 and g( x ) = 4x + 5.
3.3.1 What is the remainder when f(x) is divided by g(x). (2)
3.3.2 If f(x) = 4x3 − 7x2 − 7x + k, find k so that g(x) becomes a factor
of f(x). (4)
140
141
2 8 Differential calculus
Unit 1: Limits
When a function is undefined for a particular value x, it is important to know how
the function behaves near the value of x for which it is undefined.
• A function has a limit if it has almost identical values on either side of
the undefined value.
• A function does not have a limit if it has different values on either side of
the undefined value. y
f(x) = x² – 4
4x – 8
Consider the function sketched alongside:
2
f ( x ) = ______
x −4
4x − 8
' (2;1)
REMEMBER
• f ( 2 ) is undefined because 4x − 8 = 0
Division by 0 is undefined when x = 2.
x
• __
4
is undefined
• x → 2 means that x is almost 2, but not
0 exactly 2, and that the values chosen for x
can approach 2 from both sides.
• _____
x−2
x+3
is undefined if x = −3
The limit of a function f ( x ) • f ( x ) has a limit when x → 2 if the result is
is the value it approaches as almost the same on both sides of 2.
x gets closer and closer to a x 1,9 1,99 1,999 1,9999 2 2,0001 2,001 2,01 2,1
particular value.
f(x) 0,975 0,9975 0,99975 0,999975 Undefined 1,000025 1,00025 1,0025 1,025
As x gets closer to 2:
• from the negative side (values less than 2), the value of f ( x ) gets closer to 1
KEY WORDS
• from the positive side (values greater than 2), the value of f ( x ) gets closer to 1.
identical – exactly the same lim f ( x ) = 1 in spite of the fact that f ( 2 ) is undefined.
asymptote – a straight line x→2
that a graph gets very close
It is important to note that you can simplify f ( x ):
to, but never touches x2 − 4 (x − 2)(x + 2)
f ( x ) = ______ = ____________ = _____, x ≠ 2
x+2
• 4x − 8 4(x − 2) 4
_____
x +2 _____
2 + 2
• lim f ( x ) = lim 4 = 4 = 1
REMEMBER x→2 x→2
As x gets closer to 1:
• from the negative side (values less than 1), the value of f ( x ) gets bigger
• from the positive side (values greater than 1), the value of f ( x ) gets smaller
The results show that g does not have a limit when x = 1, so lim − _____
x→1
4
x−1
does ( )
not exist.
EXERCISE 1
1 For each of the functions A–J, determine the limit, if it exists, by setting up a
table like the one below. Select the appropriate x-values from the table.
x → −2 −2,1 −2,01 −2,001 −2,0001 −2 −1,9999 −1,999 −1,99 −1,9
x→0 0 0,0001 0,001 0,01 0,1 REMEMBER
−0,1 −0,01 −0,001 −0,0001
x→2 1,9 1,99 1,999 1,9999 2 2,0001 2,001 2,01 2,1 Factorise fractions to simplify
x→3 2,9 2,99 2,999 2,9999 3 3,0001 3,001 3,01 3,1 them. ALWAYS take out the
x→5 4,9 4,99 4,999 4,9999 5 5,0001 5,001 5,01 5,1 highest common factor first.
If there are two terms,
x2 − 2x x2 − 5x + 6
A lim _______
x B lim __________
5x − 15
consider the options of
x→0 x→3 trinomials, difference of
x2 + 2x − 8 x2 − 7x
C lim __________
x−2
D lim _______
2
squares, sum or difference of
x→2 x→0
x − 3x cubes.
s3 + 8 If there are three terms see if
lim _____ lim _____
3
E s+2
F 2
s→−2 s→−2
s −4 you have a trinomial which
2s2 − 3s − 5 5k3 − 25k2 factorises.
G lim ___________ H lim _________ If there are four terms, try
s→3
2s2 − 5s k→5
k2 − 25
grouping them into pairs.
k2 − 7k + 12 x2 − 2x
I lim ___________
2 J lim _______
x−2
k→3
2k − 4k − 6 x→2
2 Simplify each function in Question 1 and then determine the limit, if possible.
y = −3x + 9 passes through the points (2;3) and (3;0), with m = _____
3 − 0 ___
3
=
2 − 3 −1
= −3
y = – 3x + 9 11
y = – 4x + 11
9
y = –x + 5 5 (1;4)
KEY WORDS A (2;3)
3
5
(4;–5)
f(x) = –x² + 2x + 3
In the table below, we calculate the gradient between the point ( x; f ( x ) ) and the point
3 − f(x)
(2;3) using the average gradient formula: m = _______ where f(x) = –x2 + 2x + 3.
2−x
REMEMBER 3 − 3,00019999
If x = 1,9999 ⇒ m = ______________
2 − 1,9999
= −1,9999
y2 − y1
m = ______
x2 − x1 gives the gradient 3 − 2,99979999
If x = 2,0001 ⇒ m = ______________
2 − 2,0001
= −2,0001
of a straight line.
The average gradient of a
curve is also given by We cannot use the average gradient to determine the gradient at x = 2, but
y2 − y1 3 − f(x)
m = ______
x2 − x1. lim _______ ≈ −2
2−x
x→2−
The equation of a straight line
3 − f(x) 3 − f(x)
is given by lim _______ ≈ −2 ⇒ lim_______
2−x
= −2
2−x
y − y1 = m ( x − x1 ) and by x→2 + x→2
f ( x ) = −x2 + 2x + 3 y
f ( 2 ) = − ( 2 )2 + 2 ( 2 ) + 3 = 3
f ( 2 + h ) = − ( 2 + h )2 + 2 ( 2 + h ) + 3
= −4 − 4h − h2 + 4 + 2h + 3 A(2;f (2))
= −h2 − 2h + 3
f(2 + h) − f(2) x
mAB = ____________
( )
2+h −2 –2 –1 1 2 3 4
( −h2 − 2h + 3 ) − 3
________________
=
2+h−2
−h2 − 2h B(2+h;f (2+h)
= ________ h
h
(
f(x) = –x² + 2x + 3
h − h − 2)
= _________
h
= −h − 2
x
• A ( x;f ( x ) ) and B ( x + h;f ( x + h ) ) is given
f(x + h) − f(x)
by mAB = ____________
h
If s ( t ) = −4,9t 2 where s is the distance in metres and t is the time in seconds, then:
• t is the independent variable
• s ( t )is the dependent variable.
KEY WORDS
If f ( x ) = x2 + 2x − 3, then:
independent variable – a
• x is the independent variable
variable that does not depend
on other values
• f ( x )is the dependent variable.
dependent variable – a If y = x3 − 8, then:
variable that is affected by
other values
• x is the independent variable
• y is the dependent variable.
The derivative of a function measures the rate at which the dependent variable
changes as the independent variable changes.
• The derivative is the gradient of the tangent to the function at a point on the curve
f(x + h) − f(x)
• f ’ ( x ) = lim ____________
h
is the gradient of a tangent to the curve f at x
h→0
1.4.2 f ’ ( x ) = lim ( 4x + 2h − 5 ) = 4x + 2 ( 0 ) − 5 = 4x − 5
h→0
EXERCISE 3
1 Consider g ( x ) = x2 − 5x − 6.
1.1 Sketch g, indicating the intercepts with the axes and the coordinates of the
turning point.
1.2 Determine g(−1) and g(2) and then plot P(−1; g(−1)) and Q(2; g(2)) on g.
1.3 Determine the average gradient of g between P(−1; g(−1)) and Q(2; g(2)).
1.4 Consider the points: P(−1; g(−1)) and B(−1 + h; g(–1 + h))
1.4.1 Determine the average gradient between P and B in terms of h.
1.4.2 Determine the average gradient between P and B if h = 1.
1.4.3 Plot B on g and draw the line passing through P and B.
1.4.4 Determine the equation of the line passing through P and B.
1.5 Consider the points: D ( x; g ( x ) ) and E ( x + h; g ( x + h ) )
1.5.1 Determine the average gradient between D and E in terms of x and h.
1.5.2 Determine the average gradient between D and E if x = 1 and h = 5.
1.5.3 Determine the average gradient between D and E if xD = 1 and
xE = 6.
1.5.4 Discuss your results to 1.5.2 and 1.5.3.
1.5.5 Plot D and E on g and draw the line which passes through them.
1.5.6 Determine the equation of the line passing through D and E.
1.5.7 Determine g ’(1).
1.5.8 Briefly explain what g ’ ( 1 ) represents.
1.5.9 Determine the equation of the tangent to g at x = 1.
1.5.10 Determine g ’(2,5).
1.5.11 Briefly explain what g ’(2,5) represents.
1.5.12 Determine the equation of the tangent to g at x = 2,5.
SOLUTIONS
1 g ( x + h ) = − ( x + h )3
= − ( x3 + 3x2h + 3x2 + h3 )
= −x3 − 3x2h − 3xh2 − h3
g(x + h) − g(x)
g ’ ( x ) = lim _____________
h
h→0
( −x3 − 3x2h − 3xh2 − h3 ) − ( x3 )
= lim __________________________
h
h→0
−3x2h − 3xh2 − h3
= lim ________________
h
h→0
h ( −3x2 − 3xh − h2 )
= lim ________________
h
h→0
= −3x2 − 3x ( 0 ) − ( 0 )2
= −3x2
g ’ ( −2 ) = −3 ( −2) )2 = −12
2 g ’ ( −2 ) = −12 tell us that the gradient of the tangent to g at x = –2
is m = –12.
3 Substitute m = –12 and (–2;8) into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 )
y − 8 = −12 ( x + 2 ) ⇒ y = −12x − 16
g ( 2 ) − g ( −2 ) ______
−8 − 8 ____
Average gradient =___________
−16
4 = 4
= 4 = −4
2 − ( −2 )
5 Substitute m = – 4 and (–2;8) into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 )
y − 8 = −4 ( x + 2 ) ⇒ y = −4x
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
1 g ( x ) = 5 and g ( x + h ) = 5
g(x + h) − g(x)
g ’ ( x ) = lim _____________ = lim _____ = lim __ = 0
5−5 0
h h h
h→0 h→0 h→0
2 g ’(7) = 0
3 The gradient of the tangent to g is given by m = g ’ ( 7 ) = 0
4 The tangent is a horizontal line given by y = 5.
Take note that the tangent to g(x) = 5 is also y = 5.
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
SOLUTIONS
1 f ( x ) = __
2 _____
2
x and f ( x + h ) = x + h
f(x + h) − f(x)
f ’ ( x ) = lim ____________
h
h→0
h→0
(
= lim __ _____ − __
1 2
h x+h
2
x )
(
= lim __ ____________
h→0
h x(x + h) )
1 2x − 2 ( x + h )
= lim __ ( _______ )
1 − 2h
h x x+h ( )
h→0
= lim ________
−2
x(x + h)
h→0
= _______
−2
x(x + 0)
= −__2
2
x
2 f ’ ( 4 ) = −__
2 ___
2 __
1
2 = − 16 = − 8
4
3 f ’ ( 4 ) gives us the gradient of the tangent to f at x = 4 as m = −__
1
8
.
4 Substitute m = −__
1
8
and 4;__
1
2 ( )
into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 ).
__
1 __
1(
y − = − x − 4 ) ⇒ 8y − 4 = −x + 4 so x + 8y = 8
2 8
__
1
f ( 4 ) − f ( − 1 ) _________− ( − 2) ( __1 + 2 ) × 2
= __________ = _____
1 + 4 __
Average gradient =___________ 1
2 2
5 = 5 5×2 10
=2
4− −1
( )
6 Substitute m = __1
2
and 4;__( )
1
2
into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 )
y − __
1 __
2
1
= ( x − 4 ) ⇒ 2y − 1 = x − 4 and so x − 2y = 3
2
You use the derivative to determine the gradient of a point on a curve, whereas you
use the average gradient to determine the gradient between two points on a curve.
You cannot differentiate all functions.
f( x + h) − f( x)
Consider the definition of the derivative of a function given by f ’ ( x ) = lim_____________
h
.
__
0 h→0
• If f ( x + h ) − f ( x ) = 0 then lim h
= 0 .
h→0
EXERCISE 5
dy
y = __ ___ = −3x−2 = − __
3 3
x y = 3x−1 dx x2
__
Dx[ x 2 ]
__
5 5 __32
__
Dx[ √x5 ] 2
x
[
x2 − 5x − 6
Dx __________
x−6 ] [
(x − 6)(x + 1)
Dx ____________
x−6 ]
= Dx[ x + 1 ] 1
s = −5t 2 + 3t __
ds
= −10t + 3
dt
WORKED EXAMPLES
REMEMBER
__ __
1 Determine, using the rules of differentiation:
√x = x2
__ __
1
1 f ’ ( x ) if f ( x ) = 7x2 − 5x + 4h
√x
___ __
1 __
3 dy
= __ = x 2 −2 = x− 2
x2 ___
x2 x2 2 dx
if y = 3x2 − 9x − 2
x2
__ 3 y = ( x − 3 ) ( 2x − 1 )
=1
x2
_____
4 − x __
= − __ = 4x− 1 − 1
4 x
4 [ x + 3x ]
x2 − x − 12
Dx __________
2
x x x __
dx ( )
3 2
___ x − 2x + x
d ____________ √
5 2
__
1 __
3 ____
4+3 ___
7 x
x 3 .x 4 = x 12 = x 12
s = ( t 2 − 3 ) ( t 2 + 2 ).
__
1 __
3
6
SOLUTIONS
1 f ’ ( x ) = 14x − 5
dy
___
2 dx
= 6x − 9
3 y = ( x − 3 ) ( 2x − 1 )
= 2x2 − 7x + 3
dy
___ = 4x − 7
dx
4 [
(x − 4)(x + 3)
Dx ____________
x x+3
( )
__
x ]
= Dx ( 1 − 4x−1 ) = 4x−2 = __2
4
5 ___
dx ( x3
− 2x2 + √ x
d ____________
x2
= ___
d
dx
−__
3
)__
5
(
x − 2 + x 2 = 1 − 2 x− 2 = 1 − _____5
__
3 3
2x 2
)
6 ( __
1
)
s = (t 2 − 3 ( t 2 + 2 ) = t 2 + 2t 2 − 3t 2 − 6
__
3 __
1 __
3
__ __
1 9 __1 9 __1
= 2t + t − 2 − __ t 2 = 2t + __ − __ t 2
ds 1
dt 2 __
1 2
t2
Write all the answers in this exercise with positive exponents. Use the rules of
differentiation to determine:
1
dy
___
dx
if y = 3x2 − __
2
x 2 [
x3 − x + 5
Dx _________
x ] REMEMBER
3 [
2x2 − 11x + 5
Dx ____________
2x − 1 ] 4
dy
___
dx
if y = ___
4
3x2
( 2x3 )−1 = ___
1
2x 3
2x−3 = __
2
3
__ x
5 ___
d (
5x − 2√ x )2 6 __
d ( 2
3t − 4t )
dx dt
x0 = 1
[ ] dy ___
d ( )
2
Dx _____________ ___
6x − 17x + 12 x =1
7 2 8 dx
if y = ( 5x − 2 )2 dx
3x − 4x
__ __
√
( ) Only drop the Dx notation
3
___ x5 − √ x
d _________
9 Dx[ ( 2x − 3 )3 ] 10 dx x in the step in which you
dy determine the derivative.
11 Dx[ ( x − 2 )(2x + 3 ] 12 ___ if y = 5x ( x − 3 )
dx If k is a constant, then
___
d ( )
k = 0.
dy
___ x2 dy __
2 __
1 dx
if y = ___ − __ ___
3
13 dx 2x 3
14 dx
if y = x 3 − x 2
dy __ __ ( t − 3 )3
15 ___ if y = √x2 − √x3
3 5
16 __
ds
if s = _______
_
dx dt √
3
t
__
[ ]
__ __
dy
___ √ x5 − 3x2 + 2√ x
17 if xy = √3 − 4x3 + __
1
x 18 Dx _______________
__
dx 3 √x
__ __
19 f ’ ( x ) if f ( x ) = ( √x − 3 ) ( 2√x + 3 ) 20 f ’(x) if f ( x ) = 2x5 − 3x4 + __
1 3
3
x −4
3x2 − 4x − 7
g ’ ( x ) if g ( x ) = ___________ ___
d [(
21 x+1
22 dx
2x − 3 ) ( 4x2 + 6x + 9 ) ]
__
3 __
1
23 f ’ ( t ) if f ( t ) = t 3 − 3t 2 − __
1
t 24 f ’ ( x ) if f ( x ) = 2x 2 − 5x 2 + __
2
__
1
x2
__ __
25 f ’ ( x ) if f(x) = ( √x − 2x ) 2x − ___
3__
√x ( ) 26
dy
___
dx
if y = ( 3x2 − √ x )2
f ’ ( x ) if f ( x ) = ( x 2 − 2 ) ( x 2 + 3 )
__
1 __
1
27 Dx[ [ ( x2 − 9 ) ( x2 − 3x + 9 ) ( x − 3 )−1 ] 28
Important rules
___ f x ± g ( x ) ] = ___
d ( )
f x ] ± ___
d ( ) d ( )
dx [ dx [
1 dx [
g x ]
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTION
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTION
3 ___
d
[ k f ( x ) ] = k___[ f ( x ) ]
d
dx dx
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
SOLUTION
⇒ ___[ k f ( x ) ] = k___[ f ( x ) ]
d d
dx dx
___ f x × g ( x ) ] ≠ ___
d ( )
f x ] × ___
d ( ) d ( )
dx [ dx [
4 dx [
g x ]
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
SOLUTION
[ ]
f(x) Remember that you can
Show that ___ f x ] ÷ ___ g x ] ≠ ___
d ( ) d ( ) d ____
dx [
1.4 dx [ dx g ( x ) factorise both a sum and
difference of cubes.
Show that ___ f x ] + ___ g x ] = ___
d ( ) d ( ) d ( )
dx [ dx [
1.5 dx [
f x + g ( x ). ] a3 + b3
= ( a + b ) ( a2 − ab + b2 )
2 Consider the functions f ( x ) = x2 − 4x and g ( x ) = 2x − 8. a3 − b3
2.1 Fully simplify each expression: = ( a − b ) ( a2 + ab + b2 )
___ f x − g ( x ) ] = ___
d ( )
f x ] − ___
d ( ) d ( )
dx [ dx [
2.3.2 dx [
g x ]
2.3.3 ___
d
[ k f ( x ) ] = k___[ f ( x ) ]
d
dx dx
___ f x × g ( x ) ] = ___
d ( )
f x ] × ___
d ( ) d ( )
dx [ dx [
2.3.4 dx [
g x ]
___[ f ( x ) ]
d
2.3.5 ___
[ ]
f(x)
d ____
dx g ( x )
= _______
dx
___
d ( )
g x ]
dx [
3.3 Simplify f ( x )g ( x ).
3.4 If h ( x ) = f ( x )g ( x ), determine h ’ ( −1 ).
3.5 Determine Dx[ p ( x ) + h ( x ) ] in two different ways.
x2 − 4
f ( x ) = ______and g ( x ) = _______
x+3
4 x+3 2 x − 2x
4.1 Determine f ( x ) × g ( x ).
4.2 If h ( x ) = f ( x )g ( x ), determine h ’ ( x ).
The derivative gives the gradient of a point on a curve and is therefore the gradient of
the tangent to the curve at the specified point.
f( x + h) − f( x)
The derivative is given by f ’ ( x ) = lim ____________
h
. You can determine the derivative by:
h→0
• using the definition, which means you are using first principles
• using the rule f ( x ) ⇒ f ’ ( x ) = anxn−1.
If you are asked to find the derivative but you are not told what method to use, then
use the rules.
Use the definition or first principles method only if you are instructed to do so.
WORKED EXAMPLE
SOLUTIONS
1 f ’ ( x ) = −2x + 2
2.1 m = f ’ ( −3 ) = −2 ( −3 ) + 2 = 8
y = f ( −3 ) = − ( −3) )2 + 2 ( −3 ) + 8 = −7
Substitute m = 8 and ( −3;−7 ) into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 )
y − ( −7 ) = 8 ( x − ( −3 ) ) ⇒ y + 7 = 8x + 24 and so y = 8x + 17
2.2 m = f ’ ( −2 ) = −2 ( −2 ) + 2 = 6
y = f ( −2 ) = − ( −2) )2 + 2 ( −2 ) + 8 = 0
Substitute m = 6 and ( −2;0 ) into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 )
y − 0 = 6 ( x − ( −2 ) ) ⇒ y = 6x + 12
2.3 m = f ’ ( 0 ) = −2 ( 0 ) + 2 = 2 and y = f ( 0 ) = 8
Substitute m = 2 and ( 0;8 ) into y = mx + c ⇒ y = 2x + 8
y = 2x + 8
y = –2x + 12
17
16
12
y=9
9
8 (1;9)
(2;8)
x
–6 –4 –2 2 4 6
(–3;–7)
–8
y = –x² + 2x + 8
5.1 x ∈ ( −∞;1 )
5.2 x ∈ ( 1;∞ )
5.3 x=1
6 Gradients of tangents are:
• 0 at the stationary points, so y = 9 indicates that (1;9) is a stationary point
• positive where the function increases and the gradients of the tangents
passing through x-values –3, –2 and 0 are all positive
• negative where the function decreases and the gradients of the tangents
passing through the x-values 2 and 4 are negative.
1.1 f ’ ( x ) = 2x − 2 = 2 ⇒ 2x = 4 and x = 2
y = f ( 2 ) = ( 2 )2 − 2 ( 2 ) − 15 = −15 ⇒ ( 2; − 15 )
Substitute m = 2 and ( 2;−15 ) into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 )
y − ( −15 ) = 2 ( x − 2 ) ⇒ y + 15 = 2x − 4 and y = 2x − 19
1.2 f ’ ( x ) = 2x − 2 = 0 ⇒ x = 1, y = f ( 1 ) = ( 1 )2 − 2 ( 1 ) − 15 = −16
EXERCISE 9
1 f ( x ) = __
2 3 2
x and g ( x ) = x + x − 8x
1.1 Determine f ’ ( x ) from first principles.
1.2 For which value(s) of x is f ’ ( x ) = −8?
1.3 Determine the equation of the tangent to f at x = –1.
1.4 Determine the equation(s) of the tangent(s) to g if g ’ ( x ) = 0.
1.5 Determine the equation(s) of the tangent(s) to g if g ’ ( x ) = −3.
1.6 Determine the equation of the tangent to g at x = 2.
1.7 Determine the equation of the tangent which is parallel to the tangent to g
at x = –3.
1.8 Determine the average gradient of f between x = –2 and x = 1.
1.9 Determine the average gradient of g between x = –1 and x = 2. f(x) = 2x² + x – 6 y
2 f ( x ) = 2x2 + x − 6 and g ( x ) = −3x2 − 10x − 8
2.1 For which value of x will the tangents to f and g be parallel to each other?
2.2 Determine the equation of each of the parallel tangents.
2.3 Determine the equation of the tangent to g if x = 1. x
Use the first derivative test to identify and classify stationary points.
• Determine the value(s) of x for which f ’ ( x ) = 0.
• Determine the sign of f ’ ( x ) for x < a, but close to a and for x > a, but close to a.
• If f ’ ( x ) has the same sign for x < a and for x > a, then ( a;f ( a ) ) is a point
of inflection.
• If f ’ ( x ) < 0 for x < a, but f ’ ( x ) > 0 for x > a then ( a;f ( a ) ) is a local minimum
and f is concave up.
• If f ’ ( x ) > 0 for x < a, but f ’ ( x ) < 0 for x > a then ( a;f ( a ) ) is a local maximum
and f is concave down.
f ’(x) > 0
f ’(x) = 0
f ’(x) = 0
f ’(x) < 0 f ’(x) > 0
f ’(x) > 0 f ’(x) < 0
f ’(x) = 0 f ’(x) > 0
minimum maximum point of inflection
Use the second derivative to determine the point(s) of inflection and concavity of a
function.
To determine point(s) of inflection:
• determine the value(s) of x for which f ” ( x ) = 0
• if f ”(a) = 0, determine the signs of f ” ( x ) for x < a but close to a and for x > a but
close to a
• if f ’ ( x ) changes sign, then ( a;f ( a ) ) is a point of inflection
To determine concavity, solve for x if f ’ ( x ) = 0:
• if f ’ ( a ) = 0, determine the sign of f ” ( a )
• if f ” ( a ) > 0, then f is concave up on that interval and ( a;f ( a ) ) is a local minimum
• if f ” ( a ) < 0, then f is concave down on that interval and ( a;f ( a ) ) is a local
maximum
• if f ” ( a ) = 0, test the sign of f ” ( x ) for x < a but close to a and for x > a but close to a.
local maximum
f ’’(x) < 0
f ’(x) = 0
f ’’(x) < 0
f ’’(x) > 0
f ’’(x) < 0
f ’’(a) = 0
f ’’(x) > 0
f ’(x) = 0
f ’’(x) > 0
local minimum
f ’(x) = 3x² + 6x – 9
y f(x) = x³ + 3x² – 9x – 27
local maximum 6
(–3;0)
x
–5 –4 –3 –2 –1 1 2 3 4 5
–9
(–1;–16)
point of inflection –18
–27
f “(x) = 6x + 6 (1;–32)
local minimum
SOLUTIONS
2 3 __
5. Consider the function f ( x ) = − __
3
x +1
2
x2 + 10x + 2.
5.1 Determine the coordinates of the stationary points of f.
5.2 Use the second derivative test to determine the concavity of f at each
stationary point. Then state whether the stationary point is a local
minimum or a local maximum.
5.3 Determine the coordinates of the point of inflection.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTIONS
( )
f ” −__ 2
3
= −14 < 0, so −__;____
2 400
3 27 ( )
is a local maximum and f is concave down
(
at −__ ) 2 ____
;
3 27
400
x
–2 1 6
(1,67;–10,59)
(4;–36)
5 f ( 10 ) = ( 10 )3 − 5 ( 10 )2 − 8 ( 10 ) + 12 = 412, so the maximum value is 412.
6 lim f ( x ) = − ∞
x→−∞
SOLUTIONS
(3;64)
37 g“(x) = 6x – 18
27
x
–1 3
–18
5 As x → ∞ , g ( x ) → ∞
6 From question 1 we know that g ’ ( x ) = 3x2 − 18x + 27 =3 ( x − 3 )2
Roots are (3;0), y-intercept is (0;27) and TP is (3;0).
7 g ’ ( x ) ≥ 0 for all values of x. Although x = 3 is the x coordinate of a stationary
point on g, there is neither a local minimum nor a local maximum when
x = 3. g ” ( x ) changes sign at x = 3, so there will be a point of inflection on
g when x = 3.
SOLUTIONS
1 f ’ ( x ) = −3x2 + 2x − 1 = 0 ⇒ 3x2 − 2x + 1 = 0
b2 − 4ac = ( −2) )2 − 4 ( 3 ) ( 1 ) = −8 < 0 ⇒ no real roots
f has no stationary points
2 f ” ( x ) = −6x + 2 = 0 ⇒ x = __ 1
3
and __
3 (
1 ___88
)
;− 27 is a point of inflection
3 f ” ( 0 ) = 2 > 0 and f ” ( 1 ) = −4 < 0, so f changes from concave up to concave
down at __
1
3 (
;−3___
7
27 )
4 f ( −1 ) = − ( −1) )3 + ( −1) )2 − ( −1 ) − 3 = 0 ⇒ −1 is a root and x − 1 is a factor.
x3 − x2 + x + 3 = 0 ⇒ ( x + 1 ) ( x2 − 2x + 3 ) = 0
x2 − 2x + 3 = 0 ⇒ b2 − 4ac = ( −2) )2 − 4 ( 1 ) ( 3 ) = −8 < 0 ⇒ no real roots
x = −1 is the only root
5 and 6 f “(x) = – 6x + 2 y
f(x) = –x³ + x² – x – 3 1
–
2 3
x
(13–;– 23–
–1 (
–3
(13–;– —
(
88
27
f ’(x) = –3x² + 2x – 1
Sketch each of the graphs below, showing the intercepts with the axes, the
coordinates of any stationary points and the coordinates of the point of inflection.
You may need to use the quadratic formula in questions 15–20.
1 f ( x ) = ( x − 2 )2 ( x + 3 ) 2 f ( x ) = __
1 3 __
3
x −1 2
x2 − 12x + 18
3 2
3 f ( x ) = −x − 3x + 4 4 f ( x ) = −4x − 13x2 − 10x
3
5 3 2
f ( x ) = −x − 2x + 7x − 4 6 f ( x ) = (2x + 1) ( 4x2 − 44x + 169 )
f ( x ) = __x3 − 2x2 + x + ___
62
7 3
4
3
8 f ( x ) = −__1 3
x + x2 − x3
9 f ( x ) = −4x3 + 23x2 − 40x + 21 10 f ( x ) = −x3 + 8
11 f ( x ) = 2x3 − 3x2 + 8x − 7 12 f ( x ) = x3 + 9x2 + 24x + 16
13 f ( x ) = ( x − 2 )3 14 f ( x ) = x3 − 4x
15 f ( x ) = __
1(
6
x − 3 ) ( 4x2 + 15x − 45 ) 16 f ( x ) = 4x3 + 37x2 + 110x + 104
17 f ( x ) = 2x3 − 2x2 − 5x − 1 18 f ( x ) = − __
1(
6
x + 2 ) ( 4x2 + 13x − 50 )
19 f ( x ) = __
1 3
3
x + x2 − 24x + 54 20 f ( x ) = 5x + 21x2 − 9x − 62
3
EXERCISE 12
Consider the functions below and answer the questions that follow for each function.
1 Determine and classify the stationary point(s).
2 Determine the point of inflection.
3 Discuss, with reasons, the concavity of f.
4 Determine the roots of f ( x ) = 0.
If you can find only one rational root:
• check whether the other roots are irrational or non-real, showing all necessary
calculations
• use the quadratic formula to determine the roots of the quadratic factor if
they are irrational.
5 Sketch f, showing the intercept(s) with the axes and the coordinates of a
stationary point(s) and the point(s) of inflection.
6 Sketch f ’ and f ” on the same set of axes as f.
7 Briefly discuss the relationship between f, f ’ and f ” by referring to the graphs.
8 Determine the minimum and maximum values of f ( x ) for x ∈ [ −5;5 ].
9 Use your graph to determine lim f ( x ) and lim f ( x ).
x→−∞ x→∞
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
f ( x ) = ax3 + bx2 + cx + d passes through these points: (−3;0), (−1;0), (0;−6) and
(4;0). Determine the values of a, b, c and d.
SOLUTION
= __
1( 3 –6
2
x − 13x − 12 )
= __
1 3 ___13
2
x − 2 x−6
a = __
1
2
, b = 0, c = −___
13
2
, d = −6
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTION
x
1 4 f ( x ) = a ( x − x1 ) ( x − x2 ) ( x − x3 )
f(x) = a(x − 1)(x − 1)(x − 4)
f(3) = 8 ⇒ 8
= a(3 − 1)(3 − 1)(3 − 4)
8 = −4a ⇒ a = −2
f ( x ) = −2 ( x2 − 2x + 1 ) ( x − 4 )
= −2 ( x3 − 6x2 + 9x − 4 )
= −2x3 + 12x2 − 18x + 8
a = −2, b = 12, c = −18 and d = 8
f is a cubic function.
Consider the sketch of the derivative of f, given by
f ’ ( x ) = ax2 + bx + c.
y
f ’(x)
x
2 4
SOLUTIONS
1 x = 2 and x = 4
2 f ’’ ( 2 ) < 0 so the graph is concave down at x = 2 and the stationary point
is a local maximum.
f ’’ ( 4 ) > 0 so the graph is concave up at x = 4 and the stationary point is
a local minimum.
3 Point of inflection when f ’’ ( x ) = 0 ⇒ x = 3.
4 y
2
4
x
SOLUTIONS
1 r = −8 2 f ’(x) = 3x² y
f ( 2 ) = 8 + 4p + 2q − 8 = 0
⇒ q = −2p (2;12) •
f ’ ( x ) = 3x2 + 2px + q and
f ” ( x ) = 6x + 2p
x
⇒ f ’’ ( 0 ) = 6 ( 0 ) + 2p = 0 ⇒ p = 0 (0;0) 2
q = 2(0) = 0 f “(x) = 6x
(0;–8)
p = 0, q = 0 and r = −8
f(x) = x³ – 8
WORKED EXAMPLE 5
SOLUTIONS
(–1;2)
x
– 3 (0;0)
3
(1;–2)
EXERCISE 13
8 y
x
2
g(x) = –x³ – 2x² + 11x + 12
Given g ( x ) = −x3 − 2x2 + 11x + 12.
8.1 Determine the equation of the tangent to g at x = 2.
8.2 Determine the coordinates of the point where the tangent intersects g(x) a
second time.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
SOLUTIONS
4,9 ( 7 )2 − 4,9 ( 2 )2
s ( 7 ) − s ( 2 ) _______________
1 average speed = _________ 7−2
= 5
= 44,1 m/s
2 velocity of stone = s’ ( t ) = 9,8t m/s
2.1 s’ ( 2 ) = 9,8 ( 2 ) = 19,6 m/s
REMEMBER
2.2 s’ ( 7 ) = 9,8 ( 7 ) = 68,6 m/s
You may have to convert 3 acceleration of stone = s” ( t ) = 9,8 m/s2
a word problem into a 9,8 m
_____
mathematical function so 3.1 3.2 9,8 m/s2
s2
that you can determine the 4 s ( t ) = 4,9t 2 m/s, s’ ( t ) = 9,8t m/s and s” ( t ) = 9,8 m/s2
minimum or maximum by
4.1 distance: s ( t ) = s ( 15 ) = 4,9 ( 15 )2 = 1 102,5 m
means of differentiation.
4.2 velocity: s’ ( t ) = 9,8 ( 15 ) = 147 m/s
• maximise volume, area,
profit
4.3 acceleration: s” ( t ) = 9,8 m/s2
• minimise area, volume,
cost, distance, time
30 10
4 2
10 5
15 10 12
The volume of each right prism is 600 units3, but their surface areas differ in spite of
their volumes being equal.
TSA Green prism = 500 units2
TSA Red prism = 760 units2
TSA Blue prism = 460 units2
Rather than determine the smallest area by trial and error, we use calculus.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTIONS
1
h
x
2x
1 ℓ = 1 000 cm3 ⇒ 3 ℓ = 3 000 cm3
V = area of base × perpendicular height = ( 2x ) ( x ) ( h ) = 2x2h
⇒ 2x2h = 3 000 and so h = _____
3 000 _____
1 500
2 = 2 2x x
2 (
TSA = 2 2x2 + x _____
1 500
x2
1
(
+ 2x _____
500
x2 ) (
= 4x2 + _____
9 000
x ))
3 A = 4x2 + 9 000x−1 ⇒ A ’ = 8x − 9 000x−2 = 0 at miminum
_____
8x3 − 9 000 = 0 ⇒ x3 = _____
9 000
=1 125 and x = √ 1 125 = 10,4 cm
3
8
13,87
10,4
20,8
SOLUTION
1 x 32 – 2x x
x
x x 20 – 2x
32 – 2x
20 – 2x
x x
x x
The length of the box is (32 – 2x) cm, the breadth is (20 – 2x) cm
and the height is x cm.
V = area of base × perpendicular height
= ( 32 − 2x ) ( 20 − 2x )x
= 640x − 104x2 + 4x3
V ’ = 640 − 208x + 12x2 = 0
⇒ 3x2 − 52x + 160 = 0
( x − 4 ) ( 3x − 40 ) = 0
x = 4 or x = ___
40 (
3
x < 10 because 20 − 2x > 0 )
x = 4 only
3 Maximum volume:
V = 640 ( 4 ) − 104 ( 4 )2 + 4 ( 4 )3
= 1 152 cm3
or
V = 24 × 12 × 4
= 1 152 cm3
SOLUTIONS
1 2πr + h = 21
⇒ h = 21 − 2πr
V = πr2h
= πr2 ( 21 − 2πr )
= 21πr2 − 2π2r3
2 V ’ = 42πr − 6π2r2 = 0
⇒ 2πr ( 21 − 3πr ) = 0
3πr = 21 and r = ___ 21 __
3π π
=
7
(r ≠ 0)
REMEMBER
3 V = 21πr2 − 2π2r3 The area of a circle is A = πr2
= 21π ( __ ) − 2π2 ( __ )
7 2 7 3 The circumference of a circle
π π
is C = 2πr
= _____ − ____ = ____
1 029 686 343
π π π The volume of a right cylinder
3 is V = πr2h
= 109,18 cm
The total surface area of a
4 A = 2πr2 + 2πrh, so we need to find a value for h in terms of r.
cylinder is A = 2πr2 + 2πrh
V = πr2h = 109,18
109,18
⇒ h = ______
πr2
A=
109,18
+ 2πr ______
2πr2
πr2 ( )
218,36
= 2πr2 + ______
r
= 2πr2 + 218,36r−1
218,36
⇒ A ’ = 4πr − 218,36r−2 = 4πr − ______ = 0 at minimum
r2
4πr3 − 218,36
______
=0
⇒r= √
218,36
3 ______
≈ 2,59 cm
4π
109,18
h = ________2 = 5,18 cm
π ( 2,59 )
Q T
–3 3
x
R –1 S(p;–1) g
f ( x ) = ax2 + bx + c and g ( x ) = k.
QRST is rectangle with T and Q on f and R and
S (p;–1) on g. f cuts the x-axis at –3 and 3 and the y-axis at 3.
1 Determine the values of a, b, c and k.
2 State the coordinates of Q, R and T in terms of p.
3 Show that the area of QRST is given by A = 8p − __2 3
3
p .
4 Determine the value of p for which the area of QRST is a maximum.
5 Determine the equation of the tangent to f at x = 3.
SOLUTIONS
1 f ( x ) = a ( x − x1 ) ( x − x2 )
= a(x − 3)(x + 3)
Substitute ( 0;3 )
⇒ 3 = −9a, so a = −__
1
3
f ( x ) = − ( x2 − 9 ) = −__
__
1
3
1 2
x +3 3
k = −1 ⇒ y = −1
2 (
Q −p;− __
1 2
3
p +3 )
R ( −p;−1 )
(
T p; − __
1 2
p +3 3 )
3 PQ = 2p and PT = −__
1 2
3
p +4
Area PQRT
(
= 2p − __p2 + 4
1
3 )
__
2 3
= − p + 8p
3
4 A = −__2 3
3
p + 8p
A ’ = −2p2 + 8 = 0
p2 = 4 ⇒ p = 2 (p > 0)
5 f ’ ( x ) = −__
2
3
x ⇒ m = f ’ ( 3 ) = −2
Substitute ( 3;0 ) into y − y1 = m ( x − x1 ):
y = −2 ( x − 3 ) = −2x + 6
f ( x ) = a ( x − p )2 + q and g ( x ) = kx2 + bx + c y
f has a turning point at (–1;32), g passes through (–1;32) g
(–8;0) and (0;–24)and f and g both pass through P
(3;0).
PQ is parallel to the y-axis, with P on f and Q on g. x
1 Determine the values of a, p, q, k, b and c. –8 3
2 Determine an expression for the length
of PQ in terms of x. –24
Q
3 Determine the value of x at which PQ f
is a maximum.
4 What is the maximum length of PQ?
SOLUTIONS
4
3 2
PQ = −3 − __
2 ( )
− 9 − __
3
2
+ 54 ( )
= −___ + ___ + 54
27 27
4 2
= 60,75
EXERCISE 14
B
x
21 cm
A C
The radii of the smallest circles is x cm and the ratio of the areas of the circles
is 1:4:16.
One of the dimensions of the large rectangle is 21 cm.
9.1 State the radii of circles A and B in terms of x.
9.2 State the dimensions of the large rectangle in terms of x.
9.3 Show that the area of the shaded region is A ( x ) = 294x − 27πx2.
9.4 Determine the value of x for which the shaded region is a maximum.
9.5 Determine the total area of the circles when the shaded region is
a maximum.
10 A company plans to manufacture buoys for a boat race. Each
buoy is made up of a hemisphere, a right cylinder and a cone. scone
hcone
The slant height of the cone forms an angle of 60° with the base, 60˚
the radius is r and the total surface area of the buoy is REMEMBER
5 400π cm2. H 2 3
Vhemisphere = __
3
πr
10.1 Express the slant height, s and the height, h of the cone in
r Vcylinder = πr2h
terms of r. 1 2
Vcone = __ πr h
10.2 Show that H, the height of the cylinder, is given by 3
H = _____
2 700
r − 2r. TSAhemisphere = 3πr 2
10.3 Show that the volume of the buoy is given by TSAcylinder = 2πr 2 + 2πrh
πr3 ( __
V = 2 700πr − ___3
4 − √3 ). TSAcone = πr 2 + πrs
10.4 Determine the value of r for which the volume will be a maximum.
10.5 Determine the maximum volume in litres.
1 x2 − 3x − 4
Consider the function: f( x ) = __________
x−4
1.1 For which value of x is f( x ) undefined? (2)
1.2 Complete the table below:
x 3,9 3,99 3,999 3,9999 4 4,0001 4,001 4,01 4,1
f( x ) (9)
1.3 Is there a limit at x = 4? Fully justify your answer. (3)
6 Use first principles to find the derivative of f( x ) = 2x3 at the point x = –3. (6)
7 Use first principles to find the derivative of g( x ) = −3x + 2 at the point x = 4. (3)
8 Use the definition to find the derivative of f( x ) = 5 and then determine f ’( 2 ). (3)
9 f( x ) = − __
2 and g( x ) = x3 + x2 − 21x
x
9.1 Determine f ’( x ) from first principles. (5)
9.2 For which value(s) of x is f ’( x ) = 2? (3)
9.3 Determine the equation of the tangent to f at x = __
1. (4)
2
9.4 Determine the equation(s) of the tangent(s) to g if g ’( x ) = 0. (4)
9.5 Determine the equation(s) of the tangent(s) for which g ’( x ) = 12. (4)
9.6 Determine the equation of the tangent to g at x = –2. (4)
9.7 Determine the equation of the tangent which is parallel to the tangent
to g at x = 1. (5)
184
( )
__
3 [
x3 − 3x2 − 10x
10.3 Dx ____________
2
x − 5x ] (6) 10.4 ___ x3 − x2__
dx
− √x
d ___________
3 √x
(5)
10.5.
dy
___ if y = − ___
2 d ( 2x − 3√__
(3) 10.6 ___ x )2 (6)
dx 5x3 dx
( )
__ __
√ x3 − √5
3
x
10.7 Dx[ ( 3x − 1 )3 ] (4) 10.8 ___
d _________
__ (6)
dx √ x
dy __
2 __
1
ds if s = (_______
t + _2 )3
10.9 ___ if y = x5 − x3 (3) 10.10 __ (4)
dx dt 3
√t
( )
__
10.11 ___
d [ ( 3x + 2 )( 9x2 − 6x + 4 ) ] (4) 10.12 f ’( x ) if f(x) = ( √x + 1 ) x − ___
1__ (4)
dx √ x
11 Consider the function g( x ) = __
1 x3 − 2x2 − 32x + 33__
2.
3 3
11.1 Determine the coordinates of the stationary points of g. (6)
11.2 Use the second derivative test to determine the concavity of g at
each stationary point. Then state whether the stationary point is
a local minimum or a local maximum. (6)
11.3 Determine the coordinates of the point of inflection. (4)
16 f ′( x ) is sketched alongside. y
16.1 State the x-coordinates of the stationary points f ’(x)
of f and classify the stationary points. (6)
x
16.2 State the x-coordinate of the point of inflection –2 4
and justify your answer. (4)
16.3 Discuss the concavity of f and explain your –4
P
answers fully. (6)
16.4 Draw a sketch of f. (4)
16.5 What is the gradient of the tangent to f at x = 0? (3)
16.6 State another value of x at which the tangent to f will be parallel
to the tangent at x = 0. (4)
185
18 A ball is thrown into the air. Its height above the ground after t seconds is
h(t ) = −t 2 + ___
63 t + 1 metres.
8
18.1 When will the ball be 12,75 m above the ground? (3)
18.2 How high will the ball be after one second? (2)
18.3 When will the ball be at a height of 16,5 m above the ground? (3)
18.4 When will the instantaneous speed of the ball be −12,125 ms −1? (4)
18.5 After how many seconds will the ball reach its maximum height? (3)
18.6 Determine the maximum height which the ball can reach. (4)
18.7 Determine the speed of the ball during the third second. (3)
18.8 Is the speed of the ball during the third second an average speed or
an instantaneous speed? (??)
18.9 Determine the height of the ball above the ground after three seconds. (2)
18.10 Is the speed of the ball after the third second an average speed or
an instantaneous speed? (1)
18.11 Determine the speed of the ball at that after three seconds. (3)
18.12 Determine the acceleration of the ball after three seconds. (4)
18.13 How long will it take for the ball to hit the ground? (2)
18.14 Determine the speed at which the ball will be travelling when it hits
the ground. (3)
19 Thandi throws a ball into the air from the branch of a tree which he has
climbed. The height of the ball above the ground after t seconds is
h( t ) = −4t 2 + 19,2t + 4 metres.
19.1 Determine the height of the ball above the ground after two seconds. (3)
19.2 Determine the average speed of the ball during the first two seconds. (3)
19.3 When will the ball be at a height of 26,4 m above the ground? (3)
19.4 How long will it take for the ball reach its maximum height? (3)
19.5 Determine the maximum height reached by the ball. (2)
19.6 After how many seconds will the ball hit the ground? (3)
19.7 At what speed was the ball travelling at the moment of impact? (3)
19.8 What was the velocity of the ball after 2,4 seconds? Briefly explain
your answer. (4)
186
P
A
x
QB
f(x) = – (x – 5)(x + 3)
23 The straight line cuts the axes at (0;12) and (4;0). BADO is a rectangle with A
on the line, B and D on the x- and y-axes y
respectively and O at the origin.
12
23.1 Determine the coordinates of A E
for which the rectangle will have a
maximum area. (6)
D A
23.2 Then determine the sum of the
F
minimum areas of the triangles △EDA x
O B 4
and △ABF. (6)
187
2 9 Analytical geometry
Unit 1: Equations of a circle
You learnt these analytical formulae in Grade 11: _________________
• The distance between points A(x1; y1) and B(x2; y2) = √(x2 − x1)2 + ( y2 − y1 )2
y −y
• The gradient between points A(x1; y1) and B(x2; y2) = ______
2
x −x
1
2 1
• (
x1 + x2 ______
The midpoint between points A(x1; y1) and B(x2; y2) = ______
2
y + y2
; 1
2 )
• You can find the equation of a line using the formula:
* y = mx + c when you know the c value (y-intercept)
* y − y1 = m( x − x1 )for any line passing through point ( x1;y1 )
• You find the inclination of a line (angle θ) using the formula: tan θ = m
SOLUTIONS
( 2
So centre = _____
2 − 2 ; ________
−4 + 10
2 )= ( 0; 3 ) and
__________________
in place of a and b, and
not x and y. REMEMBER
r = __
1 √ ( −2 − 2 )2 + ( 10 + 4 )2
2
________ ___
= __
1 √ 16 + 196 = √ 53
2
So the equation : radius
___
( x − 0 )2 + ( y − 3 )2 = (√ 53 )2
∴ x2 + ( y − 3 )2 = 53
4 Substitute the points (2;0) and (0;6) into ( x − a )2 + ( y − b )2 = r2 diameter
__ __
∴ ( 2 − a )2 + ( 0 − b )2 = ( 2√ 5 )2 and ( 0 − a )2 + ( 6 − b )2 = ( 2√ 5 )2
∴ 4 − 4a + a2 + b2 = 20 and a2 + 36 − 12b + b2 = 20
2 2
∴ a − 4a + b = 16 ➀ and a2 − 12b + b2 = −16 ➁
∴ ➀ − ➁: − 4a + 12b = 32
∴ −a + 3b = 8
∴ a = 3b − 8 ➂
Substitute ➂ into ➁: ( 3b − 8 )2 − 12b + b2 = −16
∴ 9b2 − 48b + 64 − 12b + b2 = −16
∴ 10b2 − 60b + 80 = 0
∴ b2 − 6b + 8 = 0
∴ ( b − 4 )( b − 2 ) = 0
∴ b = 4 or b = 2
Substitute into ➂ ∴ a = 4 or −2
∴ circle centre = ( 4; 4 ) or ( −2; 2 )
x2 − 2x + 1 + y2 + 10y + 25 = 9
∴ x2 − 2x + y2 + 10y = −17
If the equation is given in this multiplied out form, first write the equation in the
form ( x − a )2 + ( y − b )2 = r2 to determine the centre and the radius of the circle. You
do this using the process of completing the square.
So, taking the example given above and working in reverse order:
= ( __ )
1 × −2 = 1 = ( __ )
1 × 10 = 25
2 2
square trinomial, where the 2 2
coefficient of the first term is 1,
is always the square of __ 1 the
2 Now form both perfect squares, so
coefficient of the middle term.
x2 − 2x + 1 + y2 + 10y + 25 = −17 + 1 + 25
___
same same √ 25
__
√1
sign sign
∴ ( x − 1 )2 + ( y + 5 )2 = 9
SOLUTIONS
∴ x2 + 8x + 16 + y2 − 3y + __9 = −6 + 16 + __ 9
4 4
∴ ( x + 4 )2 + y − __ (
3 2 = ___
2
49
4 )
So centre is −4; __( )
3 and radius = __
2
7
2
4 2x2 + 2y2 + 6x − 5 = 0
∴ x2 + y2 + 3x − __5=0 | Coefficient of x2 and y2 must be 1 so divide
2
by 2.
∴ x2 + 3x + __
9 + y2 = __
4
5 + __
2
9
4
| __ (
1 coefficient of x
2 ) = ( __21 × 3 )
2 2
= __
9
4
(
∴ x + __
2 )
3 2 + y2 = ___
19
4 ___
So the centre is at −__
3
2
; 0 (
and the )
radius is
√ 19
____
2
You need to recognise that an equation of the form cx2 + dx + cy2 + ey = f will
represent a circle.
Notice that:
• the coefficient of x2 and y2 must be the same.
• if d = e = 0 then the centre of the circle will be the origin.
•
f
the value of _ + __d 2 + __
c ( 2c ) ( 2c )
e 2 must be positive, as it represents r2.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
y
Determine the equation(s) of the tangent(s)
to the circle where: Tangent perpendicular to
1 x2 + y2 = 20 at the point (2;− 4) radius
2 x2 − 5x + ( y + 3 )2 = 1 at the
y-intercept(s) of the given circle.
SOLUTIONS x
O
= −__ = −2 ∴ m
4
1 mradius = __
1
2 tangent 2
y − y1 = m( x − x1 ) using point ( 2;−4 )
∴ y − ( −4 ) = __
1 (x − 2) (2;– 4)
2
__
1
y= x−5
2
2 First find the centre of the circle:
x2 − 5x + ( y + 3 )2 = 1
∴ x2 − 5x + __
2 ( )
5 2 + y + 3 2 = 1 + __
( ) ( )
5 2
2
(
∴ x − __
2
()
5 2 + y + 3 2 = ___
) 29
4 tangent B
y
tangent A
∴ centre = __5 ;−3
(2 )
Next find the co-ordinates of the x
y-intercepts:
y-intercept (let x = 0): ( y + 3 )2 = 1 −2
∴ y + 3 = ± 1 ∴ y = −2 or − 4
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
SOLUTION y
The __________
distance from (−3;4) to (0; 0) 3
___
= √ (−3)2 + ( 4 )2 = √ 25 = 5
x
Radius of circle ( x + 3 )2 + ( y − 4 )2 = 4 is 2 (0;0)
and radius of circle x2 + y2 = 9 is 3
The distance between the centres of the circles is
2+3=5
So the circles will touch. Note: Circles will touch when the
distance between their centres is
equal to the sum of their radii.
WORKED EXAMPLE 4 y
SOLUTION
M (2;– 5)
x2 + y2 − 4x + 10y = 7
( )
x2 − 4x + __ ( )
4 2 + y2 + 10y + ___
2
10 2 = 7 + 4 + 25
2
( x − 2 )2 + ( y + 5 )2 = 36
∴ centre = M = ( 2;−5 ) and radius = 6
_______________ _______ ____
Distance MQ = √ ( 8 − 2 )2 + ( 3 + 5 )2 = √36 + 64 = √ 100 = 10
∴ PQ = 8 units | Pythagoras’ Theorem
SOLUTION N
There are two possible tangents from point T, as shown in the diagram. x
O
Let N = (p, q).
Similarly to the working below, this simplifies to: Notice that the calculations for a and p gave the same
∴ a2 − 2a − 3 = 0 answers, so we need only have done one calculation for
∴ ( a − 3 )( a + 1 ) = 0 both results.
= −__ and mTN = _______
1
∴ a = 3 or a = −1 ∴ mTM = _______
−5 + 3 −5 − 1
= −3
5+1 3 5−3
After checking a = −1 only, so M = (−1;−3)
REMEMBER
If __
a = __
c then ad = bc
b d
_______
y2 − y1 − 5 − √10 − p2
Note: Since O = (0; 0) and But using _______
x2 − x1 , mTN =
_______________
_______ 5−p
_______
N = (p; q) = (p;√ 10 − p2 ), − p − 5 − √ 10 − p2
then ∴ _________
_______ = _______________
_______ _______ √10 − p2 5−p
√10 − p2 − 0 _________
√10 − p2 _______
mON = ____________ = p ∴ − 5p + p2 = −5√10 − p2 − ( 10 − p2 )
p−0 _______
and perpendicular gradients are negative reciprocals, ⇒ 5√10 − p2 = 5p − 10
thus ∴ 25( 10 − p2 ) = 25p2 − 100 p + 100 ∴ 50p2 − 100p − 150 = 0
−p
mTN = _________
_______ ∴ p2 − 2p − 3 = 0 ⇒ ( p − 3 )( p + 1 ) = 0
√10 − p2
∴ p = 3 or p = −1
After check p = 3 only.
So N = (3; 1)
WORKED EXAMPLE
SOLUTION
normal
2x2 − 2x + 2y2 + 6y = 8 tangent
⇒ x2 − x + y2 + 3y = 4
⇒ x2 − x + __
1 + y2 + 3y + __
9
(1;1)
4 4 x
= 4 + __
1 + __
9
4 4
(
∴ x − __
2 ) ( )
1 2 + y + __3
2
2
= ___
26
4
∴ centre = __ ( )
1 ;−__
2 2
3
−__ − 1
3 ___
−5
mnormal = mradius = _______
2
= ___
2
=5
1 __ − 1
1
−__
2 2
∴ y − y1 = m( x − x1 ) ⇒ y − 1 = 5 (x − 1)
∴ y = 5x − 4
EXERCISE 2
1 Find the equation of the tangent and the normal to each circle at the given point
on the circle.
1.1 x2 + y2 = 13 at ( −3; 2 )
1.2 3y2 = 15 − 3x2 at ( 2; 1 )
1.3 ( x − 2 )2 + ( y + 3 )2 = 4 at ( 2;−1 )
2 Determine the equation of the circle with centre (−3;5) and passing through
198
199
200
16 A(0;2), B(−3;−5), C(9;1) and D(x; y) are the vertices of parallelogram ABCD with circumcircle of a triangle
D in the first quadrant. − the circle that passes
through all of the vertices of
16.1 Determine the coordinates of D. (4)
that triangle
16.2 Show that the diagonals of ABCD bisect each other. (3)
16.3 Determine the equation of the perpendicular bisector of AB. (5)
16.4 Determine the equation of the altitude of △ABC from point A. (4)
16.5 Determine the equation of line CA. (4)
16.6 Determine the angle of inclination of AC. (3)
16.7 If B lies on the circumference of a circle with centre at A, find:
16.7.1 the equation of the circle (4)
16.7.2 the equation of the tangent to this circle at B (4)
16.7.3 the point of intersection of this tangent and CA produced. (5)
17 Determine whether the straight line x + y = 5 cuts the circle with centre (2;5)
and radius 1 unit. (6)
201
Question 1
1.1 Solve for x, correct to two decimal places where necessary:
1.1.1 ( 2x − 3 )( x − 1 ) = 0 (2)
1.1.2 3x + 1 = ___ 10
x (5)
1.1.3 ( x − 3 )( 3x + 5 ) > x − 3 (5)
1.2 Show that x2 − 6x + 10 = 0 has no real roots. (3)
1.3
Question 2
2.1 Consider the quadratic pattern 0; − 6; −14; −24; −36 and determine the nth term
in the sequence if the pattern continues in the same way. (5)
2.2 The second term of an arithmetic sequence is 13 and the sum of the first and
fifth terms is 16. Determine the first term and the common difference of the
sequence. (5)
2.3 Consider the geometric sequence given by 5x + 1; 4x − 4; 3x − 5.
2.3.1 Solve for x. (5)
2.3.2 If x = 7, determine the sum to infinity. (3)
n
Question 4
Consider the functions f( x ) = _____
3 − 1, g( x ) = − __
1 ( x − 3 )2 + 2 and
x−2 2
h( x ) = 4 × 2 x − 3
− 2.
4.1 For which values of x and y is f( x ) = g( x )? (6)
4.2 Solve for x if h( x ) = 2. (3)
4.3 Draw f, g and h on the same set of axes, clearly indicating the x- and
y-intercepts, the turning point(s), the asymptotes and the symmetry lines. (9)
[18]
Question 5
Consider the functions f( x ) = 2x2 and g( x ) = 2 x .
5.1 How must the domain of f be restricted so that f − 1( x ) is a function. (2)
5.2 State f − 1( x ) for each option stated in 5.2. (4)
5.3 State g− 1( x ) in the form y = ... (2)
5.4 h is the reflection of f in the x-axis. State the equation of h. (1)
5.5 Sketch f, g, g − 1 and h on the same system of axes. Show the intercepts with
the axes and the coordinates of any turning points. Show at least 3 points
on each graph. (8)
[17]
Question 6
6.1 Determine f ’( x ) from first principles if f( x ) = −x2 + 3. (5)
dy __
6.2 Determine ___ if y = 3x3 − 4x + √x + 5. (4)
dx
6.3 Determine Dx __________
x+1 [
x2 − 3x − 4 .
] (3)
6.4 The function f( x ) = ax3 + bx2 + cx + d is sketched below. The stationary points
of f( x ) are P( −2;32 ) and Q( 2;0 ) and the y-intercept is R(0;16).
R(0;16)
x
Q(2;0)
4 3
h
r
B
C
Question 8
Eighty Grade 12s were asked to fill in a survey form about their plans for the
following year.
20 planned to travel (T)
30 planned to work (W)
40 planned to study (S)
6 planned to work and travel
9 planned to study and travel
7 planned to study and work
8 had no plans to study, work or travel
Let the number of Grade 12s who planned to work, study and travel be x.
8.1 Draw a Venn diagram to represent the information about the learners. (6)
8.2 Solve for x. (3)
8.3 Determine the probability that one of these learners, selected at random:
8.3.1 will work and study, but not travel (2)
8.3.2 will travel, but neither work nor study (2)
8.3.3 will neither work, study nor travel. (2)
[15]
Question 1
The individual masses of 30 Grade 12 boys are recorded below:
59 63 66 66 67 67 68 69 72 72
74 74 75 75 78 79 80 84 84 85
85 86 89 92 92 98 99 101 104 108
50 ≤ x < 60
60 ≤ x < 70
70 ≤ x < 80
80 ≤ x < 90
90 ≤ x < 100
(4)
1.4 Draw an ogive (cumulative frequency curve) of the information in
the table. (4)
1.5 Use your ogive to determine an estimate for the median mass and
indicate on the ogive where the reading was taken. (2)
1.6 Use your ogive to determine the mass which should be used to
determine the heaviest 20% of the boys. Indicate on the ogive where
you took your reading. (2)
[20]
x
O C
E
A D
M is the centre of the circle which passes through A(−6;−2), B(0;6) and D.
BC is a tangent to the circle at B and AO passes through the origin.
2.1 State the coordinates of M. (2)
2.2 Determine the equation of the circle. (4)
2.3 Determine the length of BD. (3)
2.4 Determine the equation of BC. (3)
2.5 Determine the coordinates of C. (2)
2.6 Show that AB = BC. (4)
2.7 Determine the area of △ ABC (4)
2.8 Determine the equation of AC. (3)
2.9 Determine the coordinates of E. (7)
2.10 Determine the size of BA ^ O, correct to one decimal place. (5)
2.11 Determine the equation of the circle passing through A, B and C. (4)
[41]
Question 3
3.1
C
D
G
H K
Z
T
J
W
L P M
H, J, K, L, M, N, V and W lie on the circumference of the circle.
HK and LP intersect at G.
JK crosses NP at T and VW at Z. H^ = LP^ N = 90ο, LP = PM and VZ = ZW.
LM = 14 units, JK = 50 units and ZK = 10 units.
3.2.1 Prove that T is the centre of the circle. (6)
3.2.2 Determine, with reasons, the length of TP. (3)
3.2.3 Determine, with reasons, the length of VW. (3)
[18]
Question 4
4.1 D
E F
1 2
1 D
O
x
A
Two circles intersect at B and D. A and E lie on the larger circle with centre O.
^ = x.
C and O lie on the smaller circle. A
4.2.1 Prove that BC = CE. (7)
4.2.2 Is ABCD a cyclic quadrilateral? Justify your answer. (3)
[15]
20°
G
1 2 34
3 2
C 40° 1 D
Question 6
cos ( 360° + x ) − tan ( 180° − x ) sin ( 360° − 2x ) cos ( −x )
6.1 Consider ______________________________________________
( )
= cos 2x
sin 90° + x
Questions 7
sin 3x − ______
7.1 Simplify the expression fully: ______ cos 3x (4)
cos x sin x
Topic 6 Topic 7
Trigonometry: Problem solving in Functions: Polynomials
two and three dimensions • Polynomials:
The basic definitions: Use when you have a 90° For a linear or 1st degree polynomial the standard
triangle form is ax + b.
opposite adjacent opposite
sinA = __________ cos A = __________ tan A = ________ For a quadratic or 2nd degree polynomial the
hypotenuse hypotenuse adjacent
standard form is ax2 + bx + c.
When the triangle is not For a cubic or 3rd degree polynomial the standard
A
right-angled, choose form
between: is ax3 + bx2 + cx + d.
The sine rule: Use this rule c b • Polynomial functions:
when you have SSA y = ax + b is a linear function or straight line
or ASA. graph.
_____
a = _____
b = _____c B a C y = ax2 + bx + c is a quadratic function or
sin A sin B sin C
parabola.
____
sin
or a = A _____
sin B = _____
sin C
b c y = ax3 + bx2 + cx + d is a cubic function.
• Factorising cubic polynomials − this can be done
The cosine rule: Use this rule when you have SAS using:
or SSS.
• common factors, grouping or sum/difference of
a2 = b2 + c2 − 2bc cos A or b2 = a2 + c2 − 2ac cos B cubes
or c2 = a2 + b2 − 2ab cos C
• the remainder or factor theorem.
b2 + c2 − a2 or cos B = __________
cos A = __________ a2 + c2 − b2 or
2bc 2ac • The Remainder Theorem: If a polynomial f (x) is
a2 + b2 − c2 divided by ax + b , then the remainder will be
cos C = __________
2ab f (− __
b
a ).
• Or more simply, when you divide a polynomial
The area rule: Use this rule when you have SAS.
f (x) by (x − a) the remainder is f(a).
Area △ABC = __ 1 ab sin C = __
1 ac sin B = __
1 bc sin A
2 2 2 • The Factor Theorem: If a polynomial is divided by
ax + b,and the remainder = 0, then ax + b is a
Remember:
factor of the polynomial.
Or if f (− __b
a ) = 0, then ax + b is a factor of f (x)
or if f (a) = 0 then x − a is a factor of f (x).
angle of elevation You have seen that a cubic polynomial has three
horizontal
factors. A cubic equation will therefore have three
angle of depression
solutions and its graph will have three roots.
Topic 8
Differential calculus
• When a function is undefined for a particular
value x it is important to know how the function
behaves near to the value of x for which it is
undefined.
A function has a limit if it approaches the same value
on either side of the undefined value.
A function does not have a limit if it approaches
different values on either side of the undefined value.
• The average gradient between points A and B on
y −y
any curved graph = mAB = ______
2
x −x
1
2 1
Note:
___
d k f( x ) = k___
[ ] d f( x ) ;___
[ d f( x ) ± g( x ) = ___
] dx [ ] dxd f( x ) ± ___
[ ] dxd
dx dx
[ g( x ) ]
BUT ___ d f( x ) × g( x ) ≠ ___
[ ] d [ f( x ) ] × ___
d g( x )
[ ]
dx dx dx
Topic 9
Analytical geometry
• Formulae from Grade 11:
_________________
The distance formula: √ (x2 − x1)2 + ( y2 − y1 )2
Equation of line: y = mx + c or
y − y1 = m( x − x1 ) for any line passing through
point ( x1;y1 )
• Circle centred at the origin: x2 + y2 = r
• Circle centred at (a; b): (x − a)2 + (y − b)2 = r2
Use completing the square to get the equation into
this standard form.
• Equation of a tangent to a circle:
Remember that a radius is always perpendicular to
the tangent at the point of contact.
First find the gradient of the radius (from centre to
the point of contact); the perpendicular gradient
will be the gradient of the tangent. (Perpendicular
gradients have product = −1.)
Then substitute the coordinates of the point of
contact, and the gradient into y − y1 = m( x − x1 )
• A normal is the line perpendicular to the tangent at
the point of contact.
212
213
2 10 Euclidean geometry
Unit 1: Grade 11 geometry revision
O O
A K B A R B
AK = KB | OK ⊥ AB OR ⊥ AB
| line from centre to midpoint chord
E
F A R
D P Q
A 0
0 D
B C
B
^=F
E ^ | Equal chords AB & CD C
BO^ C = 2A^ | ∠ at centre
^ =D
A ^ | ∠s on chord BC
^ ^
Reflex O = 2R | ∠ at centre
D D
E G
O E G
^ = 90° | ∠ on diameter
D F
^ = 180°
^+G
E
| opposite ∠s cyclic quadrilateral
G
O
E
F
H
^H = D
^ | exterior ∠ cyclic quadrilateral A
GF B
C
^ C = 90°
OB | Radius ⊥ tangent
G
E
1 2
D E A 3
DEFG is a cyclic quadrilateral B
| DE subtends equal ∠s at F & G
C
^ =E
B ^ | tan AB, chord BD
1
^ ^ | tan BC, chord BE
B3 = D
T
M A
x
P
180°– x
B
N V
MNVT is a cylic quadrilateral PA = PB | tangents from common point P
| opposite ∠s supplementary
A
C
D
A B B
D C E
^ B = 90°
AB is the diameter | AC
ABCD is a cyclic quadrilateral
| exterior DC^ E = interior opposite A
^
EXERCISE 1
O is the centre of the circle in the first 12 questions. Determine, with reasons, w, x, y
and z.
You must determine the angles alphabetical order. Determine only w in 4, 5, 6, 8 and 10.
In question 10, x, y and z indicate the lengths of the sides of ∆OPR.
1 D 2 E 3 N
A 126° x x
C
z
y
O
Oz O M
110° y 40°
H J
x F z
v
G
K
L
D
13.5 Prove that OGFH is a cyclic quadrilateral. 3
x
1 2
circle.
14.1 Determine, with reasons, 4 other angles equal
to x.
14.2 Prove that QR || NQ.
3 2
x
4 1
5
V
1 2
^ =F
ABCDE ||| FGHIJ ⇒ A ^, B ^, C
^=G ^ =H
^, D
^ = ^I , E
^ = ^J and ___
AB = ____
BC = ___
CD = ___
DE = ___
AE .
FG GH HI IJ FJ
Two polygons are similar if and only if their corresponding sides are in proportion
and their corresponding angles are equal.
WORKED EXAMPLE
Consider each sketch below and state whether the polygons are similar or not.
Justify your answers with suitable reasons.
1 E 4 H
A 3 D
2 3 3
2
B 3 C F 4 G
2 E 8 H
y x
A 4 D 10
y x 10
5
5
x y x y
B 4 C F 8 G
3 P
KEY WORDS 2 2
T
similar polygons – polygons Q S
which have the same shape 3 3
as each other, but may be U W
different in size 5 5
corresponding sides – the 4 4
sides which join equal angles
corresponding angles – the
R V
angles which join sides which
are in proportion
SOLUTIONS
EXERCISE 2
1 Consider each figure below and state whether the polygons are similar or not.
Justify your answers with suitable reasons. REMEMBER
1.1 E 57 H
Two polygons are similar if:
A 38 D • the corresponding angles
are equal
51 34 20 30
• the corresponding sides are
x y in proportion.
x B 80 C y
F 120 G A parallelogram is a
quadrilateral with both pairs
of opposite sides parallel.
1.2 A D E H A rhombus is a parallelogram
with equal sides.
A rectangle is a parallelogram
with a right angle.
A square is a rectangle with
equal sides.
60°
B 3 C F 4 G
1.3 P S
157° 23°
T V
157° 23°
23° 157° 157°
Q R U
H
G
A
C
B
1.5 E 2x D
154° 50°
3k
I x H
A 2k 154° 50°
117° 3y
2y
F 117°
133°
133°
86° C
G
B
2 State whether the statements below are true or false. Justify your answers.
2.1 If two polygons are equiangular, they will be similar.
2.2 Two rectangles are always similar to each similar.
2.3 Two squares are always similar to each other.
2.4 Two parallelograms are always similar to each other.
2.5 Two rhombuses are always similar to each other.
2.6 If the sides of two quadrilaterals are proportional, the quadrilaterals
will be equiangular.
h1 h2 h3
h1
h2 h3
V S A T B U W
In the sketch above, AB is the base of three different triangles, that is,
△PAB, △QAB and △RAB.
The triangles have equal heights since P, Q and R all lie on the line PR, which is
parallel to base AB.
Area △PAB = __ 1 AB × h , Area△QAB = __
1
1 AB × h and Area △RAB = __
2
1 AB × h .
3
2 2 2
Area △PAB = Area △QAB = Area △RAB | common base AB, same height, AB || PQR
Triangles with different bases, but equal heights are not equal in area. The ratio of
their areas is equal to ratio of the lengths of their bases.
△PVA, △PAB and △RBW have bases VA, AB and BW on the line VW, which is parallel
to PR. The third vertex of each of these triangles lies on PR, so they have equal
heights.
Area △PVA : Area △PAB : Area △RBW=__ 1
VA × h : __
1 AB × h :__
2
1 BW × h = VA: AB: BW
1 2 3
2 2
In the sketch alongside, A
A
is the common vertex of
△ABC and △ADC.
If two triangles have a
common vertex and their KEY WORDS
bases lie on the same
B C E D vertex – the point at which
straight line, then the ratio
of their areas is equal to the ratio of their bases. two straight lines meet to
form an angle
In the sketch alongside, A is a common vertex and BC and CD lie on the same straight line. common vertex – the point
__
1 BC × AE
Area △ABC = _________
___________ at which three or more lines
2
= ___
BC | The height AE is common
Area △ACD __
1 CD × AE CD meet to form two or more
2
angles
__
1 AE × h
Area △AED = _________
___________ 2 1
= ___
AE | Common vertex D, same height h 1
Area △ACD __
1 AC × h AC
2 1
⇒ ___
AD = ___
AE
AB AC
Finally, we can also prove that ___
AB = ___
AC
DB EC
__
1 AB × h
REMEMBER Area △ABE = _________
__________ 2 2
= ___
AB | Common vertex E, same height h 2
Area △DBE 1 __ DB × h DB
2 2
When we divide two numbers
the result is a ratio, so __
1 AC × h
Area △ACD = _________
___________ 2 1
= ___
AC | Common vertex D , same height h 1
4 ÷ 12 = ___
4 = __1 = 1:3.
Area △ECD __
1 EC × h EC
12 3 1
When two ratios are equal, 2
they are in proportion, Area △DBE = Area △ECD | Common base DE, same height, DE || BC
so __
4 = ___
8 is an example of a
Area△ABE = Area △ACD | Area △ADE is common and
5 10
simple proportion.
Area △DBE = Area △ECD
When two ratios are unequal,
Area △ABE = ___________
__________ Area △ACD | Area △ADE is common and
they are not in proportion. Area △DBE Area △ECD
Area △ABE = Area △ACD
⇒ ___
AB = ___
AC
DB EC
B G B G
C H C H
D J D J
E K E K
Figure 1 Figure 2
SOLUTIONS
1.1 ___
AD = ___
AE | Proportionality theorem, DE || BC
DB EC
___
AD = ___
15 ⇒ AD = ___
60 = 10 units
4 6 6
1.2 ___
AB = ___
AC | Proportionality theorem, DE || BC
AD AE
___ = ___ ⇒ 12AB = 144 and AB = 12 units
AB 16
9 12
1.3 ___
AD = ___
AE | Proportionality theorem, DE || BC
DB EC
AD = AB – DB = 11 units – 3 units = 8 units
__
8 = ___
16 ⇒ 8EC = 48 and EC = 6 units
3 EC
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
P Z S
PQRS is a parallelogram.
Diagonals PR and QS intersect at T.
T
PZ = 25 units, RS = 40 units and U W
WR = 6 units. V is a point on QR Q V R
such that QV : VR = 2 : 1 .
Determine, with reasons, the length of:
2.1 TZ 2.2 QR
2.3 PR 2.4 ___
PU
UV
SOLUTIONS
D
F
E
B G C
SOLUTIONS
Use x, y and z to indicate the
A ratio relationships.
3y
3z 0
D
7y
5y 3y
F Note: ___
BG = __
5 = ___
5x and ___
AD = __
3 = ___
E 2y GC 2 2x DC 7 7y
5z
B 5x G 2x C
3.1 ___
AD = __
3 | Given
DC 7
___
DE = ___
BG | GE || BD, proportionality theorem
EC GC
= __
5 | Given
2
AD : DE : EC = 3 : 5 : 2
___
AF = ___
AD | FD || GE, proportionality theorem
FG DE
=__
3
5 REMEMBER
^D = θ
3.2 Let FA
__
1 AF×AD × sinθ You can determine the area of
Area △AFD = ______________
__________ 2
Area △AGE __
1 AG×AE × sinθ Make sure that you use common a triangle with the area rule:
2 ^D
angle FA Area △ABC = __ 1 ab sin C
2
= ___
AF × ___
AD
= __
1
bc sin A
AG AE 2
= __
1
ac sin B
= __
3 × __
3 = ___
9 2
8 8 64
= 0,36
1.
A
4
8
F
6
D E
B C
FE || DC and DE || BC. AF = 4 cm, DF = 6 cm and AE = 8 cm.
1.1 Determine, with reasons:
1.1.1 the length of EC
1.1.2 the length of AB
1.2 Determine Area △AFE: Area △ABC.
2
P
A T
Q R
PQ 7
W is the midpoint of PR. ST || QW, WA || RS and ___ = __ .QW and SR intersect
SQ 2
at V.
2.1 Determine, with reasons:
2.1.1 ____
PT
TW
2.1.2 ___
PT
TR
2.1.3 ___
PA
SQ
QV
____
2.1.4
VW
2.2 If SR = 36 cm, determine:
2.2.1 the length of AW
2.2.2 the length of VR
2.3 Area △PSR
Determine: ___________
Area △WVR
y w
M N
H K
y w
E F
To prove: ____
DE = ___
DF = ___
EF
GH GK HK
Construction: On DE and DF mark points M and N so that DM = GH and DN = GK.
Join MN.
Proof:
In △DMN and △GHK
1) DM = GH | Construction
2) DN = GK | Construction
3) D ^
^ =G | Given
∴ △DMN ≡ △GHK | SAS
^ N = GH
∴ DM ^K | Congruency
=E^ | Given
∴ MN || EF ^ N = corresponding ^E )
| ( DM
You do not
have to show
∴ ____
DE = ____
DF | ( Proportional intercepts, MN || EF ) these sketches.
DM DN
But DM = GH and DN = GK | Construction They are here
to help you
∴ ____
DE = ___
DF
understand the
GH GK
G D final step of
x x the proof.
A
y w
H K
y w
E B F
B
A 1 2
2 x
1
4
2 E
1
4 2
3
1 x
2 1
C 2
12
D
^ =C
AD and BC intersect at E. A ^ = x, AE = 2 cm, BE = 4 cm, EC = 8 cm
2 2
and CD = 12 cm.
1 Prove that △AEB ||| △CED.
2 Determine, with reasons, the lengths of AB and DE.
3 Prove that ABDC is a cyclic quadrilateral.
4 Determine ___
AC
BD
SOLUTIONS
1 MNPQ is a parallelogram.
NPR and MTR are straight lines.
MN = 24 units and TP = 9 units.
M Q
N P R
P O Q
3
2
1
B
27
80
18
E G F
If you know that the sides of the triangle are in proportion, show that the triangles
are equiangular.
U
x y
Q T
x y
x y
V W
R
Theorem: If two triangles have their corresponding sides in proportion, then they are equiangular.
PQ QT
Given: △PQT and △UVW with ___ = ____
PT = ____
UV UW VW
To prove: P ^,
^=U ^ =V
Q ^ and
^=W
T ^
^R = V
Construction: Draw △ QRT so that TQ ^, QT
^R = W
^ and R and P are on opposite
sides of QT.
Proof:
In △ RQT and △ UVW:
1) ^T = V
RQ ^ =x | Constructi on
2) RT ^ =y
^Q = W | Constructi on
3) ^ =U
R ^ | ∠ sum △
∴ △ RQT ||| △ UVW | AAA
RQ ____
___ QT
∴ = RT = ____ | △ RQT ||| △ UVW
UV UW VW
PQ QT QT RQ PQ
But ___ = ____
PT = ____ | ___ is common, so ___ = ___ and ____
RT = ____
PT
UV UW VW VW UV UV UW UW
∴ RQ = PQ and RT = PT | Given
In △ RQT and △ PQT:
1) RQ = PQ | Proved
2) RT = PT | Proved
3) QT is common
∴ △ RQT ≡ △ PQT | SSS
∴ ^ T = PQ
RQ ^T | △ RQT ≡ △ PQT
=V ^ ^T = V
| Construction, RQ ^
RT ^Q
^ Q = PT | △ RQT ≡ △ PQT
=W^ ^
^Q = W
| Construction, RT
∴ ^P = U
^ | ∠ sum △
VP intersects MG at S and KG at T.
GM = 60 units, KM = 30 units,
GK = 80 units, GS = 40 units, M P
T
TS = 15 units and GT = 30 units.
1 Prove that △GST ||| △GKM. V
S
SOLUTIONS
2) ____
GT = ___
30 = __
1 | Given
GM 60 2
3) ____
ST = ___
15 = __
1 | Given
KM 30 2
△GST ||| △GKM | Sides in proportion, ___
GS = ____
GT = ___
ST = __
1
GK GM KM 2
^ G = KM
1.2 ST ^G | △GST ||| △GKM
KMST is a cyclic quadrilateral | Exterior angle = interior opposite angle
^ T = _____________
1.3 cos SG 302 + 402 − 152 = ___
91 ⇒ SG^ T = 18,57°
( )(
2 30 40 ) 96
1.4 Area KMST = Area △GKM – Area △GST
= __ ^ K − __
1 GM × GK sin MG ^K
1 GT × GS sin MG
2 2
= __
1 ( 60 )( 80 ) sin 18,57° − __
1 ( 30 )( 40 ) sin 18,57°
2 2
= 573,23 units squared (unrounded value of MG ^ K gives 573,33 units squared)
D
WORKED EXAMPLE 2 A
5.3.1 BC
5.3.2 AD (Leave your answer in simplified surd form.) C
5.4 Is △AED ||| △CEB? Justify your answer by making use your answers in 5.3.
7 PT = 9 units, QT = 12 units, P
x
x
°–
90
x 90° – x
Q T R
Pythagoras’s theorem states that the square on the hypotenuse is equal to the sum of the squares
on the other two sides.
We can prove this theorem by using △ PQR ||| △TPR ||| △ TQP as follows:
PQ
___ QR
PR = ____
= ___ | △PQR ||| △TPR
TP TR PR
⇒ PR2
= TR × QR ➀
PQ
___ ___
PR QR
____
= = | △PQR ||| △TQP
TQ TP QP
2
⇒ PQ = TQ × QR ➁
PR2 + PQ2 = TR × QR + TQ × QR | from ➀ and ➁
= QR( TR + TQ )
= QR2
P
In any right-angled triangle, the line drawn through the
right angle, perpendicular to the hypotenuse, subdivides
the hypotenuse in such a way that the perpendicular
distance squared is equal to the product of the two lengths
of the subdivided hypotenuse. In this sketch, PT2 = QT.TR. Q T R
TP = ___
___ TR = ___
PR ⇒ PT2 = QT.TR | △T PR ||| △ TQP
TQ TP QP
AC is a diameter and BCD is a tangent. AED is a straight line with E on the circle.
1 Prove that CE2 = AE.ED
2 Prove that CD2 = AD.ED
A
O
1 E
2
2 3
1
C D
B
SOLUTION
EXERCISE 6
1.3 FB 1.4 AF
1.5 ED 1.6 DG
1.7 GB 1.8 FG. C 64 E 36 F B
Diameter TS is perpendicular to PR at V.
TV = 4VS and TS = 10 units.
2.1 Determine, with reasons,
the length of PR:
2.1.1 using similarity
O
2.1.2 using Pythagoras’ Theorem.
2.2 What type of quadrilateral is OPSR?
Give a reason for your answer.
2.3 Is OPSR a cyclic quadrilateral? Justify
P V R
your answer.
1 P
T
W V
Q R
TV || WR , ____
PW = __
1 and ___
PV = __
2
WQ 2 VR 3
1.1 If PT = 2x, determine TW in terms of x. (3)
1.2 Then, or otherwise, calculate the numerical value of:
QZ
___
1.2.1 (3)
ZV
Area △PQV
__________
1.2.2 (3)
Area △PQR
Area △TQV
__________
1.2.3 (5)
Area △PQR
2 BEH is a common tangent to both circles. BAG is a tangent to the smaller circle.
^ =x
BCD, FEC and AED are straight lines and D
D
H
x
G
F
E
3 4
2 5
1 6
1 2
A 3
1
2 C
1 2
2.1 Name three other angles equal to x. (5)
2.2 Prove that △FEA ||| △CED. B (4)
2.3 Prove that FE.ED = CE.EA. (2)
2.4 Prove that BAEC is a cyclic quadrilateral. (5)
2.5 ^ = AB
Prove that A ^ C. (2)
1
237
4. The circles intersect at A and E. B and F lie on the circumference of the smaller
circle and C and D lie on the circumference of the larger circle. BFD and CFE are
straight lines. A E
^ B = x and ED^ B = y.
1
CD 1
2
B
4.1 Determine, in terms of x and y: 2 F
4
^
3
y
4.1.1 A (2) 1 2
x D
4.1.2 ^
F4 (2)
4.1.3 F2. (2)
4.2 Prove that CD is a tangent to circle EFD. (4)
4.3 Prove that △CDF ||| △CED. (4) 1 2
4.4 2
Prove that CD = CE.CF. (3) C
238
E1 2 3 1
D
2 2
B 5 4
1
2 1
7 O is the centre of the circle. COD, BED and AEO are straight lines. B, C and D lie
on the circle and AO ⊥ CD. A
7.1 Prove that:
7.1.1 ABOD is a cyclic quadrilateral. (5)
7.1.2 △AOC ||| △DBC (4)
7.1.3 DC.OC = BC.AC (2)
7.1.4 2
2OC = BC.AC (2)
7.2 Draw AD and BO. B 2
7.2.1 Prove that AO bisects CA^ D. (4) 1
3 E
7.2.2 State the relationship between AB 2
4
and AC if BO || AD. (2) 1
1 2 D
C O
239
2 11 Statistics
Unit 1: Revision of symmetric and skewed
data
In Grade 11 you discovered that when you analyse statistical data, you get an idea of
REMEMBER how data values are distributed throughout the range. Symmetrical data values are
balanced on either side of the median, with the data being evenly spread on either
The median is the middle
side as shown in the box-and-whisker diagram in the Remember box.
value.
It is possible for three sets of data values to have the same range and the same
interquartile range, but for one to be skewed to the left, one to be symmetrical and
one to be skewed to the right. See the box-and-whisker plots below.
he lef t Symmetrical
Skewed data values are more Skewed to the right
spread out on one side than
on the other.
Skewed to the lef t Symmetrical Skewed to the right
y
Although a box-and-whisker plot is useful
rical Skewedtotothe
Skewed theright
right(or
to show the spread of data, we cannot always 10 -
positively skewed) -
-
be sure whether data is symmetrical or skewed. 8-
We must determine the mean of the data to -
-
6-
make sure. What is important is how the mean -
Skewedtotothe
Skewed theleft
lef t(or Symmetrical
compares with the median. When Skewed to the right
we have
-
4-
negatively skewed) perfect symmetry, the median (middle value), -
-
2-
mode (value with highest frequency) and -
-
mean will all be the same, as shown in the x
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0 2 4 6 8 10
frequency polygon alongside. mode
median
Consider the histograms below: mean
REMEMBER
20 - 30 -
Range = highest value –
27,5 -
lowest value
25 -
Interquartile range = upper
15 - 22,5 -
quartile – lower quartile
20 -
Frequency
Frequency
17,5 -
10 - 15 -
12,5 -
10 -
5- 7,5 -
5 -
2,5 -
- 0 -
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
We can conclude:
• If the mean = the median, then the data is symmetrical.
• If the mean > the median, then the data is skewed to the right.
• If the mean < the median, then the data is skewed to the left.
240 Topic 11 Statistics
-
Q1= 37 -
80 -
Q2(median) = 61 -
-
60 -
Q3 = 82
-
-
∴ IQR = 45 40 -
-
∴ Q1 – 1,5 IQR = –30,5 -
20 -
Q3 + 1,5 IQR = 149,5 -
-
∴ no outliers 10
-
Q1 Q2 Q3
20° 40° 60° 80° 100°
Percentage
Box-and-whisker plot:
The range of the data is
100 – 20 = 80. The results are widely spread and there are no outliers.
Using the calculator, we can determine that the standard deviation is 23,55, which
is fairly high. This means that it is not only a few values that are causing the range
to be large. Many data values deviate largely from the mean.
As the mean is almost equal to the median, we can say that the data is almost
symmetrical. We can also see this in the box-and-whisker plot. There are two modal
REMEMBER
groups (30 ≤ x < 40 and 80 ≤ x < 90), which are fairly evenly distributed on either
side of the median. Thirty-two learners scored lower than 40 and 32 learners scored Modal group is the group
higher that 80, creating symmetry on the highest and lowest parts of the range as with the highest frequency
well. It is significant that, while the data is symmetrical, more than half the test
results (64 out of 111) were distributed far from the mean and median.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
Data A
Data B
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0 5 10 15 20 25 30
3.1 The weights in kilograms of the 1992 Springbok rugby players were:
78 78 85 88 89 90 92 93 101 105 106 106 108 112 112
3.2 A box-and-whisker diagram is given for the weights of the 2010 SA Schools
Rugby players.
The mean weight for these players is 97,66 kg and the standard deviation
is 11, 76.
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
The above examples are both strong relationships, whereas the following examples
are weaker relationships, because the points are more scattered and do not follow as
clear a pattern:
y y
x x
y y exponential
y trend y parabolic trend
x x x x
Unit 2 Bivariate data: scatter plots, correlation and regression lines 243
WORKED EXAMPLE
SOLUTIONS
1 y
200
Number of ice creams sold
150
100
50
KEY WORDS
0 x
10 20 30 40
correlation coefficient –
Temperature in degrees Celsius
the measure of association
between two variables
2 Besides the outlier at (38;127), the rest of the data points show a linear trend
negative correlation – the
measure that indicates that with a strong positive relationship between the two variables.
the two variables move in
opposite directions, so as
one increases so the other We can further determine the strength of the relationship between two variables
decreases by calculating the correlation coefficient. This value can vary between –1 (which
positive correlation – the indicates a very strong negative correlation) and 1 (which indicates a very strong
measure that indicates that positive correlation). If the correlation coefficient is zero, there is no relationship
the two variables increase or between the two variables.
decrease together
x x x x
r = 1 (perfect line) r = –0,99 r = –0,09 r = –0,68
r =very
(a strongline)
1 (perfect r = –0,99
(a strong negative r = 0,09
(as this is close to zero, r = –0,68 strong
(a moderately
positive
(a verycorrelation)
strong correlation)
(a strong negative (as there
this is is almost
close no
to zero, negative correlation)
(a moderately strong
positive correlation) correlation) correlation)
there is almost no negative correlation)
correlation)
When we have drawn a scatter plot, we can draw a line that best fits the data. This
line is called a regression line. The line is chosen so that it comes as close as possible
to the data points and passes through the mean values for each set of data. The
standard form equation of the line of regression is given as:
REMEMBER
y = A + B × x where the regression parameters A and B are described below: _
_
x refers to the mean of the set
of x values.
The regression coefficient, which is the
gradient of the regression line
Unit 2 Bivariate data: scatter plots, correlation and regression lines 245
Calculate the values of A and B using the STAT option on a calculator as follows:
• Go to MODE: choose the STAT option
• Choose the option A + Bx: You will now have a table on your screen.
• Type in each of the data values, pressing = after each entry.
• Press AC
• Go to SHIFT 1 (that is, the other STAT option)
• Choose the Reg option
• Choose the A option, followed by =
• Press AC
• Go to SHIFT 1 (that is, the other STAT option)
• Choose the Reg option
• Choose the B option, followed by =
WORKED EXAMPLE
1 Use the values given in the previous worked example (the analysis of Mr
Naicker's ice cream sales compared with temperature) to draw a regression
line to best fit the data. Determine the equation of this line by
1.1 including the outlier
1.2 removing the outlier.
2 Using the regression line which was calculated by removing the outlier,
determine and comment on the number of ice creams that the shop owner
predicts he will sell on a day when the temperature is
2.1 24 °C
2.2 5 °C
SOLUTIONS
Note: When a point lies far from the others in ∴ the equation of the
a horizontal direction, it is called an ‘influential regression line is:
observation’. y = 2,5598x + 66,047
Unit 2 Bivariate data: scatter plots, correlation and regression lines 247
We now consider the aspect of residuals in more detail to help us determine whether
the trend of a set of bivariate data is linear or not.
Now consider the scatter plots in the next two figures. The plotted points show a
non-linear trend as shown with the green curve. The purple line shows the linear
regression line in each case.
In each diagram the vertical distance between the plotted point and the regression
line represents the residual (that is, y − ^y), where y is from the plotted point and ^y is
from the point on the regression line. So, if the plotted point is above the regression
line then y − ^y will be positive, and if the plotted point is below the regression line
then y − ^y will be negative.
In this diagram the plotted points are first
y
below, then above, and then below the
regression line. This means that the residual
values will be negative, then positive and
then negative again. This suggests that the
scatter plot will show a parabolic trend (as
shown by the green curve). The opposite
would have been true if the plotted points
had suggested a negative parabola. The
x
residuals would have been negative for the
central values and positive at the high and
low ends.
In general, if there is a random nature to the residual values (positive and negative)
with no apparent pattern, this indicates that a linear trend is appropriate for the
bivariate data. If there is a pattern to the residual values, then it indicates that a
linear model would not be appropriate. The trend that exists between the variables
is possibly exponential or parabolic (or another trend). We would have to look more
carefully at a larger sample of data points to decide on the suggested trend of the
points if a linear trend does not seem appropriate.
EXERCISE 2
1 For the following sets of bivariate data, use your calculator to determine:
1.1 the value of r, the correlation coefficient, and what this indicates about
the relationship between the variables
1.2 the regression parameters and the equation of the regression line
1.3 the predicted value required, and whether it is interpolation or
extrapolation.
A x y B x y C x y
10 180 11 35 8 19
20 160 22 71 16 68
30 140 29 82 25 28
40 120 38 148 37 52
50 100 53 149 55 56
60 80 59 188 59 97
70 60 75 259 81 24
80 40 82 286 94 78
Unit 2 Bivariate data: scatter plots, correlation and regression lines 249
50 -
40 -
30 -
20 -
10 -
-
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70
-
0 20 40 60 80 100
2 Candice's Grade 11 Mathematics class wrote two tests. The results achieved by
10 learners are recorded in a table as percentages.
Learner 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Test 1 92 68 58 47 84 65 59 53 67 75
Test 2 89 70 55 50 80 63 62 57 61 78
2.1 Draw a scatter plot to represent the relationship between these two sets
of data.
2.2 Determine the correlation coefficient for this set of bivariate data.
2.3 Discuss the relationship between the results of these two tests.
2.4 Show the regression line on the diagram of the scatter plot. Discuss
whether a linear model is appropriate for this set of bivariate data.
2.5 Determine the equation of the regression line.
2.6 A Grade 11 learner, Candice, wrote the first test and her result was
76%. She missed the second test. Predict the result that she would have
achieved, and discuss whether this is an accurate prediction or not.
Age in months 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36
Height/Length in cm 76 79 82 85 87 89 92 94 96
3.1 Draw a scatter plot to show her growth over time, using her age as the
independent variable. Start the x-axis at age 0 (that is, at birth), although the
first point to plot is (12;76). Continue your scale to the age of 48 months.
3.2 Use your calculator to determine the values of:
3.2.1 the correlation coefficient
3.2.2 the regression parameters.
3.3 Write the equation of the regression line, and use it to predict Rabia’s
height when she was 26 months old.
3.4 Nomakhushe was interested to know her length at birth. What would her
predicted birth length be if she used the equation of the regression line?
3.5 Why would this not be an accurate prediction of her birth length?
3.6 Nomakhushe then found a more detailed chart, which included with her
length in the first and 4th years. The additional information is shown
below:
--
-
90 –-
--
-
80 –-
--
-
70 –-
--
-
60 –
x
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
–
Unit 2 Bivariate data: scatter plots, correlation and regression lines 251
Weight (kg)
--
-
90 –-
--
– -
80 -
--
– -
70 -
--
-
60 –
x
-
-
-
-
–
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
150 160 170 180 190 200 210
Height (cm)
4.1 Which team appears to have a better correlation between height and
weight? Give a reason for your answer.
4.2 Draw the line of best fit for each team.
4.3 If reserve players are brought into the teams, use the lines of best fit to
estimate:
4.3.1 the weight of a 1992 Springbok reserve player with a height of
195 cm.
4.3.2 the height of a 2010 SAS reserve player with a weight of 100 kg.
5 Mr Kerbelker was not happy with some of the test results of his class. He decided
to do a survey to find out how much time they had spent watching TV each day.
The results of his survey are shown below, together with the test result of each
student.
5.1 Draw a scatter plot to show the relationship between these two variables.
5.2 Determine the equation of the line of best fit.
5.3 Determine the correlation coefficient for this set of data values (to 2
decimal places).
5.4 Describe the correlation between the time spent watching TV and the
results obtained.
1 The results, out of 50, for two tests written by a Grade 12 class are given below:
Test A 39 33 35 44 37 40 24 31 30 5 42 12 46 16 35
Test B 41 45 48 40 47 42 37 44 43 24 39 45 49 43 48
1.1 Use a calculator to determine for each test, the value of:
1.1.1 the mean (4)
1.1.2 the standard deviation. (4)
1.2 Determine the five-number summary for each set of values. Then
draw a box-and-whisker plot for the results of each test. (12)
1.3 Discuss the distribution of each set of test results. (3)
1.4 Determine the correlation coefficient; and hence describe the
relationship between the two test results. (2)
1.5 Draw a scatter plot and then discuss the relationship between the
results of the two tests. (4)
1.6 Determine the equation of the regression line for this set of
bivariate data. (2)
x
x
2.3 2.4
y y
x x
Match the correct box-and-whisker plot to each of the histograms above. State
whether the data is symmetrical, skewed to the right, or skewed to the left.
A B
C D
(2 × 4)
253
4.1 Draw a scatter plot to represent the relationship between these two sets
of data. (4)
4.2 Determine the correlation coefficient, and discuss what this tells us about
the correlation between the advertising expenditure and sales figures of
the company. (2)
4.3 Discuss the trends that the company should notice with regard to the
relationship between money spent on advertising and sales figures. (3)
4.4 Discuss whether a linear model is appropriate for this set of bivariate data. (2)
4.5 Determine the equation of the regression line. (2)
4.6 The company would like to predict their sales figures for the next year if
they plan to spend R35 900 on advertising. Determine the predicted sales
figures based on the line of regression. (2)
4.7 Would the result in 4.6 have made use of extrapolation or interpolation?
Then discuss whether the result should be considered accurate or not. (2)
254
6 A group of scientist are studying the effects of a certain drug that is being tested
on mice who have a particular virus. Their results are recorded below:
Number of days since drug administered 5 10 15 20 25 30
Number of mice still affected by the virus 219 95 28 2 24 102
-
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70
Determine:
7.1 an outlier (1)
7.2 the equation of the regression line:
7.2.1 including the outlier (2)
7.2.2 excluding the outlier (2)
7.3 the correlation coefficient:
7.3.1 including the outlier (2)
7.3.2 excluding the outlier. (2)
7.4 Discuss the relationship between this set of
bivariate data. (4)
8 A group of learners were asked to complete a form showing their height and
their most recent mathematics test result. The information gathered is shown in
the table below:
Height (cm) 159 145 152 163 149 156 168 155 150
Mathematics result (%) 75 95 52 48 82 84 98 74 59
Determine the correlation coefficient for this set of data values, and then discuss
255
P(A ∩ B)
so P (B | A) = ________
P(A)
You can enter data quantities or probability values into the various parts of a Venn
diagram. (For probability values the total value for the sample space will be 1). When
you enter data into the Venn diagram, start with the intersection values (use x for this
if it is unknown at that stage). Use the intersection to calculate the values in the rest
of the areas of the Venn diagram. If necessary, solve for x, knowing that the values of
each section must total to the sample space.
WORKED EXAMPLE
1 Sellmove estate agency has 31 clients to find suitable properties for. It also
has 23 clients whose properties they must sell. The company has 42 clients
altogether who fall into one or other of these categories. Draw a Venn
diagram and then answer the questions:
1.1 How many clients is the company both trying to find a suitable
property for and trying to sell for?
1.2 What is the probability that one of the clients for whom the company
is trying to find a suitable property is also one for whom they are trying
to sell a property?
SOLUTION
There are 12 clients for whom Note: As there are 31 buyers, but x of those are also
the company is both trying to sellers, this means that 31 – x are buyers only. Similarly,
there are 23 – x who are sellers only.
find a property to buy and to
sell a property.
1.2 We need to find the probability of the client being a seller as well as a buyer,
so:
P(S ∩ B) = ___
12
42
= __
2
7
Unit 1 Revision of rules for independent, mutually exclusive and complementary events 257
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
Judy and her friends decide to take a break from studying and go for lunch. Judy
goes to a restaurant and has a choice of:
Starter: Soup or salad
Main course: Beef, pork or chicken
Dessert: Ice cream or trifle
If she is equally likely to choose any option, draw a tree diagram and determine
the probability that she will have ice cream and not beef.
SOLUTION
The tree diagram shows all the options. The blue pathways (labelled SoCIc; SoPIc;
SaCIc and SaPIc) show the options that satisfy the criteria of the question.
Having ice cream and not beef is 4 out of the possible 12 options, so the
probability is ___
4
12
= __
1
3
. (In this example each branch on each level is equally
REMEMBER weighted.)
• Contingency tables:
These are statistical tables that represent the relationships between two or more
variables. The frequencies of each variable are shown in rows and columns.
WORKED EXAMPLE
Northcross High School has a total of 654 learners. Three hundred and thirty one
learners are boys. Nazamo's Grade 12 class organised a Charity Fun Run where
all proceeds would be donated to the Red Cross Children's Hospital. In total 602
learners attended the Fun Run, but 25 of the girls did not attend. All 654 learners
at the school were given a raffle ticket (no other raffle tickets were given out),
which was drawn on the day of the Fun Run. Draw a contingency table and
determine the probability that the winner of the raffle was:
1 at the Fun Run
2 a boy, given that the winner was not at the Fun Run.
SOLUTION
First enter the given data into Did attend Did not attend Total
the table (those typed in red),
Boys 304 27 331
after which we can calculate the
Girls 298 25 323
missing data, knowing that the
Total 602 52 654
totals of each column and row
must equal the values at the end
of each column and row.
1 There were a total of 602 learners at the Fun Run out of a possible
654 learners. So the probability of the raffle winner being at the Fun Run
is ____
602
654
≈ 92,05%.
2 There were 27 boys not at the Fun Run out of a total of 52 who did not
attend. So the probability that the winner was a boy, given that the winner
was not at the Fun Run
the number of ways an event can occur
= _____________________________________________________________
the total number of possible outcomes that satisfy the conditions given
= ___
27
52
Unit 1 Revision of rules for independent, mutually exclusive and complementary events 259
3 A random sample of school children from Sunshine College was surveyed. The
results of the survey showed that the probability that a learner from the chosen
group came from a family where their parents were still married was __
3
4
(call this
event A). The probability that a learner from the group surveyed had at least one
sibling was 0,8 (call this event B), and the probability that a learner from the
group surveyed had lost a parent due to HIV Aids was 0,25 (call this event C). It
was further found that events A and C were mutually exclusive.
3.1 Are A and C are exhaustive?
3.2 Are B and C are complementary?
3.3 If A and B are independent, determine P(A ∩ B).
4 One hundred and eighty people attended a charity function in aid of the Nelson
Mandela Children’s Fund. Fifty percent of the people were women, and 10%
of the women were unmarried. There were 15 unmarried men. On arrival,
each person was given a ticket for a lucky draw. Draw a contingency table, and
determine the probability that the lucky winner will be a married man.
7 In a school with 650 learners, the number of learners who play only soccer is
10 more than the number of learners who play both soccer and rugby. The number
of learners who play only rugby is twice the number of learners who play only
soccer. The number of learners who play neither rugby nor soccer is six times the
number of learners who play both soccer and rugby. Draw a Venn diagram, and
determine the number of learners who play neither rugby nor soccer.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
Nadia did a survey where she asked a group of 85 learners whether they drank
fizzy cooldrink or fruit juice. Forty two said that they drank both, 21 said that they
drink fruit juice only, and
12 learners said that they drink neither.
1.1 What is the probability that a learner chosen at random drinks only fizzy
cooldrink?
1.2 Are the events ‘drinking fizzy cooldrink’ and ‘drinking fruit juice’
independent events?
SOLUTION
This example suits a Venn diagram well as there are two aspects to compare:
fizzy cooldrink (C) and fruit juice (J). We can represent each as a circle.
12
Unit 2 Use Venn diagrams, tree diagrams and contingency tables to solve problems 261
Mrs Sachs asked her class of 30 learners how they researched information for their
history projects. Ten said they read books from the library, 25 said they had used
the internet, and 8 said they had interviewed people. Two said they had used
none of these three options. Three said they had interviewed people and used the
internet but not the library, and 7 said they had used the library and the internet.
One said he had used the library only. Determine the probability that a learner
chosen at random from the class had used all three options.
SOLUTION
30
A Venn diagram is the best option in L
this example as there are three different I
1
options. There is also much information 7–x
15
given that relates to intersections between x
2
the three options. We will draw one circle 3
for library users (L), one for internet
users (I) and one for interviewing people 3–x
2
(P). There are intersections between all P
three options, so we will draw the circles
intersecting. We start by filling in the
intersection of all three. As we do not know that value, we will call it x. Next fill
in the rest of the values shown in bold. Finally determine the rest of the values by
calculation, knowing the totals for each circle.
We can now create an equation because we know the total of the sample space to
solve for x:
1 + 7 − x + 15 + x + 2 + 3 + 3 − x + 2 = 30
∴x=3
So the probability of all three options = P(L ∩ I ∩ P) = ___ = ___
3 1
30 10
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
Researchers at Groote Schuur Hospital found that many people are carriers of a
certain disease. They tested 200 people and found that 5 of the 90 females tested
were carriers, and that 7 of the males tested were carriers. Determine:
4.1 the probability that a male from those tested is a carrier
4.2 the number of males in South Africa who are likely to be a carrier (assuming
that the population of South Africa is 50 million)
4.3 the probability that the person tested is a carrier, given that the person is
a female
4.4 the probability that the person tested is male, given that he is a carrier.
SOLUTION
You could use a contingency table for this example (because both the two factors
being considered, male/female and carrier/non-carrier are complementary events).
You could also use a tree diagram (because there are two events that are both
exhaustive, and happen simultaneously):
Fill in the red numbers first
Carrier Not a carrier
Male 7 103 110
Female 5 85 90
12 188 200
Unit 2 Use Venn diagrams, tree diagrams and contingency tables to solve problems 263
Male 103
110 110
200 Not
carrier
90
200 5 Carrier
90
Female 85
90
Not Note: In a tree diagram when the first option
carrier
is given, ignore that probability. Look only at
4.1 P(M ∩ C) = ____
110 ____
= ____
7 7 the probability of the next branch.
×
200 110 200
4.2 ____
7
200
× 50 000 000 = 1 750 000
4.3 P(C | F)
= ___ = ___
5 1
90 18 ____
110 ____
7
P(M and C) __________________ ×
4.4 P(M | C) = __________ = ___
7
200 110
= 110 12 Note: P(C) has two
P(C) ____ ____
7 ____
90 ___
5
× 110 + 200 × 90
200 possibilities, each of
which must be reached
The contingency table method is often easier when the by following a path.
events are complementary as in this case: male/female So each path must be
and carrier/not carrier. Tree diagrams are best used only multiplied, and the
when there are more than two options. two options added.
WORKED EXAMPLE 5
Umfolozi School has 752 learners in Grades 8 to 12 and 387 are boys. There are
160 Grade 8s, 157 Grade 9s, 151 Grade 10s and 143 Grade 11s. Ninety Grade 8s and
73 Grade 11s are boys, while 82 Grade 9s and 78 Grade 10s are girls.
5.1 If a learner is selected randomly from the school, determine P(boy in Grade 10).
5.2 If a learner is selected randomly from Grade 8, determine P(boy)′.
5.3 If a learner is selected randomly from the school, determine P(Grade 9 | girl)
5.4 If a learner is selected randomly from the school, determine P(Grade 12)′.
SOLUTION
A contingency table will be most useful in this example. A Venn diagram is not
possible. A tree diagram is possible, but would require too many branches.
Grade 8 Grade 9 Grade 10 Grade 11 Grade 12
Male 90 75 73 73 76 387
Female 70 82 78 70 65 365
160 157 151 143 141 752
1 Ngwenya School’s soccer coach analyses the performance of his team after half
the season is over. He finds that if it rains, the probability that the team will win
is 0,4. If it does not rain, the probability that the team will win is 0,7. During the
month ahead, the probability that it will rain is 0,2. The coach considers various
outcomes of his team’s next match, which is in two weeks’ time. Determine the
probability that:
1.1 it will rain and his team will win
1.2 it will not rain
1.3 his team will win
1.4 his team will lose, given that it does not rain.
2 A cutlery drawer contains 12 knives, 10 forks and 8 spoons. If only the handles
are visible and Xhanti randomly selects three items without replacing them,
what is the probability that he:
2.1 selects a knife, fork and spoon
2.2 selects three of the same
2.3 selects three knives
2.4 selects a fork then two spoons
2.5 first selects two knives, and then does not select a fork.
3 A group of 100 people were asked which exercises they do to keep fit: running,
cycling or going to the gym. Fifteen said that they only run, 30 said that they go
to the gym only and 35 said that they do none of these options. The cyclists said
that they do not go to the gym or run, and none of those who run or go to the
gym said they go cycling. The same number of people who said they run and go
to the gym said that they go cycling.
3.1 Determine the probability that a person chosen randomly from the group
of 100:
3.1.1 runs and goes to the gym
3.1.2 does not cycle
3.1.3 goes to the gym, given that they run.
3.2 Prove that running and going to the gym are independent events.
Unit 2 Use Venn diagrams, tree diagrams and contingency tables to solve problems 265
If there are a ways that one event can be performed, b ways that a second event can
be performed, c ways that a third event can be performed, and so on, then there are
a × b × c × … ways in total that the events can be performed successively.
In the example above, we assume that we can use each letter once only. What would
happen if we had been allowed to repeat any of the letters? Our choices for the
second letter will be any one of the 4 letters again, and so on, so the total number of
possibilities will be:
4 × 4 × 4 × 4 = 44 = 256 4 4 4 4
What would happen if we were told that the first letter had to be H, with repetitions
not allowed?
In this situation where conditions are given, always consider the condition/restriction
before continuing with options for the rest of the positions.
So, there is only one option for position 1 which leaves us with 3, then 2 then 1
choice thereafter:
1×3×2×1=6 1 3 2 1
If we were told that the last letter must not be E, we would start by knowing that
there are 3 possible choices for the last letter, then 3, 2, 1 for the other positions:
3 × 2 × 1 × 3 = 18 3 2 1 3
If we need to know how many five-digit numbers we can form using 1; 2; 3; 4 and 5,
we could apply the same principle: the first digit is chosen from 5 possibilities, the
second from the remaining 4 numbers , the third from 3 numbers, and so on, thus
the total number of possibilities is:
Unit 3 The fundamental counting principle 267
What would happen if we had more values to choose from than positions to be filled?
If repetitions are allowed, then the total number of possible arrangements of
n items where only r positions need to be filled will be:
n × n × n × ……… × n (r times) = nr
Now consider the situation where repetitions are allowed: To determine how many
three-digit numbers we can create from 1; 2; 3; 4 and 5 with no repetitions, the first
digit would be chosen from 5 possibilities, the second from 4 and the third from 3.
Thus there would be:
5 × 4 × 3 = 60 possible numbers in total. This is the same
as _______ = ________________
5! 5×4×3×2×1
(5 − 3)! 2×1
= ____
120
2
= 60
In general, the total number of possible arrangements where repetitions are not
allowed, will be: _______
n!
(n − r)!
n = the number of items that are available to choose from, and
r = the number of items chosen.
WORKED EXAMPLES
1 How many different outfits can Claire wear if she has 3 skirts, 4 blouses,
and 2 pairs of shoes from which to choose?
2 A four-character code is formed either by choosing from the numbers 1, 2, 3,
4, 5 or by choosing from the letters A, B, C, D, E. How many different codes
can be formed if no letter or number can be repeated?
3 How many five-digit codes can be formed from the numbers 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5, if:
3.1 no digit may be used more than once
3.2 no digit may be used more than once and the code must start with 5
3.3 there is no restriction on how often a digit is used, but the code must
end with 5
3.4 there is no restriction on how often a digit is used, but the code must
start with 5 and not end with 1
3.5 there is no restriction on how often a digit is used, but the code must
start with 5 or 1
3.6 there is no restriction on how often a digit is used, but the code must
start with 5 or end with 1?
1 Claire will first have a choice of 3 skirts, then a choice of 4 blouses, followed
by a choice of 2 pairs of shoes, so in total she will have 3 × 4 × 2 = 24
possible outfits.
2 There are 5! possible arrangements of the numbers,
Note: 1,2,3,4,5 and
or 5! arrangements of the letters. Thus, using the A,B,C,D,E are mutually
addition rule for mutually exclusive events: there exclusive.
are 5! + 5! = 240 possible codes.
3.1 There will be 5! = 120 possible codes.
3.2 There will be 1 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 24 possible codes.
3.3 There will be 5 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 1 = 625 possible codes.
3.4 There will be 1 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 4 = 500 possible codes
3.5 We could answer this by considering that the first digit is a choice of 2,
followed by a choice of 5, then 5, then 5, then 5. So the total number of
codes will be 2 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 5 = 1 250. Alternatively, we could consider that
there will be 1 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 5 = 625 codes that start with 5, and 625 that
start with 1. Since ‘starting with 5’ and ‘starting with 1’ are mutually exclusive
events, we can apply the addition rule, so there will be
625 + 625 = 1 250 possible codes.
3.6 Since ‘starting with 5’ or ‘ending with 1’ are not mutually exclusive events REMEMBER
(some codes can start with 5 AND end with 1), we must subtract the number
P( A or B ) = P( A ) + P( B )
of codes that can have both, so there will be − P( A ∩ B )
625 + 625 – (1 × 5 × 5 × 5 × 1) = 1 125 possible codes.
Arranging items where the order of the items matters, is called a permutation.
KEY WORDS
• When repetitions are allowed in a permutation, the number of ways of arranging r
items from a choice of n items will be nr. permutation – an
When repetitions are not allowed, instead of using the formula _______ given above,
n! arrangement of items where
• (n − r)! the position or order of the
we could use the key for permutations on the calculator: nPr
items is important
Other notations for permutations are: nPr or P(n,r).
WORKED EXAMPLES
Now consider arranging items in such a way that some of them have to be next to
each other.
WORKED EXAMPLES
How many ways can Greta, Mavis, Ava, Gertrude, Desmond, Yaseen and Basil
sit in a row, so that:
1 There are no restrictions on who must sit where.
2 Greta and Mavis have to sit together.
3 The girls must sit together and the boys must sit together.
4 Only the girls have to sit together.
SOLUTIONS
1 This means that we can arrange 7 people in any order, so there will be 7!
(that is, 5 040 possible arrangements).
2 We consider Greta and Mavis as one unit, and so look at the number of
arrangements we can have with 6 units (the pair, and the other 5 individuals).
In an example like this, repetitions are not valid as none of these people
would be able to sit in more than one place at the same time. So, that means
that there are 6 × 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 720 possible arrangements. However,
the pair of Greta and Mavis can be seated in two different ways and still be
together (Greta then Mavis, or Mavis then Greta). So in total there are (6 × 5
× 4 × 3 × 2 × 1) × 2 = 1 440 different arrangements.
Now consider situations like those at the start of this unit: Determine the number of
‘words’ that we can form from certain given letters. The example that we considered
used the letters in the work HELP. What would happen if the word that we started
off with had repeated letters? For example, if we want to determine the number of
‘words’ that we can form from CONSOLIDATION? It is important to know whether
the repeated letters will be treated as different letters or not. If the repeated letters are
treated as different letters, then there will be 13! (6 227 020 800) arrangements, as
CONSOLIDATION has 13 letters. If the repeated letters are treated as the same, then
some of those 6 227 020 800 ‘words’ that are created will be the same, thus there
would be fewer different arrangements. As there are 3 Os, 2 Ns, and 2 Is, the number
of different arrangements would be __________
13!
= 259 459 200 .
3! × 2! × 2!
In general, the number of different ways that n letters can be arranged, treating all
repeated letters as the same, where a of the letters are identical, b are identical, c are
identical, and so on, will be: ________
n!
a! b! c! ...
WORKED EXAMPLES
How many ‘words’ can be formed, using all of the letters in the word
CHARACTERISTIC, if:
1 the repeated letters are treated as different letters
2 the repeated letters are treated as identical
3 the repeated letters are treated as different, and the word starts with an H
4 the repeated letters are treated as identical, and the word starts with an A
and ends with a C
5 the repeated letters are treated as different, and the word starts with an A or
ends with a C
6 the repeated letters are treated as identical, and the word starts and ends with
the same letter?
T T
A A
R R
I I
In the first option, the remaining 12 letters would have 2 As, 2 Rs, 2 Ts and
2 Is. Thus there would be ______________ = 29 937 600 words. In the second
12!
2! × 2! × 2! × 2!
option, the remaining 12 letters would have 3 Cs, 2 As, 2 Rs and 2 Is. Thus
there would be ______________ 9 979 200 words.
12!
3! × 2! × 2! × 2!
In the third option the remaining 12 letters would have 3 Cs, 2 Ts, 2 Rs and
2 Is. This would also result in 9 979 200 possible words. In the last option the
remaining 12 letters would have 3 Cs, 2 Ts, 2 As and 2 Is, thus also resulting
in 9 979 200 possible words. Similarly there would be 9 979 200 words.
So, in total there will be 29 937 600 + 4(9 979 200) = 69 854 400 possible
words.
7 How many different 13-letter ‘words’ can we form using the letters of the word
MATHEMATICIAN if no repetitions are allowed?
8 How many different 6-letter ‘words’ can we form using the letters of the word
MATHEMATICIAN if no repetitions are allowed?
12 How many different five-digit codes can we form using the digits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5,
6, 7, 8 and 9, if:
12.1 the digits can be used in any order and can be repeated
12.2 there must be no repeated digits
12.3 the code must not start with 0, but can have repeated digits
12.4 the code must not start with 0, and must not have any repeated digits
12.5 the code must start with 1, and can have repeated digits
12.6 the code must start with 9 and end with 0, and must not have any
repeated digits
12.7 the code must start with two 5s, and although repeated digits are allowed,
there must not be another 5
12.8 the code must start with 9, then 8, and there must not be any repeated
digits in the code
12.9 the code must end with the same number that it started with, and there
must be no other repeated digits
12.10 the code must end with the same number that it started with, and digits
can be repeated.
14 Determine how many different codes can be formed from the digits 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5
if the code can be a three-digit or a four-digit number, and no digit may be repeated.
15 A four-character code can consist either of four digits chosen from the numbers
0, 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5, or it can consist of four letters chosen from V, W, X, Y and Z.
How many possible codes will there be if:
15.1 any digit or letter can be repeated
15.2 the digits can be repeated but the letters must not be repeated
15.3 the digits must not be repeated, but the letters can be repeated?
17 In how many different ways can the names Piet, Maria, Valmarie and Lara be
written, if:
17.1 the names can be in any order
17.2 Piet must be written first and the other names can be in any order
17.3 Maria must be written last and the other names can be in any order
17.4 Valmarie must be written first and Lara must be written second
17.5 Maria, Lara and Valmarie must be written together
17.6 Piet must not be written first.
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
Consider the word HEATHER. If the letters of this word are arranged in any order
in which the repeated letters are treated as identical, what is the probability that:
1.1 the ‘word’ formed will start with an H and end with an E
1.2 the ‘word’ formed will start and end with the same letter
1.3 the letters R and T are adjacent
1.4 of the arrangements where R and T are adjacent, the vowels are also adjacent?
SOLUTIONS
1.1 There are 7 letters in HEATHER with 2 Es and 2 Hs, so there are
______
7!
= 1 260 ways in total that the letters can be arranged.
2! × 2!
Now determine how many arrangements will start with an H and end with
an E. If the first and last letters are fixed as being H and E, there are
5 other letters that can be in any order (E, A, H, T and R). As none of these
are repeated letters, there will be 5! ways that these letters can be arranged.
Therefore, the probability of the arrangement chosen starting with an H and
ending with an E is _____ = ___
5! 2
1 260 21
.
1.2 If the arrangement must start and end with the same letter, then it must be
either
E E
or
H H
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
SOLUTIONS
2.1 The total number of ways of arranging the given numbers with no repetitions
= _______ = 15 120 or 9P = 15 120
9!
(9 − 5)! 5
To be an odd number, the final digit must be a 1, 3, 5, 7, or 9, which would
have 5P1 = 5 possibilities. The other 4 digits could be any of the digits except
for the final digit as there must be no repetitions. Thus there would be
8
P4 = 1 680 possibilities. In total, there would be 1 680 × 5 = 8 400 possible
ways to have an odd number.
Therefore, the probability that the number formed will be an odd number
is: ______ = __
8 400 5
15 120 9
2.2 For the number to be less than 50 000, the first digit must be a 1, 2, 3, or 4,
and the other 4 digits can be any of the 9 digits, except for the digit that was
first. Therefore, there will be 4 × 8P4 = 6 720 possible numbers that are less
than 50 000. The probability of getting such a number is _______ = __
6 720 4
15 120 9
2.3 To be less than 50 000 and divisible by 5, the first digit is a choice of
4 possibilities, the last digit must be a 5. The remaining 3 digits are chosen
from 7 digits. So there are 4 × 7P3 × 1 = 840 possible numbers, and the
probability of getting such a number, given that we are only choosing from
numbers that are divisible by 5 = _______ = __
840 1
8
P4 × 1 2
A code is chosen by using 3 letters of the alphabet followed by 5 digits. The letters
and digits can be repeated. Determine the probability that the code chosen:
3.1 has only one 7 in it
3.2 has at least one A in it
3.3 starts with an A and ends with a 9.
SOLUTIONS
Note: There are 10 possible
3.1 The total number of ways of creating a code which has 3 letters and 5 digits
digits to choose from in total:
with repetitions will be 263 × 105. If we want a code with only one 7:
0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 and 9,
The 3 letters in the code can be any of 26 letters. These can be repeated, so but there must only be one
there will be 263 possibilities for the 3 letters. The 5 digits must have one 7, so 7. That leaves 9 to choose
the remaining 4 digits can be arranged in 94 ways. But the 7 can be in any of from in each of the remaining
the 5 positions. positions.
Therefore, the probability that the code chosen has only one 7 in it is
263 × 94 × 5
___________ = 0,32805
263 × 105
3.2 For the code to have at least one A (it could have one, two or three As), it is
easiest to remember that P(A) = 1 – P(A′). So, the probability that there is at
253 × 105
least one A = 1 – the probability that there is no A = 1 – _________ = ______
1 951
263 × 105 17 576
3.3 If the code must start and end with a specific letter or digit, there is no choice
for those positions.
The number of possibilities for the remaining positions is 262 × 104, so the
262 × 104
probability of this happening is _________ = ____
1
260
263 × 105
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
Repeat Question 3, but assume that there are no repetitions of letters or digits.
SOLUTIONS
4.1 The total number of ways of creating a code which has 3 letters and 5 digits
with no repetitions will be ________ × ________ = 471 744 000
26! 10!
(26 − 3)! (10 − 5)!
(or 26P3 × 10P5).
If we want a code with only one 7:
The 3 letters in the code can be any of 26 letters. These must not be repeated,
so there will be 26P3 possibilities for the 3 letters. The 5 digits must have
one 7, which can be in any of the 5 positions, so the remaining 4 digits must
be chosen from 9 digits. Therefore, in total, there will be
26P × 5 × 9P = 235 872 000 possible codes with one 7, and the probability of
3 4
Amina, her brothers, Aaqib and Asheeq, and their parents, are posing for a
family photograph. Assuming that the photographer wants them to stand in a
line, what is the probability that:
5.1 Aaqib and Asheeq will be next to each other
5.2 Amina will be in the middle, given that her brothers are next to each other?
SOLUTIONS
5.1 If we consider Aaqib and Asheeq as one unit, there will be 4 units to arrange,
which will be possible in 4! ways. As there are two ways that Aaqib and Asheeq
Note: If the brothers must
can be next to each other, there will be 2 × 4! = 48 possible arrangements with
be next to each other, this Aaqib and Asheeq next to each other. In total there would be 5! possible ways to
position will have to be the arrange the whole family in a row, so the probability of Aaqib and Asheeq being
48 __
second brother (if the first next to each other = ___ 2
= 5.
5!
position was one of the
brothers), or the second
5.2 For Amina to be in the middle, the number of other possibilities will be:
parent (if the first position was
4 1 Amina 2 1
a parent). So, once the first
position is filled this position That is, 8 possibilities.
no longer has a choice, and
will be only one possible
Therefore the probability of Amina being in the middle, given that her
brothers are next to each other is ___ = __
8 1
option 48 6
WORKED EXAMPLE 6
Hong-lee considers the dinner menu at a restaurant. The menu consists of a choice
from two starters, three different main courses, and three desserts, one of which is
malva pudding. Assuming that he is equally likely to choose any option, what is
the probability that he will have malva pudding with his meal?
SOLUTION
In the past we might have answered this Dessert 1
Main 1 Dessert 2
question by using a tree diagram: Malva
Dessert 1
Starter 1 Main 2 Dessert 2
From this diagram we can see that Malva
Dessert 1
6 out of the 18 meal options include Main 3 Dessert 2
Malva
malva pudding, so the probability of Dessert 1
Hong-lee having malva pudding is: ___
6 Main 1 Dessert 2
18 Malva
= __
1 Dessert 1
3 Starter 2 Main 2 Dessert 2
Malva
Note: a choice of Using counting principles, we know that Dessert 1
Main 3 Dessert 2
2 starters followed by a the total number of meal options Malva
choice of 3 main courses, = 2 × 3 × 3 = 18. The number
followed by the one of these meals that will include Note: a choice of 2 starters followed
option of malva malva pudding will be 2 × 3 × 1 = 6, by a choice of 3 main courses,
pudding. followed by a choice of 3 desserts.
so the probability of Hong-lee having
malva pudding is: ___ = __
6 1
18 3
.
1 Determine the probability that a four-digit code chosen from the letters of the
alphabet starts with an A if:
1.1 letters can be repeated
1.2 letters cannot be repeated.
2 The cards ace, two, three, four, five, and six of hearts are shuffled and placed face
down on a table, and then turned over. Determine the probability that the order
of the cards:
2.1 starts with a 6
2.2 ends in a three or five
2.3 has the ace and two next to each other.
3 Valda has decided on the make and model for her new car, but has a choice
between four different colours, two different engine sizes and whether to have
power steering or not.
3.1 How many different possible cars is she choosing between?
3.2 Determine the probability that she will not have power steering in her car.
4 A code is created by choosing three digits from 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, or three digits from
6, 7, or 8 with no repetitions. Determine the probability that the code will:
4.1 end with a 5
4.2 have no 8.
5 Five letters from the word SPECIAL are arranged randomly with no repetitions.
Determine the probability that:
5.1 the word SPICE will be chosen
5.2 the word will contain an E
5.3 the letters of the word SPICE will be chosen in any order.
6 Consider the word ADMINISTRATION. The letters of this word are arranged in
any order, where the repeated letters are treated as being identical, what is the
probability that:
6.1 the ‘word’ formed will start with an S
6.2 the ‘word’ formed will start with an M and end with an S
6.3 the letters D and O are adjacent?
7 Repeat Question 6, assuming that the repeated letters are treated as being
different.
1 One person is randomly selected from this list: Rashaad, Terry, Sarah, Thandi,
Chris and Fadiel. Determine the probability that the person selected is:
1.1 Terry (2)
1.2 not Thandi (2)
1.3 a person whose name starts with a T (2)
1.4 either Sarah or Fadiel. (2)
2 A teacher puts the names of the 25 learners in her class in a bag. She randomly
selects 5 learners to assist her with a project on each day of the week. The learner
with the first name she draws from the bag assists her on Monday, the second
name she draws assists her on Tuesday, and so on, until she has 5 names to assist
her from Monday to Friday. How many different possible lists of helpers could
she have if after drawing a name she:
2.1 returns the name into the bag (2)
2.2 does not return the name to the bag? (2)
4 A test contains ten questions in which the learners have to state whether the
statement is true or false. Determine how many different answers are possible,
assuming that all ten questions are answered. (2)
5 A four-letter code is formed with no repetitions using letters from the words
TEACHER and CLAP. Treat repeated letters in the words as different letters.
5.1 How many codes are possible if:
5.1.1 any letter from either of the words can be used (2)
5.1.2 the code must either use four letters from the word TEACHER
or four letters from the word CLAP (4)
5.1.3 the code must use one letter from the word TEACHER and the
other three letters from the word CLAP (4)
5.1.4 the code must use one letter from the word CLAP and the other
three from the word TEACHER? (4)
280
9 A security code is formed so that the code consists of 3 digits chosen from 1, 2, 3,
4 or 5 followed by one letter chosen from A, B, C, D or
E. No repetitions are allowed. For example:
9.1 How many such codes are possible? (5) 352D; or 142C
9.2 What is the probability that the code formed
starts with a 1 and contains a vowel? (2)
10 The letters from the word AEROPLANE are arranged in a line, and the repeated
letters are treated as different. Determine:
10.1 the total number of possible arrangements (2)
10.2 the probability that the letters R and N will be adjacent (4)
10.3 the probability that the vowels will be adjacent, given that R and N
are adjacent. (2)
281
11 Tsepho either walks to school or catches a bus. If he catches the bus, the
probability that he will be on time for school is 0,95. The probability that
he is late for school, given that he walks to school is 0,2. The probability
that Tsepho is on time for school on any day is 0,9.
11.1 What is the probability that he walks to school? (6)
11.2 What is the probability that he will be on time for school, given that
he takes the bus? (2)
11.3 Given that he is late for school, what is the probability that he took
the bus? (4)
11.4 Are the events walking to school, and being on time independent
events? (5)
12 Given that P(A) = 0,6; P(B′ ) = 0,15; P(A ∪ B)′ = 0,1 and P(A and B) = x:
12.1 determine the value of x (5)
12.2 determine P(A′ ∩ B) (4)
12.3 determine P(A | B) (2)
12.4 determine whether A and B are independent events. (5)
14 Ten learners are seated in a row. There are 3 from school A, 5 from school B
and 2 from school C.
14.1 In how many ways can the learners be seated if they can arrange
themselves in any way? (2)
14.2 In how many ways can the learners be seated if each school’s learners
must sit together? (4)
14.3 What is the probability that the learners from each school will be
together, given that the seating arrangement was randomly selected? (3)
14.4 What is the probability that Ntsika, a learner from school A, will be
seated at the end, given that the schools sit together? (5)
15 Eighty five people attended a conference. Sixty two of the attendees can
speak English, 39 can speak Afrikaans and 45 can speak Zulu. Ten people
can speak all three languages, 32 can speak both English and Afrikaans,
5 can speak Afrikaans and Zulu but not English, and 11 can speak Zulu only.
Determine:
15.1 n(English or Afrikaans or Zulu)′ (6)
15.2 P(English and Zulu) (2)
15.3 P(English | Zulu) (2)
15.4 P(Zulu | Afrikaans) (2)
16 Tom has eight bags of marbles. Five bags contain 3 blue and 5 green marbles
and the other three bags each contain 4 blue and 6 green marbles. If 1 marble
is drawn at random from any bag, what is the probability that the marble
will be blue? (6)
282
Question 1
1.1 Solve for x:
1.1.1 (x − 2)2 = 8 + x (4)
1.1.2 x − 4 = _____
−6
x+3
(4)
√___________
2013
x
1.3 Given f(x) = 2012 , determine, without a calculator, the value of
2009
x +x
f(x) if x = 2. (4)
1.4 If 2x−1 + x−2 = 3 and x < 0, determine, without the use of a calculator,
the value of (x2 − 3x)−1. (5)
[29]
Question 2
2.1 A class of 30 learners wrote a mathematics tests. The lowest test score
was 30%. No two learners scored the same mark and every succeeding mark
in the class was 2% higher than the previous one.
2.1.1 Use the above information to write down the first 3 test scores as
a sequence. (1)
2.1.2 What was highest mark in the class? (2)
2.1.3 What was the total of all 30 tests? (2)
2.1.4 Find the class average for the 30 learners. (1)
[14]
Question 5
5.1 Draw neat sketch graphs of the functions f(x) = _____
−3
x+2
+ 3 and g(x) = −2x + 3.
Show all intercepts with the axes and
any asymptotes. (6)
5.2 Write down the domain of f(x) and the domain of f −1(x). (2)
5.3 About which line is f(x) symmetrical? (2)
5.4 Write down the equation of g−1(x) in the form y = … (2)
[12]
Question 6
6.1 Determine from first principles the derivative of f(x) = −4x2 + 5. (4)
dy
6.2 Find ___ if:dx
6.2.1 y = (3x + 2)2 (3)
8x3 −
6.2.2 y = _______
__ 1
√x
(3)
6.3 For what value of m will the curve of y = mx − 2x 3 have a local minimum
at x = __
1
? 2
(4)
[14]
Question 9
9.1 Alexander creates several different 7 character screen names. He uses
the arrangements of the first 3 letters of his name (ALE), followed by
arrangements of the 4 digits, 1987, his date of birth. How many different
screen names can he arrange in this way? (3)
9.2 A vet surveys 30 of his clients. Sixteen clients have dogs, 12 have cats,
and 6 have fish. Five clients have dogs and cats, 4 have dogs and fish,
1 has a cat and fish and no one has all three kinds of pets.
9.2.1 Draw a Venn diagram to illustrate the above information. (4)
9.2.2 How many of these clients own none of these pets? (1)
9.2.3 The vet is offering free de-worming tablets for dogs to these clients.
What is the probability that the client he chooses at random is a
dog owner? (2)
9.3 The probability that a person picked from the general public is blonde
is 25% and that they are left-handed is 10%. These two events are independent.
9.3.1 What is the probability that a person picked at random from the
general public is right-handed and is not blonde? (4)
9.3.2 What is the probability that a person picked at random from the
general public is either left handed or blonde? (3)
[17]
Question 1
The heights of 60 U15 Rugby players are recorded in the table.
Question 2
The data below shows the temperature of sea water at different depths
in an ocean.
2.1 Determine the least squares regression line y = a + bx for the data.
Round the values of a and b to three decimal places. (4)
2.2 Use the line to predict the temperature to the nearest integer at
a depth of 240 m. (2)
[6]
Question 4
y
In the diagram Q is the centre of the circle and lies on
the line y − 2x = 5. P lies on the circle and the x-axis. T
T lies on the circumference of the circle. PT is a diameter.
Determine:
Q
4.1 the equation of the circle (5)
4.2 the equation of the tangent to the circle at T (4)
4.3 the centre and radius of another circle with x
P
equation x2 − 2x + y2 + 6y + 6 = 0. (4)
[13]
Question 5
5.1 Given sin 40° = a, determine, without a calculator and showing all steps,
each of the following in terms of a:
5.1.1 cos (−50°) (2)
5.1.2 cos 80° (2)
5.1.3 sin 230°. (2)
5.2 Without using a calculator, fully simplify the expression below. Show all
your working.
sin ( 180ο − x ).cos( − x)
__________________________________ (7)
tan ( 360ο − x ).cos(180° + x).sin(90° + x)
[13]
Question 6
6.1 Prove the identity _________
1 + sin 2x ____________
cos x + sin x
cos 2x
= cos x − sin x (5)
Question 8 A
In the diagram, which is not drawn to scale, B, C and D
^ C = 40°. AB is a vertical
lie in the same horizontal plane. DB
24,41°
pole. BD = 96 m and BC = 106 m. The angle of elevation
from C to A is 50°.
8.1 Calculate AC. (2)
8.2 Calculate CD if AC = AD. (3)
8.3 Determine the size of BD ^ C. (3) B 96 m
D
40°
[8]
106 m 50°
Question 9
9.1 In the figure, X, Y and Z are three points on
X Y
the circle with centre O. PZQ is a tangent to the
^ Y = 140°, calculate,
circle at Z. XY || PQ. If ZO O
with reasons, the magnitude of OZ ^ X. (7) 140°
9.2 In the figure, ABCD is a cyclic quadrilateral.
O is the centre of the circle. Redraw the diagram
and prove the theorem that A ^ +C^ = 180ο P Z Q
A
B O
D
C
(6)
Question 11
PR is the diameter of the circle in the figure. SB is S
perpendicular to PR and cuts PR in T. A point V on
the circumference of the circle is joined to P and R.
Prove:
11.1 TAVR is a cyclic quadrilateral. (4) T
2 1 1
P 1 2 3 2
R
11.2 △PSR ||| △PTS (3)
12
11.3 PS2 = PR. PT (2)
A
11.4 △PTA ||| △PVR (3)
11.5 PS2 = PA. PV (4)
[16] V
B
A
In the figure, A is the common vertex of △ABC and △ADC
Area △ ABC
AE is the common height, so __________ = ___
BC
Area △ ADC CD
In the sketch, DE || BC A
∴ ___ = ___
AD AE
DB EC
When using this fact, state the proportionality theorem,
Topic
as well as the parallel lines12
involved. h1 h2
• A line Number
drawn through patterns
the midpoint of one side of a triangle, D E
P
In the figure, PS = SQ and ST || QR
∴ ST = TR S T
C H C H
In the figure, BG || CH || DJ
∴ ___ = ___
BC DH D J D J
CD HJ E K E K
Figure 1 Figure 2
• If two triangles are equiangular, G D
x x
their corresponding sides are in proportion.
A
^ =D
In the figure, G ^; H ^ = ^F
^ = ^E and K y w
H K
∴ ___ = ___ = ___ (△GHK ||| △DEF)
GH HK GK y w
DE EF DF E B F
Topic 10
Euclidean geometry (continued)
When using this fact always mention the similar triangles involved in the order of the corresponding angles. Then
the proportionate sides are easy to find:
the first two letters of each triangle; the last two letters of each triangle, outer letters of each triangle.
• If two triangles have their corresponding sides in proportion, then they are equiangular.
x
x
°–
90
x 90° – x
Q T R
Grade 12 Geomerty
Proportionality theorem A
A line drawn parallel to one side of a triangle divides the other two sides
proportionally.
___
AD ___
= AE | Proportional intercepts, DE || BC
D E
DB EC
___
AD ___
= AE | Proportional intercepts, DE || BC B C
AB AC
___
DB ___
=
EC
| Proportional intercepts, DE || BC
AB AC
Converse proportionality theorem Q
QV ____
QW __
VW || PR | Converse proportionality theorem, ___ =
VP WR h
=k
kx ky
PQ RQ h + k
VW || PR | Converse proportionality theorem, ___ = ____ = ____
VQ WQ k V W
hy
PQ ___RQ ____
| Converse proportionality theorem, ___
h+k P R
VW || PR =
PV RW
= h
Midpoint theorem
F
JK || GH | Midpoint theorem, J and K midpoints of FG and FH
respectively
__
1 J K
JK = 2 GH | Midpoint theorem, J and K midpoints of FG and FH
respectively
G H
Q R
N P
A
z
x y x y
B C E F
___
AB ___
=
AC ___
=
BC
| △ABC ||| △DEF
DE DF EF
If two triangles have their corresponding sides in proportion, they are equiangular
M
G
kz ky
az ay
H ax J N kx P
GJ ___
HJ __
| Corresponing sides in proportion, ____
GH ___ a
△GHJ ||| △MNP = =
MN MP NP k
=
^ =M
G ^, H ^ =N
^ and ^J = P
^ | △GHJ ||| △MNP
The perpendicular line drawn form the vertex of the right angle of a right-angled triangle to the
hypotenuse divides the triangle into two triangles that are similar to each other and similar to the
original triangle.
B
D C
A
A summary of all notations and definitions that were • When applying any of these techniques to solve
studied in Grade 11 appear on the first page of this probability problems, remember:
topic.
• You can use Venn diagrams, tree diagrams and
probability of an event
the number of ways an event can occur
contingency tables studied in Grade 11 to assist = _________________________________________
the total number of possible outcomes for the event
with certain probability questions.
• The fundamental counting principle:
– If there are a ways that one event can be
performed, b ways that a second event can be
performed, c ways that a third event can be
performed, and so on, then there are
a × b × c × … ways in total that the events can
be performed successively.
Term 3 summary 293
294
295
Although Grade 10 lays a critical foundation for Grades 11 and 12, work covered in
Grade 10 is not directly examinable in the final examination.
All work covered in Grade 11 is examinable, although you will not cover it again in
Grade 12.
In the mid-year examination, trial examination and final examination, you will be
examined on the entire Grade 11 curriculum.
It is essential that you spend time revising Grade 11 work as it will form the greater
part of the mid-year examination.
The table below contains the mark distribution for the Mathematics NCS End-of-year
Grade 12 papers.
PAPER 1
PAPER 2
296 Term 4
B
Complex 30% • Solve problems involving ( x −__1)3
1 Determine f ’( x ) if f( x ) = _______
procedures complex calculations and/or √x
45 marks
higher order reasoning 2 If cos ( α − β )
• Solve problems not having an = cos α cos β + sin α sin β, derive a formula
obvious route to the solution for:
• Solve problems not based on a 2.1 cos ( α+ β )
real world context 2.2 sin ( α+ β )
• Make significant connections 3 Determine the equation of the tangent
between different representations which touches the circle
• Conceptual understanding x2 + 2x + y2 − 4y = 5 at the point (−4;1).
P ^ +R
^+Q ^ +R
^ = 180∘ ⇒ P = 180∘ − ( Q ^)
| ∠ sum △PQR
r − q cos( 180∘ − ( Q + R ) )
RHS = ______________________
q − r cos( 180 − ( Q + R ) )
∘
r + q cos( Q + R )
= ______________
( )
q + r cos Q + R
298 Term 4
Question 1
__ __ _______
___
1.3 Determine a possible value of p2 + q2 if √p + √ q = √ 9 + √56 . (7)
[25]
Question 2
A quadratic pattern has a third term equal to 2, a fourth term equal to –2
and a sixth term equal to −16. Calculate the second difference of this
quadratic pattern. [5]
Question 3
3.1 The third term of an arithmetic sequence 11 and the sum of the second
and fifth terms is 26. Determine the constant difference and the value of the
first term. (5)
4
3.2 Evaluate ∑ 12 × 2 1 −n
(4)
n = −1
4.1 Siseko buys a house for R600 000. He pays a deposit of R42 000 and
his monthly payments are R7 500.
The interest rate is 11,25% per annum, compounded monthly. He pays
the deposit immediately and his first monthly repayment one month
after securing the loan.
4.1.1 Determine the deposit as a percentage of the house price? (1)
4.1.2 How long will it take him to pay off the loan? (4)
4.1.3 What is the amount of his final payment? (4)
Question 5
y
g h
C(3;9)
2
A(1;1) x
–2 B y=–
5
3
3 6
5.4 Calculate ∑f x − ∑f x .
( ) ( ) Show all working. (4)
x=0 x=4
[22]
Question 7
7.1 If f( x ) = − __
2 , determine f ’( x ) by using the definition.
x (5)
7.2 Determine:
7.2.1 ___
d [ ( 2x − 3 )( 5x + 1 ) ] (3)
dx
( x + 3 )3
_______
7.2.2 g ’( x ) if g( x ) = __ (4)
√ x3
7.3 y f(x) = x³ – 4x ² – 11x + 30
E
A
x
B C D
F
3 2
f( x ) = x − 4x − 11x + 30 has been sketched above.
7.3.1 Show that (x − 2) is a factor of f(x). (2)
7.3.2 Determine the coordinates of A, B, C and D. (5)
7.3.3 Determine the coordinates of the stationary points E and F. (5)
7.3.4 Determine the equation of the tangent to f at x = 1. (3)
[27]
Question 8
There are 1 000 Grade 12 learners at Fiseka High School. All of them take either
Mathematics or Mathematical Literacy as a subject. The table below is incomplete,
but shows that 300 girls take Mathematics, 120 boys take Mathematical Literacy
and there are 640 boys in total.
8.1 Copy the table and fill in the missing values. (3)
8.2 What is the probability that a randomly selected Grade 12 learner is a boy
who takes Mathematics? (2)
[5]
D G F
C E B
The cone has a height of 10 cm and a radius of 5 cm. The volume of a cylinder is
given by V = πr 2h and the volume of cone is given by V = __
1 πr2h. The radius of the
3
cylinder is x cm.
9.3 Determine the maximum volume of the cylinder which can be inscribed in this
cone. (4)
[9]
Question 10
A bar code is designed with a mixture of letters and numbers. The first three values
must be letters from the alphabet and the last four values may be any numbers
from zero to nine.
10.1 If there are no restrictions, how many bar codes are possible? (3)
10.2 If no letter or numbers may be repeated, how many bar codes are possible? (3)
10.3 What is the probability that a randomly selected code has no vowels,
contains only prime numbers and has no repeated letters or numbers? (3)
[9]
Question 1
The following 19 consecutive batting scores were recorded for the top run scorer at
Thembisa High School during the cricket season:
67 11 28 42 49 61 52 40 42 60 53 31 76 47 71 79 41 54 59
[8]
Question 2
The response time to a stimulus was measured for 13 people of varying ages.
The results are summarised below in the table.
Age (years) x 17 20 22 23 25 31 33 38 40 45 53 59 72
Time (seconds) y 0,8 0,9 1,0 0,8 1,3 1,1 1,2 1,5 1,4 1,6 1,7 1,9 2,3
Give your answers correct to four decimal places for this question.
2.2 Calculate the equation of the least squares line for this data. (4)
2.5 If Vinnie is 65 years old, estimate his response time to the stimulus. (2)
[12]
A
M
C
0
x
O D
A is the centre of the circle which touches the x-axis at D(4;0) and crosses
the y-axis at C(0;2) and B(0;8). AM ⊥ BC.
3.6 Determine the equations of the two tangents to the circle which are
perpendicular to the tangent at C. (8)
Question 4
Do not use a calculator in any part of this question.
___
4.1 Given 3 tan β + 5 = 0, β ∈ [ 180°;360° ], evaluate √ 34 ( cos β − cos ( 90° + β ) ). (4)
4.3 Calculate the value of ( sin 105° + cos 105° )2. (3)
cos 2θ − sin 90° + θ ( )
4.4 Prove the identity __________________
( )
cos θ − 1
= ________ (5)
sin 2θ + cos 90° − θ sin θ
[18]
5.1 5.1.1 Determine the general solution of cos 2x = sin ( x + 60° ). (6)
5.1.2 Hence, solve for x if cos 2x = sin ( x + 60° ) and x ∈ [ − 90°;180° ]. (2)
5.2 Draw, on the same set of axes f( x ) = cos 2x and g( x ) = sin ( x + 60° ) for
x ∈ [ − 90°;180° ]. Show clearly all the intercepts on the axes and the
coordinates of the turning points. (6)
Question 6
K
D G
x
x
y
E F
The figure shows the boundaries of a sports field DEFG. DG || EF and DE ⊥ EF.
KG is a vertical pylon for a floodlight. The angle of elevation of K from F is x.
^ F = x, DF
ED ^G = y and KG = h m.
^ F in terms of x and y.
6.1 Express DG (3)
h cos ( y − x )
6.2 Prove that DF = ___________ (6)
sin x
[9]
Question 7
7.1 P
T
Q R
^
△PQR is a right-angled triangle with QRP = 90° and RT ⊥ PQ.
Prove Pythagoras’ Theorem by similar triangles. (8)
G2 F
12
34
1 O
23
1
4
D
E
AC and AE are tangents to the circle at B and D respectively. F is a point
on the circle with centre O.
7.2.1 Prove that BG = GD. (4)
7.2.2 Prove that ABOD is a cyclic quadrilateral. (4)
7.2.3 Prove that O^ =F ^ (3)
1
^
7.2.4 If OD bisects BDF, prove that AE || BF. (6)
7.2.5 Prove that BG2 = AG.GO (3)
7.2.6 If GO = 9 units and AO = 25 units, determine the length of OD. (4)
[32]
Question 8
A
E
F
D
C
B
8.1 AE : EF : FC (4)
8.2 DE : BF (4)
8.3 __________
Area △ADE (4)
Area △ABC
Question 1
1.1 Solve for x: Leave your answers in simplified surd form where necessary.
1.1.1 x2 – 2x – 4 = 0 (3)
_____
1.1.2 √ x + 7 + 1 = 2x (4)
1.1.3 (2x − 3)(x + 1) ≥ 33 (5)
__
2
1.1.4 4x 3 = 9 (2)
1.1.5 8x.____
1 = ___
1 (3)
x−1
4 32
1.2 If 2x2
− 5xy − 12y2 = 0 and xy > 0:
1.2.1 find the value of __
x
y (3)
1.2.2 if x + y = 4 , use this and your answer from 1.2.1 to solve for x and y . (3)
[24]
Question 2
2.1.1 Write down the first four terms of pattern 1 and pattern 2. (2)
2.1.2 Which pattern is linear and which is quadratic?
Give a reason for your answer. (2)
2.1.3 Write down a formula for Tn, the nth term of the pattern 1. (2)
2.1.4 Write down a formula for Tn, the nth term of the pattern 2. (5)
2.2 In a geometric progression the third term is 24 and the sixth term is 3.
Find the sum to 10 terms. (5)
2.3 ___
24 + 12 + 6x + 3x2 + ... is an infinite geometric series.
x
2.3.1 Find the values of x for which the series converges. (4)
2.3.2 Find the sum to infinity in terms of x. (3)
n
3.1 Write down an expression for the value of the investment after n full years. (2)
3.2 What will be the value of the investment at the end of 8 years? (2)
3.3 If the value of the investment exceeds R10 000 after n full years, calculate
the minimum value of n. (2)
3.4 Jano takes out an annuity of R55 per month, instead of investing the
lump sum of R5 000. If his payments start in one month’s time, what
would his investment be worth after 8 full years if he receives the
same interest rate of 7,2% p.a. compounded monthly? (3)
3.5 How long will it take for the investment in 3.4 to exceed R10 000? (3)
[12]
Question 4
4.2 Determine the equation of q(x), the graph obtained by reflecting h(x)
in the y-axis. (1)
4.3 Determine the equation of h−1(x), the graph obtained by reflecting h(x),
in the line y = x.
Write your answer in the form y = … (2)
4.5 Sketch the graph of h–1(x) on the same set of axes as h(x) and use it
to determine the values of x for which is h–1(x) ≥ −3. (4)
[10]
Question 5
The figure shows the graphs of y = f(x) = _____4 + 1 and g(x) = 2x + 3. y
x+2
A is the y-intercept of both graphs, C is the point of intersection of the g
asymptotes of f(x) and D and E are the x-intercepts of the two graphs.
B is a point of intersection of f(x) and g(x). A
f
5.1 Write down the coordinates of C. (2)
C
5.2 Write down the coordinates of A and B. (5)
x
D E
5.3 For which values of x is f(x)g(x) ≤ 0? (3)
[12] B
6.1 If f(x) = −x2 + 3x, determine the derivative, f ’(x), from first principles. (4)
dy
6.2 Determine ___ for these functions:
dx
__
6.2.1 y = √3
x − ___
1 (3)
3x
5x3 − 5
6.2.2 y = _______ (3)
x−1
6.3 The figure shows the curve of f(x) = ax3 + 1. y
Point P(2;5) lies on the curve of f.
6.3.1 Show that a = __ 1. (2)
2
6.3.2 Determine the average gradient of the curve between x = 2
and x = 4. (3) P(2;5)
6.3.3 Determine the equation of the tangent to f(x) at point P. (3)
6.3.4 The graphs below represent f(−x) or f −1(x) or −f(x).
Match the graph with its function and write down the letter x
corresponding to each function on your answer sheet. (3)
y y y
P(5;2)
P(–2 ;5)
x x x
P(2;– 5)
A B C
[21]
Question 7
The graphs of the functions f(x) = −x3 + 6x2 − 9x + k and y
g(x) = ax2 + bx + c are drawn below.
8.2 Hence show that the area of light L, let in by the window is given
4x metres
by A = 32x − 8x2 − 2πx2. (3)
8.3 Find the value of x, correct to two decimal places, that should be used
to allow this design to let in the maximum amount of light. (4)
[8]
Question 9
9.1 If you are given 2 yellow cards, 1 red card, l green card and 1 blue card,
determine the number of different ways in which you can arrange these
cards in a single row. (2)
9.2 There are 75 boys in Grade 12 in a school. Forty eight play rugby,
8 play rugby and hockey, 12 play squash and 2 play hockey
and squash. If 1 boy plays all three sports and 4 boys do not play any sport,
what is the probability that a Grade 12 boy chosen at random plays only
hockey and no other sport.
(Hint: Draw a Venn diagram.) (6)
9.3 A team of 3 learners is chosen at random to take part in a debate. The team
is chosen from a group of 7 girls and 3 boys. Find the probability that:
9.3.1 only girls are chosen (4)
9.3.2 two girls and one boy is chosen. (3)
[15]
Question 1
1.1 If the following set of numbers (5; 7; 8; x; 15) has a mean of 9, calculate
the standard deviation. (4)
1.2 A scientist has 100 female rats and 100 male rats. She measured their lengths
(excluding the tail) to the nearest cm and represented her results in the
box-and-whisker diagrams below.
Female rats
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
Male rats
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
Question 2
A number of bacterial cultures were grown in a laboratory for a Life Sciences
experiment. The results showing the number of bacteria in millions and their
ages in days are recorded in the table.
2.1 Draw a scatter plot with a scale up to 15 days on the x-axis and a scale up
to 415 million on the y-axis. (3)
2.2 Determine the equation of the least squares regression line and the
correlation coefficient, r. Use r to comment on the results. (4)
2.3 Readings were taken a few days later and recorded in the table below.
2.3.1 Plot these on your graph and describe what they show. (2)
2.3.2 Would you use the least square regression line to predict the number
of bacteria for 16 days? Explain whether you would you be using
interpolation or extrapolation. (2)
[11]
3.1 A(3;2), B(1;a) and C(4;5) are points in the Cartesian plane. Determine
the value(s) of a if :
3.1.1 A, B and C are collinear (4)
___
3.1.2 the length of AB = √20 units. (5)
3.2 Consider the points A(−2;8), B(2;4), C and D that are the vertices of
a parallelogram. The equation of line BD is 3y − x = 10.
y
A(–2;8 )
B(2;4)
P
D
x
Determine:
3.2.1 the coordinates of D and C (4)
3.2.2 the equation of AC (4)
3.2.3 the coordinates of P, the point of intersection of the two diagonals (2)
3.2.4 by calculation that ABCD is a rectangle (4)
3.2.5 the magnitude of AD ^ B. (5)
[28]
Question 4
A B
x
O
M
4.1 Determine the coordinates of M and the radius of the circle. (5)
4.2 Find the coordinates of A and B, the points of intersection of the circle
and the x-axis. (4)
4.3 Determine the equation of the tangent to the circle at the point A. (4)
[13]
Question 6
Given _____________
cos 2x = ___________
cos x − sin x
3
(cos x + sin x) 1 + sin 2x
6.1 Prove the identity. (5)
6.2 For which values of x in the interval [0°;360°] is the identity undefined? (5)
[10]
Question 7
7.1 Find the general solution to the equation cos 2x = sin(x − 45°). (5)
7.2 Sketch the graphs of f and g on the same system of axes for x ∈ [−180°;180°].
Indicate the x- and y-intercepts and the coordinates of the turning points. (6)
7.3 Use the graphs to find values of x ∈ [−90°;90°] for which f(x) > g(x)? (2)
[13]
Question 8
In the figure below, AB and CD are two vertical towers of equal height 50 m
standing on a horizontal plane BDE. From E the angle of elevation of A is 42°
and the angle of elevation of C from E is 23°.
50 m
C
B
42° 50 m
23°
E D
^ D = 55°, calculate the area and perimeter of the horizontal plane BED.
8.2 If BE (4)
[8]
O
A
9.3 In the diagram below O is the centre of the circle BCD. CD is produced
to A so that AO ⊥ BC. AO and BD intersect at E. B^ = 35°.
1
B
2 1
35°
1 E 1
A 2 O
2
3
1 2
3
D
10.1 A
D E
B F G C
In the diagram D is a point on AB and E is a point on AC such that DE ∥ BC.
G is the midpoint of BC. F is another point on BC such that AF ∥ EG
and ___
AD = __
1.
DB 5
B C
Q R
10.3 In the diagram below MN and MQ are tangents to the circle PQN and
NM || PQ.
N
1 2
1 2
Q M
Exam Tips
How to prepare for final examinations
Here are suggestions to help you prepare for the final matriculation Mathematics papers:
• Do not cram! Start your preparations early. Remember that you have been preparing for these examinations since the start
of Grade 11. The curriculum for the Grade 12 examination papers covers everything that was taught in Grades 11 and 12.
You may have forgotten some of the details about the work done in Grade 11, so it will be necessary to revise it.
• Plan a carefully structured revision schedule that is realistic, and then keep to it.
• First ensure that you are fully aware of all of the definitions, laws, formulae and rules for each topic. Learn the proofs
that are required for examination purposes. Bookwork will make up part of the marks in the papers.
• Go through each topic and make a summary of the essential rules and methods, as well as reminders of when to use
each method. Write these out on clearly presented pages, using bold headings and colour. Put this somewhere where
you will often see it. Read it over many times.
• Use the internet if there is a topic you are feeling unsure of, or if there is a question that you are battling to understand.
There are videos that teach certain topics and websites that take you through step-by-step explanations of how to
tackle certain topics. The internet may also provide you with answers to questions that trouble you.
• The best way to revise mathematics is to do mathematics. Mathematics is a subject that requires lots of practice; it is
best that this practice is consistent and regular. You will improve your mathematics only when you start working through
problems. The more you practise, the more you will start getting the answers correct. The more answers you get correct,
the more your confidence will grow. Having confidence in your mathematics is the key to doing well in this subject,
especially when you are in examination situations. Start by practising the work topic by topic. First ensure that you have
remembered all the concepts and methods covered in each topic, and then move on to essential practice doing mixed
exercises or examination papers. This will help you recognise when to use each method.
• Make sure that you practise calculator work. The finance and statistics sections, in particular, require a thorough
knowledge of your calculator. If you do not have enough practice at this skill, you may find that you are either
unfamiliar with the process, or very slow at doing calculator work in the examinations.
• As you work through revision exercises, make sure you learn from your mistakes. Look back at tests and examinations
that you have written during Grades 11 and 12. These will remind you of the mistakes that you made in the past.
As you work through past tests and papers as well as revision exercises, make a list of your common errors as well
as concepts or methods that you had forgotten. Keep this list on hand and keep adding to it. Read through this list
regularly to remind you not to make the same errors in the next revision exercise or examination that you practise.
• Do not give up and be too quick to look at a memorandum when you are working through a revision exercise. Spend
time working at a problem before looking at the memorandum. If you keep at it and finally master the problem
yourself, you will have made far more progress in your learning that if you give up and look at the memorandum. If
you do need to look at the memorandum, analyse what it was that you had forgotten; add this to your list of points to
remember.
• It is sometimes useful to work together with a friend or group of people. Discussing a mathematics problem can be
beneficial in terms of hearing other people’s perspectives and thinking patterns. Telling others about your thoughts also
helps consolidate your own understanding. Explaining how to do a mathematics problem to someone else is one of the
best ways of ensuring that you have fully understood it.
• As the final examination date gets closer, practise revision papers under the same conditions that you will have in
the final examination. Do the paper in one sitting and complete it in the correct time allocation, without looking
at memoranda or notes. This will enable you to get used to concentrating for three hours without a break, as well
as ensure that you can complete the paper under the pressure of time constraints. This process of providing an
examination simulation assists in building your confidence for the final examination. It is very important that you
do not enter an examination feeling worried and stressed. If you have examination anxiety, start this examination
simulation process earlier to put yourself in an examination situation often enough for you to feel more confident in the
final examinations.
• Finish your examination preparations by looking at your summary sheets, the list of your common errors and the
bookwork required for the examination.
Exam Tips
How to write examinations
Here are tips to help you cope with the final matriculation mathematics papers:
• Make sure that you have enough sleep the night before an examination! You need a clear, alert and calm mind, which
is only possible when you are fully rested.
• Have all necessary stationery (including a ruler, pencil, eraser and spare pen), and remember to check that your
calculator is set on deg and not rad or grad.
• Avoid last minute cramming and talking through the work with friends immediately prior to an examination. This often
causes you to panic.
• Read the instructions carefully (for example, take note of how many decimal places answers require). Make sure you
answer all parts of a question, and do not forget to look at the back page of the question papers.
• Use the reading time before the examination starts to plan your approach. Take note of the questions that you can see
will be difficult and leave them to the end. Look for the easiest questions and make sure that you do them early in the
examination time. You can answer your examination in any order, as long as you label your questions correctly.
• Do not panic! If you have prepared yourself well by revising and practising, you do not need to stress. If you come
across a question that you cannot do, leave it out and try not to think about it. There will always be questions in an
examination that are meant to extend you. Firstly complete all the questions that you know how to do when you are in
a calm state of mind. Then go back and tackle the more challenging questions.
• As soon as you are allowed to start writing, jot down the rules and identities that you think you may forget so you can
refer to them when you need them. However, do not spend too long writing out all the rules; this might cause you
time pressures towards the end of the examination.
• Do not spend too long on any one question. As you have 180 minutes in which to complete 150 marks, spend
1,2 minutes on each mark. If you have been battling with a question for too long, leave it out and move on. Once you
have finished the examination and if you have time, return to the questions that you did not complete.
• Show all your working. The mark allocation will be an indication of how much working is required.
• If a question requires you to use an answer from a previous question that you were unable to answer, estimate an
answer for the previous question so you can show that you know the method required for the new question. Tell the
examiner that your first answer is an estimate, and you will score part marks for using the correct method.
• Do not forget to write the units with answers that require units and to write degree symbols for angles.
• In questions where you are asked to prove, or show, a statement to be true, do not use what you have been asked to
prove. Remember to set out your argument clearly and to include all steps of working, giving reasons.
Exam Tips
What bookwork do you need to know?
Here is a list of the derivations and proofs that you must learn for the final matriculation mathematics papers.
PAPER 1
Sequences
• Derivations of the formulae for the sum of arithmetic and geometric series, including S∞ .
PAPER 2
Trigonometry
sin θ ; sin2 θ + cos2 θ = 1
• Derivations of basic identities: tan θ = _____
cos θ
• Derivations of all compound and double angle formulae, accepting that cos ( α − β ) = cos α cos β + sin α sin β
• Derivations of the sine, co sine and area rules
Euclidean Geometry
Proofs of circle theorems:
• The line drawn from the centre of a circle perpendicular to a chord bisects the chord.
• The angle subtended by an arc at the centre of a circle is double the size of the angle subtended by the same arc
at the circle (on the same side of the chord as the centre).
• Angles subtended by a chord of the circle on the same side of the chord are equal.
• The opposite angles of a cyclic quadrilateral are supplementary.
• Two tangents drawn to a circle from the same point outside the circle are equal in length.
• The angle between the tangent to a circle and the chord drawn from the point of contact is equal to the angle in
the alternate segment.
3.3 T19 = −52 7.2 The letter T appears 79 times in row 20.
Sequence B:
TOPIC 1: EXERCISE 3
3.1 x=4
Sequence A:
3.2 Tn = 7n − 11
1.1 1 875
3.3 T19 = 122
1.2 Tn = 3 × 5n−1
Sequence C:
1.3 Tn = 46 875
3.1 x = 1,5
1.4 n=8
3.2 Tn = −7,5 + 2,5n
Sequence B:
3.3 T19 = 40
1.1 2
Sequence D:
1.2 a=2
3.1 x = − 0,5 Tn = 2n − 4
3.2 Tn = − 6,5 + 1,5n 1.3 T7 = 8
Sequence C:
TOPIC 1: EXERCISE 2 1.1 162
1.1 −5; 2; 9
1.2 a = 2 and r = −3
Tn = 7n − 12 Tn = 2(– 3)n –1
Answers 319
Tn = 2n – 1
1 2 048
2.3 If If x = − __ _____
3 , T10 = 3 3.3 Tn = 17 – 3n
1
If x = 7, T10 = 50 × __
5 ( )9 2
= ______
78 125 4 T1 = 2; T2 = 8; T3 = 14;
Sequence D: Tn = 2 + ( n − 1 ) ( 6 ) = 6n − 4
2.1 x = 49 or x = 4 5 S55 = 5 445
2.2 If x = 4, Tn = 3 × ( −2 )n−1 6 First three terms: 2; 5; 8
If x = 49, Tn = 48 × __7 n−1
4 ( ) Tn = 3n – 1
2.3 If x = 4, T10 = −1 536
7
If x = 49, T10 = 3 × __
4 ( )9 = ___________
121 060 821
16 384 TOPIC 1: EXERCISE 6
1 1
T1 = 96; T2 = 24; T3 = 6; Tn = 96 × __
4 ( )n
−1 2 S 10 = 557,89
6 560
3 S8 = _____
81
2 If r = −5, T1 = 3; T2 = −15; T3 = 75 and
Tn = 3 × ( −5 )n − 1 4 S10 = 3 906,2496 ≈ 3 906,25
If r = 4, T1 = 3; T2 = 12; T3 = 48 and
5 T5 = 1
Tn = 3 × 4n−1
3.1 If x = 12, y = 18
3 1
If x = __ __
4, y = − 42
320 Answers
2.3 ∑2 × 9n −1
4.1 4 + 8 + 12 + … + 732
n=1 4.2 3 + 9 + 27 + … 729
2.4 Sn = 10 761 680
4.3 67 344 + 1 092 = 68 436
3.1 2
Tn = 36 − __
3 ( ) n−1
5.1 5 + 10 + 15 + 20 + … + 100
∞
3.2 ∑ ( 3) 2 n−1
36 − __ 5.2 3 + 6 + 12 + … + 96
n 1
=
6.1 67 and 92
4 n=8
5 6.2 Tn = 2n2 − n + 1
5 ∑r 3 = 224 7.1 1 ( )( )
Area of Triangle 1 = __
r=2 2 2 1 =1
1 ( )( )
Area of Triangle 2 = __
2 4 2 =4
TOPIC 1: EXERCISE 9
1 ( )( )
Area of Triangle 3 = __
2 6 3 =9
1 S∞ = 4 915,2 cm2
1 ( )( )
Area of Triangle 3 = __
2 8 4 = 16
2.1 7th week
1 ( )( )
Area of Triangle n = __
2 2n n = n
2
2.2 138 km
7.2 This is a quadratic sequence or pattern.
2.3 S10 = 840 km
Answers 321
1.1 geometric sequence 9.3 On the 90th day she will cycle 282 km.
This is an excessive distance, it is unlikely that
1.2 Tn = 3 × 2n−1
she will be able to maintain this programme!
1.3 n=6
10.1 –3
1.4 T10 = 1 536
10.2 Tn = n2 − 14n + 45
1.5 T20 = 1 572 864
11.1
50
Sn = a + ar + ar 2 + … + ar n−2 + ar n−1
1.6.1 ∑3 × 2 n−1
➀
n=1 2 n−2 n−1 n
r Sn = ar + ar + … + ar + ar + ar
1.6.2 S50 = 3 ( 250 − 1 ) ➁
Sequence C: ➀ − ➁: Sn − r Sn = a 0 0 0 0 −ar n
a ( 1 − rn ) a ( rn − 1 )
1.1 quadratic sequence Sn ( 1 − r ) = a ( 1 − rn ) ⇒ Sn = ________ ________
(1 − r) = r − 1 , r
≠1
1.2 Tn = n2 + 2n − 3
3
11.2.1 r = __
5
1.3 T9 = 96
( __35 )
n
→ 0 as n → ∞
1.4 1 536 is not a term in the sequence as n must be
a natural number. ∞
322 Answers
−8S20 = 9( 1 − 920 )
TOPIC 2: EXERCISE 1
Take out a common factor of 9
9 ( 1 − 920 ) − 9 ( 920 − 1 ) 9 ( 920 − 1 ) 1.1 One-to-one
S20 = _________
−8
= ___________ = _________
−8 8
1.2 Many-to-one
1
8 r = __
3 , a = 162 1.3 One-to-many
9.1 The third term = 72 1.4 One-to-one
9.2.1 Tn = −2n − 3 1.5 Many-to-one
9.2.2 Tn = 3n+1 2.1 Yes
Answers 323
3.2 y ≥ − 1 or y ≤ − 1 (0;1)
3. 3 y ≥ 2 or y ≤ 2 x
(–3;0) (1;0)
5.1 g(−1) = 0 −x + 6 x
c) y = _______
2 = −__ + 3
2
g(0) = 3
g(1) = 0 d) Domain f: x ∈ ℝ; Range f: y ∈ ℝ
Domain f −1: x ∈ ℝ Range f −1: y ∈ ℝ
5.2 Domain: {−1; 0; 1}
Range: {0; 3; 0 } 1.3 a) and b) y y= x
f ¯¹
5.3 (–3;1)
y
x
(0;3) (–3;–1)
(–1;–3) (1;–3)
x
f
(–1;0) (1;0) y = –3x ²
___
c) y=±√ 3 ,x≤0 −x
___
g
d) Domain f: x ∈ ℝ
5.4 g(x) is a function because a vertical line cuts it Range f: y ∈ ℝ, y ≤ 0
once. This means for every x there is one Domain f −1: x ∈ ℝ, x ≤ 0
y value. Range f −1: y ∈ ℝ
5.5 g(x) is a many-to-one function 1.4 a) and b) y y = x² + 1
f y=x
6
x 0 1 4 9 16 25
(–2;5) (2;5)
5 or 6 or 7 or 8 or 9 or –1
y 4 (5;2) f
3 2 1 0 -1
(0;1) (1;0)
x
It is not a function because for every x, except
x = 0, there are two y values, which shows it is a (5;–2)
one-to-many relation.
324 Answers
d) Domain f: x ∈ ℝ A(–2;5)
Range f: y ∈ ℝ, y ≥ 1
(0;0)
Domain f −1: x ∈ ℝ, x ≥ 1 x
1
Range f −1: y ∈ ℝ f
(5;–2)
2.1 A(−1;−1) B(3;−9) ___
1 3 5.5 y = + √__
4
5x
2.2 y = − __ x − __
2 2
___ 6.1 f(x) and g(x) are functions.
2.3 y = ± √ −x , x ≤ 0
6.2 f and g are inverses.
2.4 f –1 is not a function. f is a many-to-one function
and the inverse is f –1. Therefore this is a one-to- 6.3 f and g are inverses.
many relation and not a function.
6.4 f and g are inverses.
Restriction: x ≥ 0 or x ≤ 0
1 1
2.5 LHS = −2x − 3 + ____ __
2 + 3 = −2x − 2 TOPIC 2: EXERCISE 3
−x x
2
RHS = ____
2 − (−2(−x) − 3) −3
−x 1 a)
2 2 y
= ____2 − 2x + 3 − 3 = −2x − __2
−x x 6
∴ LHS = RHS 5
4
3 f
3.1 a) and b) y 2
1
x
f –1 –6 –5 –4 –3 –2 –1
–2
1 2 3 4 5 6
f 1
–3
–4
–5
x
(3;–1) –6
g
(–3;–3)
(3;–3) 1
b) y = ______
(x − 3)
−2
f 2 a) y f
____
3.2 −1
f :y = ± √ −3x x≤0
8
g −1: y = −3x f 1
6
3.3 y=x
4
5
5.1 a = __
4
–6 –5 –4 –3 –2 –1
–2
1 2 3 4 5 6
___
y = − √__
–3
4
5.2 5x
–4
–5
–6
5.3 Domain of f : x ∈ ℝ, x ≤ 0
Range of f −1: y ∈ ℝ, y ≤ 0 b) 1
y = ______ +4
(x − 2)
Answers 325
(0;4) (4;5)
(5;4)
(0;2) (–1;0)
(4;0)
(2;0) (0;–1)
4
b) y = _____
x−4
b) 1x + 2
y = −__
2 c) Range of f: y ∈ ℝ; y ≠ 4;
c) Range of f: y ∈ ℝ Domain of f − 1: x ∈ ℝ; x ≠ 4
Domain of f −1: x ∈ ℝ 3.1 A and C
2.2 a) y B and D
3.2 A and D
(0;4) E and C
4.1 q(x) = y = 2x − 6
(–2;0)
(4;0)
4.2 p(x) = y = (x − 1)2
(0;–2) 4.3 y = (x + 3)2 + 2
5.1 (
3 __
A( −1;2 ) and B __ 9
2; 2)
5.2 C(2;−1) and D ( __
2;2 )
3
9 __
b) y = 2x + 4
c) Range of f: y ∈ ℝ 5.3 y=x−3
__
Domain of f −1: x ∈ ℝ 5.4 y = ± √__
x
2
326 Answers
2.1 a) f : y = 5x
( )
1 x
g: y = 5 − x = __
5
5.6.1 x>0 b) Domain f = Domain g: x ∈ ℝ
5.6.2 x < −3 Range f = Range g: y ∈ ℝ, y > 0
5.6.3 x ≥ 0 or x ≤ 0 c) a=2
5.7.1 3 2.2 a) f: y = 2x
g(x) = y = −2x
5.7.2 −2
b) Domain f = Domain g: x ∈ ℝ
6.1 ( 1 ;−5
A(1;1) and B −__
5 ) Range f: y ∈ ℝ, y > 0
6.2 A(1;1) and D ( −5;−__
5)
1 Range g: y ∈ ℝ, y < 0
1
6.3 1
f −1: y = __ c) a = ___
16
x
( )
x
f and f −1 are the same graphs because 2.3 a) 2
f: y = __
1 3
the graph of y = __x is symmetrical in the line
( )
2 x
y=x g(x) = y = − __
3
6.4 x+4
y = _____ b) Domain f = Domain g: x ∈ ℝ
5
Range f : y ∈ ℝ, y > 0
6.5 y g Range g: y ∈ ℝ, y < 0
y=x 9
c) a = − __
4
g
TOPIC 3: EXERCISE 2
1 1.1 25 = 32
C –5 ; 5 A(1;1)
1.2 103 = 1 000
1 1
B – ; –5
5 1.3 3−4 = ___
81
1.4 53 = 125
6.6.1 0 < x ≤ 1 or x < −5
4
1.5 ( __12 )
−6
= 64
6.6.2 0 < x ≤ __ 5
2.1 log2 16 = 4
7.1 f(−x) = B, f −1(x) = C, −f(x) = A
1
2.2 log3 ___
27 = −3
7.2 C is not a function.
2.3 loga 5 = 2
The range must be restricted to y ≥ 2 or y ≤ 2
2.4 log3 8 = x
4
8.1 y = _____
x−1
_____
2.5 log2 x = y
8.2 y = 1 ± √x − 1 2.6 logc a = 3
__
8.3 y= 3
√ x −1 3.1 x=5
1
3.2 x = ____
100
3.3 x = −3
3.4 x=2
Answers 327
4.8 x=4
d) f − 1(x): y = log 5 x
4.9 x = 2 or x = −1
e) Range of f(x): y ∈ ℝ, y > 0
4.10 x = 3 or x = −1
Domain of f −1(x): x ∈ ℝ, x > 0
d) f −1(x): y = log__1x
d) y = log4 x 2
328 Answers
(7;2)
(–1;0) (1;1) y = log3( x + 2) (9;2)
x (0;1)
(0;–1) y = log 3x
y = –2 x
1 (1;0)
–3; 27
1
27 ;–3
d) f −1(x): y = log3(x + 2)
Answers 329
No symmetry
1.6
y
c) g: y = − 6x
( )
1 1 1 x
– –;
9
2 –;
9
2 d) h: y = __
6
(1;0) x
y = –log1x
3
(–1;0) (9;–2) y = log x 1.3 a) f −1: y = 3x
1
3
b)
Symmetrical about the y-axis or reflections in y y =3 x y=x
the line x = 0 (2;9)
d) h: y = 5x
(0;1)
x
(1;0)
y = log 2 x
9 3
;–2
4
330 Answers
(0;1)
x (0;1)
(1;0) x
y = log 1 x (1;0)
3
y = log 1 x
(9;–2) 8
(64;–2)
d) g(x) = log3 x
d) g(x) = log8 x
e) x ∈ ℝ, x > 0 e) x ∈ ℝ, x > 0
2.2 a) a=2
TOPIC 3: EXERCISE 6
b) f −1: y = 2x
1 y
c) x
y y =2 y=x
(3;8)
Q(2;9) y = 2
(8;3)
(0;1) y= log x x
2
x
–2;1
4
(1;0)
1 ;–2
4
y = log x
3
e) x ∈ ℝ, x > 0 2 y
y = log 1 x
2.3 a) a=5 4
−1
b) f :y= 5x
c)
y y = 5x y=x
x
y = –1
Q(4;–1)
(1;5) y= log5 x
(0;1)
(5;1)
x
(1;0)
d) g(x) = log__1 x
5
e) x ∈ ℝ, x > 0
Answers 331
4.1 k=4
4.2 At Q: y = 0
x = 40 = 1
log5 x ≥ 1 when x ≥ 5 4.3 0 < x ≤ 16
4 y 4.4 y = 4x
y=x –1
5.1 y=1
5.2 x=1
x 5.3 y = log2(x − 1)
2
P(1;0) y = log 1x 6.1 b = __
3
2
6.2 y = log__2 x
3
log__1 x ≥ x − 1 when 0 < x ≤ 1 6.3 y=x
2
5 y 6.4 f y
-1
f
–3; 27
y = log x 8
4 9
–2; 4
x (0;1)
P(1;0) x
(0;–1) (1;0)
9 ;–2
–2;– 9 4
4
27 ;–3
8
y = – 2x+2
h y = log 2 x
log4 x ≤ −2x + 2 when 0 < x ≤ 1 3
6.5 2 x
y = − __ (3)
TOPIC 3: REVISION TEST
6.6 Graph of h
1.1 x = −3
6.7 y ∈ ℝ, y < 0
1.2 x=7
6.8 h is an increasing function because as x
1.3 x = 16 increases the corresponding values of y increase.
( )
1 2 1 x
3.1 a is g(x) = __ __
4 x , b is f(x) = 4
8.1 y = b0 = 1
P = (0;1)
3.2 P = (0;1)
1 8.2 b=4
3.3 k = __
4 a = −3
3.4 x<0 a = −3, b = 4, p = 1, q = 4
332 Answers
10.3 and 10.4 y 6 x = R608,41 (using ANS key for more accurate
f y=x
i(12))
TOPIC 4: EXERCISE 3
f –1
Q(1;2) 1 R11 796,86
P T(2;1) g 2 R96 785,36
x
3.1 R2 045,05
4 R16 222,04
6.2 R3 124,24
TOPIC 4: EXERCISE 1
7.1 9,8%
1.1 n ≈ 8,3%
7.2 R43 418,94
1.2 i = 14,3%
7.3 R51 081,11
2 n ≈ 5,45 years
7.4 R65 262,17
3.1 x = R334 283,73
7.5 R14 181,06
3.2 ieff = 10,47%
334 Answers
5.1 cos x
______ 1
= − _____ 3.3 cos( A + B ) + cos(A − B) = 2cos A cos B
− sin x tan x
LHS = cos A cos B − sin A sin B + cos A cos B
sin x
5.2 − _____ = −1
sin x + sin A sin B
_____ _____
6.1 −k 6.2 √ 1 + k2 6.3 √ 1 + k2 = 2 cos A cos B
__
1 = RHS
7.1 − √3 7.2 − __
2
3.4 sin ( A+B ) + sin ( A − B ) = 2 sin A cos B
8.1 15,24° or 124,76°
LHS = sin A cos B + cos A sin B + sin A cos B
8.2 x = – 30°; 150°; 120°; – 60° − cos A sin B
= 2 sin A cos B
8.3 θ = ± 104,48° + n.360° or θ = 0° + n.360°, n ∈ ℤ
= RHS
8.4 θ = 12°; 192°; –168°; –348°
3.5 cos ( A + B )cos(A − B) = cos2A – sin2B
8.5 n = 27,5° + n.90° or θ = −55° + n.180°, n ∈ ℤ LHS = (cos A cos B − sin A sin B)(cos A cos B
+ sin A sin B)
TOPIC 5: EXERCISE 2 = cos A cos2 B − sin2 A sin2 B
2
1.3 sin 3θ cos 2β + cos 3θ sin 2β 3.6 sin ( A + B )sin(A − B) = cos2 B – cos2 A
LHS = (sin A cos B + cos A sin B)(sin A cos B
1.4 sin x cos 4y − cos x sin 4y − cos A sin B)
2.1 1 = sin A cos2 B − cos2 A sin2 B
2
Answers 335
4.1 a
5
3 x 4.2 a
x a
_______
_____
–4 4.3
√1 − a2
_____
4.4 2a√1 − a2
−24
____
5.4.1 25 4.5 2a
336 Answers
Answers 337
tan x = p
2 tan x
tan 2x = _________
2
1 − tan x
2p
= ______2
1−p
338 Answers
=
(a
2 ________
______ b
)(
________
______
√ a2 + b2 √ a2 + b2
_____________________
) LHS = si n2 x + cos2 x − 2 sin x cos x
_________________________
sin x − cos x
( b 2
________
______
√ a2 + b2 ) (
a
− ________
2______
√ a2 + b2 ) =
sin2 x − 2 sin x cos x + cos2 x
_________________________
sin x − cos x
2ab
(sin x − cos x)(sin x − cos x)
________________________
______ =
a2 + b2 (sin x − cos x)
= ______
2 2
b −a
______ = sin x − cos x = RHS
a2 + b2
sin x + sin 2x
________________
2ab
= ______ 1.3 = tan x
1 + cos x + cos 2x
b2 − a2
sin x + 2 sin x cos x
Alternative solution using tan 2x formula LHS = ____________________
1 + cos x + 2 cos2 x − 1
sin x(1 + 2 cos x)
2 tan x
tan 2x = _________ = _______________
2 cos x(1 + 2 cos x)
1 − tan x
sin x
a
2 ( __ = _____
b)
cos x
b2
= _______ __
a 2 × b2 = tan x = RHS
1 − ( __
b ) (co s2 x − sin2 x)2
______________
2ab 1.4 = cos 2x
= ______ cos4 x − sin4 x
b2 − a2 2 2 2 2
(cos x − sin x)(cos x − sin x)
1
__________ LHS = __________________________
2 2 2 2
sin(A + B) (cos x − sin x)(cos x + sin x)
_________ sin A cos B + cos A sin B cos A cos B
6.1 = ______________________ × __________
cos(A + B) cos A cos B − sin A sin B 1
__________ cos2 x − sin2 x
cos A cos B = ____________
sin A cos B cos A sin B 1
__________ + __________
cos A cos B cos A cos B = cos 2x = RHS
= _____________________
cos A cos B __________
sin A sin B C = (180° – (A + B))
__________ 1 − cos 2x
cos A cos B − cos A cos B 1.5 _________ = tan x
sin 2x
tan A + tan B 1 − (1 − 2 sin2 x)
= _____________ LHS = _______________
1 − tan A tan B 2 sin x cos x
2 sin2 x
6.2 RTP: tan A.tan B.tan C A B = ___________
2 sin x cos x
= tan A + tan B + tan C sin x
= _____
cos x
tan C = tan(180° − (A + B))
= tan x = RHS
tan C = − tan(A + B)
sin 2x − cos x
_______________ cos x
= _____
(
tan A + tan B
tan C = − _____________
1 − tan A tan B ) 1.6 1 − cos 2x − sin x sin x
2 sin x cos x − cos x
LHS = _____________________
tan C(1 − tan A tan B) = − tan A − tan B 2
1 − (1 − 2 sin x) − sin x
tan C − tan A tan B tan C = − tan A − tan B cos x(2 sin x − 1)
= _______________
∴ tan A.tan B.tan C = tan A + tan B + tan C sin x(2 sin x − 1)
cos x
_____
= sin x = RHS
Answers 339
340 Answers
10 x = 30° + n.120°, n ∈ ℤ
x = −30° + n.120°, n ∈ ℤ
Answers 341
342 Answers
sin x + sin 2x
_______________ 1 + 2 cos x
+ (sin 60° cos 20° + cos 60° sin 20°)2 8.3 = __________
1 + sin x − cos 2x 1 + 2 sin x
= [sin2 20° + sin2 60° cos2 20° sin x + 2 sin x cos x
LHS = _____________________
− 2 sin 60° cos 20° cos 60° sin 20° 1 + sin x − (1 − 2 sin2 x)
+ cos2 60° sin2 20° + sin2 60° cos2 20° sin x(1 + 2 cos x)
= _______________
2 sin2 x + sin x
+ 2 sin 60° cos 20° cos 60° sin 20°
sin x(1 + 2 cos x)
+ cos2 60° sin2 20°] = _______________
sin x(2 sin x + 1)
= sin2 20° + 2(sin2 60° cos2 20°) 1 + 2 cos x
= __________ = RHS
+ 2(cos2 60° sin2 20°) 1 + 2 sin x
__
√3 1 8.4 cos2 3x − cos 6x = sin2 3x
= sin2 20° + 2(___)2 cos2 20°) + 2(__)2 sin2 20°)
2 2 LHS = cos2 3x − cos 2(3x)
2 3
__ 2 1
__ 2
= sin 20° + cos 20° + sin 20° = cos2 3x − (cos2 3x − sin2 3x)
2 2
3
__ 2 2 = sin2 3x = RHS
= (sin 20° + cos 20°)
2
1
________ 1 sin 2x tan x
3
__ 8.5 + ________ = ___________
= = RHS 1 + cos x 1 − cos x sin4 x
2
1 − cos x + 1 + cos x
7.1 1
sin(45° + x).sin(45° − x) = __ LHS = __________________
2 cos 2x (1 + cos x)(1 − cos x)
2
= _________
LHS = (sin 45° cos x + cos 45° sin x).(sin 45° cos x 1 − cos2 x
− cos 45° sin x) 2
_____
=
sin2 x
= (sin2 45° cos2 x − cos2 45° sin2 x) 2 sin x cos x( _____
cos x )
sin x
1 1
RHS = ________________
= __ cos2 x − __ sin2 x sin4x
2 2 2 sin2 x
_______
=
1
__ sin4 x
= (cos x − sin2 x)
2
2 2
= _____
1
__ sin2 x
= cos 2x = RHS
2
∴ LHS = RHS
∴ sin 75°.sin 15°
cos 2x − cos x _____
_____________ 1 1
1
= __ 8.6 = − _____
tan x sin x
4 sin 2x + sin x
2cos2x − 1 − cos x
_________________
7.2 sin 105° + cos 105° = cos 45° LHS = 2 sin x cos x + sin x
LHS = sin(45° + 60°) + cos(45° + 60°) (2 cos x + 1)(cos x − 1)
= ____________________
sin x(2 cos x + 1)
= sin 45° cos 60° + cos 45° sin 60° + cos 45° cos 60° (cos x − 1)
= _________
− sin 45° sin 60° sin x
cos x _____1
1__
= ___
1__
cos 60° + ___ 1__
sin 60° + ___ cos 60° RHS = _____
sin x − sin x
√2 √2 √2
(cos x − 1)
1__ = _________
− ___ sin 60° sin x
√2
1__ ∴ LHS = RHS
= 2___ cos 60°
√2
cos4 x + sin2 x cos2 x
_________________
8.7 = 1 + sin x
= 2 ___( )( )
1__ __
√2 2
1 1 − sin x
2 2
cos x(cos x + sin x) 2
1__ LHS = __________________
= ___ = cos 45° = RHS 1 − sin x
√2 (1 − sin2 x)(1)
= ____________
8 Identity proofs 1 − sin x
(1 − sin x)(1 + sin x)
8.1 1 − sin 2x = (sin x − cos x)2 = __________________
(1 − sin x)
LHS = 1 − sin 2x
= 1 + sin x = RHS
= sin2 x + cos2 x − 2 sin x cos x
= (sin x − cos x)(sin x − cos x)
= (sin x − cos x)2
Answers 343
The identity in 8.6 is undefined if: 2.1 BC2 = x2 + x2 − 2x.x cos 120°
x = 0°; 180°; 360°; 120°; 240° = 3x2
__
BC = √ 3 x
9.1 x = 9,74°; 80,27°; −170,26°; −99,74°
300
2.2 x = ____
√
__
9.2 x = 70,53°; 289,47°; −70,53°; −289,47° 3
2.3 A = 48,59° or 131,41°
9.3 x = 90°; 270°
2.4 Area ABDC = 42 307,48 m2
9.4 x = 0°; ± 180°
3–6 Proofs. Refer to your teacher for details
9.5 x = ± 60°; ± 300°; 33,69°; 213,69°;−326,31°;
−146,31°
TOPIC 6: EXERCISE 2
10.1 x = 43° + n.180°, n ∈ ℤ 2
c
of x = −16,5° + n.90°, n ∈ ℤ 1 a2 = __________
2(1 − cos C)
10.2 x = −19,07° + n.360° 2 a = 2c cos C
of x = 39,07° + n.360°, n ∈ ℤ 3–10 Proofs. Refer to your teacher for details
10.3 x = 22,5° + n.90°
2.2 11,47 cm
2.3 9,62 cm
3.1 XA = 16,55 m
3.2 XC = 14,62 m
3.3 AC = 12,31 m
344 Answers
6.2 AC = 102,16 m
TOPIC 7: EXERCISE 1
6.3 CD = 81,47 m
1 −13
6.4 AB = 34,94 m
2 17
7.1 Area △CBD = 582,23 m2
3 6a − 6
7.2 AB = 28,75 m
4 2a2 + a + 2
TOPIC 6: EXERCISE 4 5 0
1–3 Refer to your teacher for details
6 16p3 + 24p2 + 4p
4p sin y
4.1 DC = _______
__
√3 7 8xh + 4h2 − 5h
4.2–4.3 Refer to your teacher for details
8 3a2p + 3ap2 + p3 − 8p
5.1 ^ C = 180° − (x + y)
BD
9 −2
5.2 Refer to your teacher for details 2−a
_____
10 a
5.3 EF = 25,31 m
TOPIC 7: EXERCISE 2
6 Refer to your teacher for details
7.1 ^ V = 82,63°
TQ
1 (x + 1)(x + 2)(x − 2)
2 x(x + 4)(x − 2)
7.2 Area △TQV = 96,695 cm2
3 8(x − 2)(x2 + 2x + 4)
TOPIC 6: REVISION TEST 4 (x − 5)(x2 + 10x + 25)
1 ^ M = 60,5°
VA 5 9x(x + 2)(x2 − 2x + 4)
2 ^ B = 22,2°
ED 6 (x − 3)(x − 2)(x + 2)
Answers 345
1.10 6a2 + 6a + 2
TOPIC 7: EXERCISE 5
−a
_______
1.11 h(a + h)
3
1 x = −1 or x = 2 or x = __ 2 4+b
_____
3 real rational roots 1.12 −b
2.1 (x + 1)(2x − 3)(2x + 3)
346 Answers
3.5.1 a = −5 Function E:
b=2 1 −1,9999
3.5.2 a = −5 Function F:
b=5 2 −3
4.1 (x − 1)(x − 2)(x − 4)
Function G:
4.2 (x − 1)(x + 2)(x − 3) 4
__
2 3
4.3 (x − 3)(x + 2)(x + 4) Function H:
4.4 (x − 2)(2x + 1)(3x − 1) 2 12,5
5.1.1 x = −1 or x = −2 or x = 4 Function J:
2 2
1
5.1.2 x = −2 or x = __
2 or x = 1
1 −3
5.1.3 x = __ ___
2 or x = 2 or x = 1
3
5.1.4 x = −3 or x = __
2 or x = 4
Answers 347
3 mCD = −2 A(–2;7)
1
4 h = __2
x
5 mAB = −5 –1 5
–5
P(3;–8)
TOPIC 8: EXERCISE 3 (2;–9)
1.1 y
g(x) = x² – 5x – 6 y = 2x – 12 2.2 A ( −2;7 )
4
P ( 3;− 8 )
2
P x
–2 –1 –2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 mAB = −3
–4
–6 B 2.3 y = −3x + 1
–8
D
–10 2.4.1 mAB = h − 8
–12
Q (2,5;–12,25)
–14
2.4.2 mAB = − 4
–16
–18
2.5.1 mDE = 2x + h − 4
y = – 6x – 6
2.5.2 m=1
1.4.3 B ( 0;− 6 ); see graph for line through P and B. 3.1 m=3
1.4.4 y = − 6x − 6 3.2 y = 3x + 2
348 Answers
4.3.2 f ’ ( −1 ) = 0 4 g ’( x ) = 2
g ’( 4 ) = 2
4.4 y=4
5 f ’( x ) = 0
4.5 A ( 2;54 ) and B ( −1;0 )
54 − 0 54 f ’ ( −5 ) = 0
4.6 mAB = ________
(
= ___ = 18
3
2 − −1
)
6 − 6x
4.7 C(2 + h; h3 + 12h2 + 45h + 54)
7 f ’ ( x ) = −12x2
4.8 mAC = h2 + 12h + 45
8 g ’ ( x ) = −18x
4.9 f ’ ( 2 ) = 45
9 f ’( x ) = 0
4.10 the gradient of the tangent to f at x = 2.
10 g ’ ( x ) = −12x
4.11 y = 45x − 36
9
11 f ’ ( x ) = − __
2 x
TOPIC 8: EXERCISE 4 12. g ’( x ) = − 6x2
1 f ’ ( x ) = 2x − 1 13 f ’ ( x ) = −5 − 6x
f ’( 2 ) = 3
14 g ’ ( x ) = − 4x + 1
1
2 f ’ ( x ) = − __
2
x
1
f ’ −2 = − __
( ) TOPIC 8: EXERCISE 6
4
dy
___ 2
3 g ’ ( x ) = 15x2 1 = 6x + __2
dx x
g ’ ( 4 ) = 240 5
2 2x − __
2
3 x
4 f ’ ( x ) = − __
2
x 3 1
3
f ’ ( −5 ) = − ___ dy
___ 8
25 4 = − ___3
dx 3x
5 g ’ ( x ) = −10x + 2 1
__
5 50x − 30x2 − 4
g ’ ( −1 ) = 12
6 6t − 4
6 g ’ ( x ) = −2x
3
__
7
x2
TOPIC 8: EXERCISE 5 dy
___
8 dx
= 50x − 20
f ( −3 + h ) − f ( −3 )
________________
1.1 h
= h − 11 9 24x2 − 72x + 54
1.2 lim ( h − 11 ) = −11 10 2__ _____
_____ +
1__
3√x2 2√x3
3
x→0
1.3 f ’ ( x ) = 2x − 5 11 4x − 1
f ’ ( −3 ) = −11
12 10x − 15
1.5 y = −11x − 9
3 2
13 −___2 − __x
7 2x 3
2.1 g ’( x ) = __2
x
2
___ 1
___
2.2 1
g ’ ( −7 ) = __ 14 1 −
__ 1
__
7 3x3 2x2
2.3 g ’ ( −7 ) gives us the gradient of the tangent to g 2
___ 3
___
15 1
__ − 2
__
at x = −7 3x3 5x5
3
2 __ _____
1 = ____ − 5 __2
2.4 y = __
7+2
3√
3
x 5√ x
8 __53
__ 2
__ 18 __ 9
3 f ’ ( x ) = −15x2 16 3 t − 15t 3 + ___
1 + __
__ 4
t3 t3
Answers 349
3.2 p ’( x ) = 2 ⇒ p ’( 3 ) = 2
1.1 f ( x )g ( x ) = 6x5 + 6x4 − 6x3 − 6x2
3.3 2x5 +4x4 + 8x3 − 16x2 − 32x − 64
1.2 LHS = 36x2 + 24x2
RHS = 30x4 + 24x3 − 18x2 − 12x 3.4 18
f( x )
____ 3
___ 3 3.5 10x4 + 16x3 + 24x2 − 32x − 30
1.3 g( x ) = − ___2
2x 2x x+2
4.1 _____
x
1
1.4 LHS = __
x 2
4.2 h ’ ( x ) = − __
2
3 3 x
RHS = − ___ __
2 + 3
2x x
1.5 LHS = 10x + 6x2 TOPIC 8: EXERCISE 8
RHS = 10x + 6x2 1.1 y = 24x − 30
350 Answers
Answers 351
4.2 2
g ” ( 7 ) > 0 concave up at 7;−179__
3 local( ) 7.2 f ’ ( −3 ) > 0 and f ’ ( −2 ) < 0
minimum.
( − __73;18___
27 ) is a local maximum, the first
14
1
g ” ( −5 ) < 0 concave down at −5;108__ local( 3 ) derivative changes from positive to negative.
maximum
f ’ ( 0 ) < 0 and f ’ ( 2 ) > 0
4.3 ( 2
1;−35__
3 ) (1;0) is a local minimum because the first
5.1 ( −2;−10__23 ) and ( 2,5;19___
27 )
17 derivative changes from negative to positive.
5.3 ( 0,25;4___
48 )
25 7.4 ( − __23;9___
27 )
7
2
6.1 (0;0) and ( −2;− 4 ) 7.5 f changes concavity at x = − __
3.
352 Answers
1 y
–1 ;18,52
3 1
–4
x
12 7 –4
1 9 – 3–2 ;–923
–
;
3 26
– ;–1814
–2 31 –
27
x
–3 2
2
f(x) = (x – 2) ( x + 3)
Stationary point(s): −2__1 14
___
(
3 ;−18 27 and ( 1;0 ) )
4
Stationary points: (2;0) − __ 14
___
3 ;18 27 ( )
2
Point of inflection: − __ 7
___
3 ;−9 27 ( )
1 ___
Point of inflection: __ 7
3 ;9 27 ( ) 6 1
Roots: − __
2 ;0( )
y
2 Roots: ( − 6;0 ), ( 1,5;0 ) and ( 6;0 ) f(x) = (2x + 1) 4x2 − 44x + 169
y
(– 3;40,5)
7
1 11 ;512
;11 –
12
2
2 169
x
x 1
–6 1,5 6 −
2
( )
2 7
4;–16
3 Stationary point and point of inflection: __
2 ;512
1 3 1 2
f(x) = x – 2 x – 12x +18
3 7 Roots: ( −2;0 )
2
Stationary points: ( −3;40,5 ) and 4;−16__
3 ( ) y
1
Point of inflection: __ 11
___
2 ;11 12 ( ) f(x) = 34
–x3 – 2 x 2 + x + 62
–
3
8 Roots: (0;0)
Answers 353
– 1–;26,27 •
4 • 22,5
(2,5;2,25)
1 x 2,97 • • 3 x
1,75 • •
4 ;– 25
3 –5,72 (2,5;–1,46)
–– –
3 27
4 ___
Stationary points: ( 2,5;2,25 ) and __ 25
3 ;− 27 ( ) 1
Stationary points: 2__ (
11
___
2 ;−1 24 and ( −3;54 ) )
11
Point of inflection: 1___
12 ;0,66 ( ) 1
Point of inflection: − __ 13
___
4 ;26 48 ( )
10 Roots: (2;0) f(x) = – x3 + 8 y 16 Roots: ( − 4;0 ), ( −3,25;0 ) and ( −2;0 )
Stationary point and
point of inflection: (0;8) y
(0,8) 104
11 Roots: (1;0)
x
2 f(x) = 4x 3 + 37x 2 + 110x + 104
y 3 2
f(x) = 2x – 3x + 8x – 7
1
x
(– 3,67;0,93)
–7 –1 ;– –7 (– 3,08;0,– 66)
2 2 x
–4 –2
(–2,5;–2,25)
3 ; 9 ) and ( 3 ;− 9 )
( − ____
√
2 3 _____
16 3 √
2 3 _____
____ 16 3 √ √
354 Answers
(–1,4;–21,96)
Function B:
–4 (2;–3)
(3;–4) 3
x
(2;0) 4 5
(3;–3) (4;–4)
f ''(x) = 6x – 12
f(x) = x3 – 6x + 9x – 4
–18
6 See the sketch for f ’ and f ”. f''(x) = 6x – 18 –20
Answers 355
The x-coordinate of the turning point of f ’ is The maximum value of f ( x ) for x ∈ [ −5;5 ] is
the same as the x-coordinate of the point of 67,375.
inflection of f. 9 lim f ( x ) = −∞ and lim f ( x ) = ∞
x→−∞ x→∞
When f ’ ( x ) > 0, f is an increasing function and
Function D:
when f ’ ( x ) < 0, f is a decreasing function.
11 11
Function C: 3 f ” ( x ) > 0 if x < ___ ( )
___
8 , f ” x < 0 if x > 8 and
1 There is a stationary point at (3,5; 64)
( ) 11
f ” ___8 = 0, so f changes from concave up to
11
concave down at x = ___ 8.
f ” ( x ) = 6x − 21
f ” ( 3,5 ) = 6 ( 3,5 ) − 21 = 0, so the second 4 x=1
derivative test fails! x ≈ 4,48 or x ≈ 0,64
f ” ( 3 ) = −3 < 0 and f ” ( 4 ) = 3 > 0
5 3
4 x + 11
f (x) = – – – x2 + 3x – 23
–
There is a change in concavity at x = 3,5 and 3 2 6
y
so the stationary point ( 3,5;64 ) is a point of
inflection. f '(x) = – 8x + 11 2
3;183
11
– ;169
–
2 ( 3,5;64 ) from 1 8 16
1
–– 11
2 –
8;
7,22
3 f ” ( 3,5 ) = 0, f ”( x ) < 0 when x < 3,5 and f ”( x ) > 0 4 x
–1 0,64 11 3 4,48
when x > 3,5 so f changes from concave down –8
1 7
– – ;– 4– – 23
4 32 –
to concave up at ( 3,5;64 ) 6
1
4 The only real solution is x = − __
2
2
f '(x) = – 4x + 11x + 3
5 2
f '(x) = 3x – 21x + 147
–
4 6 See graph
y 1
f (x) = –
8
(2x + 1) (4x 2 + 44x + 169)
7 The x-coordinates of the stationary points of
f are same as the x-coordinates of the roots of
(3,5;64) f ’ ( x ).
f ''(x) = 6x – 21
36,75 When f ’ ( x ) > 0 we can see that f is an increasing
21,125 function and when f ’ ( x ) < 0 we can see that f
x
(3,5;0) is a
– 21
decreasing function. When f ” ( x ) < 0, fis
6 See the sketch for f ’ and f ”.
concave down, when f ” ( x ) > 0, f is concave
7 f ’ ( x ) = f ” ( 3,5 ) = 0 so (3,5;64) is both a up and when f ” ( x ) = 0 there is a point of
stationary point and a point of inflection. inflection.
f ’ ( x ) ≥ 0 for all real values of x, so f is never a
8 The minimum value is −18 and the maximum
decreasing function.
value is 285,33.
f ” ( x ) changes sign from negative to positive at
3,5, so there is a change of concavity in f from 9 lim f ( x ) = ∞ and lim f ( x ) = −∞
x→−∞ x→∞
concave down to concave up.
356 Answers
( )
and f ” −__
2
1 = 0, so f changes concavity from
2 1 ( − __23;9___
27 ); ( 2;0 )
13
2
concave up to concave down at x = − __ 1 f ” ( − __
3 ) = −8 < 0 so f is concave down at
2
2.
8 Minimum: −40,5
2
( − __23;9___
27 )
13
2 (1;0)
Answers 357
( 7;36 )
f ’ ( x ) > 0 when f is an increasing function, f ’ ( x )
< 0 when f is a decreasing function.f. ( ) 7
f ” __ ( )
7
__
3 = − 6 3 + 28 = 14 > 0 so f is concave up
2
f ” ( x ) < 0 when x < __ 2
__
3 , f ” x > 0 when x > 3 and
( ) and ( __
3 ;−14 27 ) is a local minimum.
7 22
___
( )
f ” __2
3 = 0, so f changes concavity from concave
2 f ” ( 7 ) = − 6 ( 7 ) + 28 = −14 < 0 so f is concave
down to concave up at x = __ 3. down and ( 7;36 ) is a local maximum.
8 Minimum value is −147 and maximum value is 63
2 ( 4__23;10___
27 )
16
( −__53;−3___
3 2
27 )
7 f(x) = –x + 14x – 49x + 36
2
(7;36)
5
f ” ( −2 ) = 2 > 0 if x < − __
36 2
4 –3 ;16 3
– 1 •
3 , f ” −1 = − 4 < 0
3 ( ) f ''(x) = – 6x + 28
5
__ 5
__
( )
if x > − 3 and f ” − 3 = 0 so f changes from
28 –2 •• 4 2– ;1016
–
3 • • 27
4 2•
3 x
5
concave up to concave down at x = − __ 3.
1
• 4– 7 9
7 3
– ;–1422
–
4 x = −3 3 27
3 2 – 49 2
5 f(x) = –x – 5x – 9x – 9 y f '(x) = –3x + 28x – 49
6 See graph
– 5– ;– 2– 7 The x-coordinates of the roots of f ’ ( x )are the
3 3
– 5– same as the x-coordinates of the stationary
3
x points of f. f ’ ( x ) > 0 when f is an increasing
–3
7 function, f ’ ( x ) < 0 when f is a decreasing
– 5– ;–327
–
3 –9 function.f.
–10
2 2
f ” ( x ) > 0 when x < 4__ __
3 , f ” x < 0 when x > 4 3
( )
( )14
___
and f ” 3 = 0, so f changes concavity from
14
concave up to concave down at x = ___
3.
f '(x) = –3x 2 – 10x – 10
f ''(x) = – 6x – 10 22
8 Minimum −14___
27 and maximum 756
6 See graph
9 lim f ( x ) = ∞ and lim f ( x ) = − ∞
x→−∞ x→∞
358 Answers
( 6;−36 )
–1
x
( )
4
f ” __
3 = −14 < 0 so f is concave down at –2
(–1;–1) –2
( 1__13;14,81 ) and this is a local maximum. –3
4 x = −2
Answers 359
Function N:
1
– ;0,93
3 11 1 f has no stationary points.
–
12
0 1
– 3 11
– – 1,5
– ; – 143 2
x 2 ( __13;−3,41 )
3 4 12 216
1
3 f ” ( 0 ) = −2 < 0 so f is concave down if x < __
3,
(1,5;–2,25) 1
__
f ” ( 1 ) = 4 > 0 so f is concave up if x > 3 and
11
–;– 4,08
12 ( )1
f ” __ 1
__
3 = 0 so f changes concavity at x = 3 from
concave down to concave up.
f''(x) = –24x – 22
4 x=1
6 See graph
5 f '(x) = 3x 2 – 2x + 5 y
7 The x-coordinates of the roots of f ’ ( x )are the same
as the x-coordinates of the stationary points of f.
1 ;4–
2
f ’ ( x ) > 0 when f is an increasing function, f ’ ( x ) < –
3 3
0 when f is a decreasing function. 1
–
5 3
11 11
f ” ( x ) < 0 when x < ___ ___
12 , f ” x > 0 when x > 12
( ) –2 1
x
( )
and f ” ___ 11
12 = 0, so f changes concavity from
11
–5
360 Answers
8.1 y = −9x + 36
x
–3 –1 1 3 8.2 ( −6; 90 )
9.1 (3; 4)
9.2 y = 9x − 23
9.3 y
g
f ’( 3 ) = 0, so f ( −3 ) = f ( 3 ) = 0 and there is a local
(3;4)
maximum at x = 3
6.2 y x
–1 0 2 2.55
2,48
f
(1,24;–3,92)
(0;0) y = 9x – 23
x
–3 10.1 (1;0)
10.2 y = 3x − 3
10.3 y
f g
(O;27) f”
f' (2;2)
f
1
7.1 a = __
2, b = −2, c = 4
−592
7.2.1 y = 8x + _____
27 x
( –0,73 0 1 2.73
7.2.2 3
20
2 ; 4 ___
−__
27 )
is a local maximum
(2; 0) is a local minimum.
(0,5;– 0,75)
7.2.3 ( __23; 2 ___
27 ) is a point of inflection because g
10
–2
changes from concave down to concave up at
2 –3
x = __
3.
y = 3x – 3
Answers 361
__
2 ( _____
r − 2r ) + 3 πr ( √ 3 r )
5.3 h ’ ( 2 ) = 9,5 m/s 2 3
V = __ 2700 1 2
__
3 πr + πr __
5.4 Acceleration = h ” ( t ) = −10 m/s2 2 √ 3 πr3
= __πr3 + 2700πr − 2πr3 + ______
3 3
__
5.5 Maximum height when t = 2,95 seconds = 2 700πr −
πr3 (
___ 4 − √3 )
Maximum height 46,51 m ______ 3
7.1 1
a = __ TOPIC 8: REVISION TEST
2 , b = 0, c = − 8 and k = 2
7.2 (1 2
T ( p;2 ),Q ( − p;2 ),R − p;__ __
)
1 2
(
2 p − 8 and S p; 2 p − 8 ) 1.1 x=4
7.3 QT and RS are horizontal lines, QR and TS are 1.2 f ( x ); 4,9; 4,99; 4,999; 4,9999; Undefined;
vertical lines, angles in QRST are all right angles, 5,0001; 5,001; 5,01; 5,1
QRST is a rectangle.
1.3 Yes, the limit is 5. Although f ( 4 ) is
7.4 Area QRTS = 20p − p3. undefined, lim f ( x ) = 5 and limf ( x ) = 5.
___ x→4 − x→4+
7.5 p= √___
20
3 ≈ 2,58 units, p < 0 2.1 −6
7.6 Maximum area= 34,43 units2
6
__
2.2 7
7.7 y = 2x − 10
8.2 DE = x3 + 8
1
Turning point: __ 1
__
3 ;−1 3 ( )
362 Answers
4.1 −h + 7 ( 8;−____
3 )
179
5 −__ 4
x2 1
11.3 (2;−35__
3)
g ’ ( −2 ) = −1
7 g ’ ( x ) = −3 12.2 ( − __13;10___
27 )
16
g ’ ( 4 ) = −3 12.3 x = −1 or x = 4 or x = − 4
8 f ’( x ) =0
12.4 f(x) = –x3 – x 2 + 16x + 16 y
(2;36)
2
9.1 f ’ ( x ) = __
2
x
2
__
2 = 2 ⇒ x = 1 and x = ± 1
9.2 2
x – 1 ;10 16 16
3 27
9.3 y = 8x − 8 –4 –1 4
833 23
9.4 y = − ____ ___
27 = −30 27 and y = 45
– 8 ;–14 22
3 27
9.6 y = −13x + 12
175
9.7 y = −16x + ____
27 or 432x + 27y = 175
4
10.1 f ’ ( x ) = 7 − __
2 x
Answers 363
18.13 8 seconds
16.5 m = f ’( 0 ) = − 4
18.14 h ’ ( 8 ) = − 8,125 m/s
16.6 x=2
19.1 26,4 m
4 3
17.1 V = __ πr + πr2h and T.S.A. = 4πr2 + 2πrh
3 19.2 11,2 m/s
17.2.1 4πr2 + 2πrh = 1,56π
19.3 t = 2 or t = 2,8
0,78 − 2r2
h = _________
r 19.4 2,4 seconds.
0,78
____
= r − 2r
19.5 27,04 m
4 3
17.2.2 V = __
3 πr + πr
0,78
2 ____
r − 2r ( ) 19.6 5 seconds
4
= __πr3 + 0,78πr − 2πr3
3 19.7 20,8 m/s
2
= 0,78πr − __πr3
3 19.8 The ball is stationary at 2,4 seconds and the
17.2.3 V = 1,02 m3 velocity is zero.
9 4 3
17.3.1 ___ __
16 π = 3 πr + πr h
2
20.1 A(4;7) and B ( 4;−18 )
17.4 In both 17.2 and 17.3 h = 0. A sphere is more 20.6 k ∈ [ −20,25;16 ] or −20,25 ≤ k ≤ 16, k ∈ ℝ
efficient than a capsule for minimising or
maximising the surface area.
364 Answers
21.4 t = 8 seconds
TOPIC 9: EXERCISE 2
1.2 Yes, with centre off the origin 1.4 Equation of tangent: Equation of normal:
1(
y − 4 = − __
5 x−1
) y − 4 = 5( x − 1 )
1.3 Yes, with centre off the origin
1 21
y = − __ ___
5x + 5 y = 5x − 1
1.4 No, (y2 term is negative)
1.5 Equation of tangent: Equation of normal:
1.5 No, (x2 and y2 coefficients different) 1
y = − __
5x − 7 y = −5x − 7
1.6 ( −2
No, −16 + ___
2 ( )2 + ( __42 )2 = −11 ), which would 1.6 Equation of tangent: Equation of normal:
1(
mean that r2 = −11 which is impossible. y − 3 = − __
2 x+1
) y − 3 = 2( x + 1 )
1 5
2.1 x2 + y2 = 49 y = − __ __
2x + 2 y = 2x + 5
5 34
2.2 x2 + y2 = 73 2.1 y = __ ___
3x − 3
5 5
2.3 ( x − 3 )2 + ( y + 5 )2 = 3 2.2 y = __ __
2x − 2
2.4 ( x − 1 )2 + ( y − 3 )2 = 37 2.3 Tangent at ( 0;0 ): x = 0
2.5 ( x + 1 )2 + ( y − 4 )2 = 25 or ( x + 1 )2 + ( y + 4 )2 = 25 Tangent at ( − 4;0 ): x = − 4
1
2.6 ( x − 3 )2 + ( y − 1 )2 = 5 or ( x − 1 )2 + ( y − 1 )2 = 5 2.4 y = __
4x
__ __
2.7 7 2
(x + __ 65
7 2 ___
__ 2.5 y = √ 7 or y = − √ 7
2 ) + (y + 2 ) = 2
2.8 x2 + ( y − 1 )2 = 36 2.6 x = − 8 or x = 2
Answers 365
4.3 3 __
M = __ 1
5; 5( ) 9.1 BC = 10
366 Answers
12.4 4
y = − __ 16.7.3 ( − 26,1;4,9 )
3x
3 25 17 No intersection
12.5 y = __ ___
4x + 4
18.1 Centre = ( 1;2 ) or ( 5;10 )
29
12.6 p = − ___
3
__
18.2 Radius = 2a = 2 or 10
12.7 BC = 2√ 5
Answers 367
h( x ) = 4 × 2x − 3 − 2
Asymptote: y = −2
x-intercept: (2;0)
y-intercept: 4 × 2− 3 − 2 = −1,5 ⇒ ( 0;−1,5 )
3
y f (x ) = –1
x–2
h(x) = 4 × 2 x – 3 – 2
-
y= –x + 1
- y= x – 3
- ( 3 ;2 )
1-
- x
-
0 1 2 3 5
y = –1 –1
-
–1,5
y = –2
-
–2,5
-
x=2
–3 -
368 Answers
2x and y = − √ 2x , x ≥ 0
1 1
5.2 Option 1: x = 2y2 ⇒ y2 = __ __
___
2 x and y = √ 2 x , x ≥ 0
1 1
Option 2: x = 2y2 ⇒ y2 = __ __
h
(4) 4 3
(0;0) 1 __
7.2 h = 4, r = 4√ 2 (5)
Answers 369
1.3
Cumulative
Mass in kg Frequency
frequency
50 ≤ x < 60 1 1
60 ≤ x < 70 7 8
70 ≤ x < 80 8 16
80 ≤ x < 90 7 23
90 ≤ x < 100 4 27
18 -
16 -
14 -
12 -
10 -
8-
6-
4-
2-
M P
- x
-
370 Answers
O 4 60°
3 2
2 1 1
30°
3
F
E _____
K
6.2.1 cos 24° = √ 1 − p2
Answers 371
2 f(x) = cosx + 1
(120;0,5) (240;0,5)
x
-
-
-
–90 –45 45 90 135 180 225 270
–1 g(x) = –cos 2x
(180;–1)
OH || AE | Midpoint theorem, O ^
^J = M | tan NM / chord MP
1 1
and H midpoints of AC ⇒M ^ =M ^
1 2
and EC
15.3 N ^
^ =M | Corresponding ∠s, NO || MK
or 4
13.4 ^ C= 90˚
BA
372 Answers
Answers 373
374 Answers
7.2 PT2 + QT2 = 92 + 122 = 225 1.3 BC = 200 units | Pythagoras’ Theorem in △DBC
PQ2 = 152 = 225 FB = 100 units
PQ2 = PT2 + QT2
^ Q = 90° 1.4 AB = 150 units | Pythagoras’ Theorem in △ABC
PT | Converse of Pythagoras’ ___
AF = 50√ 13 | Pythagoras’ Theorem in △ABF
Theorem
^ R = QT
^ R = QT
^ R = 90° 1.5 In △CED and △CFA:
7.3 PQ | △PQR ||| △PTQ ||| QTR ^ is common
1) C
7.4 25: 9: 16 2) CE^ F = CF
^A | Corresponding ∠s, DE || AF
3) ^
CDE = CA ^ F | ∠sum △
7.5 PR – only a diameter can subtend a right angle
⇒ △CED ||| △CFA | AAA
on the circumference. CE
ED ___
___
FA = CF | △CED ||| △CFA
___
8.1 In △ABC ||| △DAB: ED = 32√ 13
AC ___
___ 22 __
2
1) BD =
33 =
3 | Given DG ___
___ EF
1.6 DB = EB | FG || ED
AB
___ 18 __
___ 2
2) DA = 27 = 3 | Given
540
BC ___
DG = ____
17
___ 12 __2
3) AB = 18 = 3 | Given
540 _____
1500
1.7 GB = 120 − ____
17 = 17
⇒ △ABC ||| △DAB | Sides in proportion
1.8 In △BFG and △BED:
8.2 AB2 + BC2 = 468 1) ^ is common.
B
AC2 = 484 2) B^FG = BE
^D | Corresponding ∠s, FG || ED
AC2 ≠ AB2 + BC2 3) ^
BGF = BD ^ E | ∠sum of △
△ABCis not a right-angled triangle. ⇒ △BFG ||| △BED | AAA
FG
___ BF
___
8.3 4
__
ED = BE | △BFG ||| △BED
9 ___
400√13
8.4 D = 33° FG = ________
17
8.5 No, it is not a cyclic quadrilateral. 2.1 PV = VR | OV ⊥ PR
^ ≠ AD
BCD ^ B |△ABC ||| △DAB
VS = 2 units
TV = 8 units
8.6 No, AB and CD are not parallel to each other.
It was proved in 8.2 that △ABC is not a right- 2.1.1 PV2 = TV.VS = 16 ^S = 90° and PV
| In △TPS, TP
angled triangle, and because △ABC ||| △DAB ⊥ TS
we know that AB ^ C = DA^ B. The co-interior
PV = 4 units
angles cannot be supplementary. PR = 8 units | PV = VR
9.1 In △DHG and △FHE: 2.1.2 TO = OP = OS = 5 units | Radii
DG ___
___ 4 1 OV = 3 units
1) FE = = __
4 | Given
16
PV = 4 units | Pythagoras’ Theorem in
HG ___
___ 3 1
__
2) HE = 12 = 4 | Given △OPV
DH __
___ 2 __1 PR = 8 units | PV = VR
3) FH = 8 = 4 | Given
376 Answers
3.5 ^ D = 90°
BA | ∠ on diameter BD
4
1.2.3 Area △TQV = __ Area △PQV5 AE2 = DE.EB ^ D = 90°and
| In △BAD, BA
| Common vertex V, same height AE ⊥ BD
4
__
5 Area PQV
Area △TQV ___________
__________
Area △PQR
=
4 2
Area △PQR
8
( )
= __ __ = ___
5 5 25
144 = 6.EB
EB = 24 units
2.1 ^ =x
E | tan BD, chord EC ^ = 180° − x + y
6 4.1.1 A ( ) | Opposite ∠s cyclic
^ =x
E | Vertically opposite ∠s
3 quadrilateral ACDE
^ =x
A | tan HE, chord FE
2
4.1.2 ^ =x+y
F | Opposite ∠s cyclic
4
2.2 In △FEA and △CED: quadrilateral ABFE
1) A^ =D ^ =x | Proved
2 ^ =x+y | Vertically opposite ∠s
2) ^ ^
E2 = E5 | Vertically opposite ∠s
4.1.3 F2
^ =x CD2 = CE.CF
3.1 C1 | ∠s on chord AD
^ =x
D | Alternate ∠s, FG || AC 5.1 T3 = 90° | PT ⊥ MN
4
^ =x
A2 | tan GD, chord DC ^ = 90°
R | ∠ on diameter MN
1
D1 = x | tan FD, chord DA or alternate
∠s, FG || AC TSRN is a cyclic quadrilateral
^ B = 90° | Exterior ∠ = interior opposite ∠
3.2 FD | Radius ⊥ tangent
^
E2 = 90° | Co-interior ∠s, FG || AC
^ = 90°
E | Straight ∠
1
AE = EC | OE ⊥ AC
Answers 377
5.6 ^ =N
P ^ | △MPN ||| △MTP 5.10.3 TS: SQ = 7: 25
1 1
MP is a tangent to circle PTN. 5.10.4 MS: SR = 225: 351 = 25: 39
| converse tan/chord theorem
5.10.5 No, sides are not proportional.
5.7 In △MTS and △MRN: 9
___
1) ^ is common.
M
5.11 64
2
7
___
2) ^ =R
T ^ = 90° | Exterior ∠ cyclic 5.12 25
1 1
quadrilateral TSRN 6.1 ^ =x
E | Alternate ∠s, AB || FE
2
^ | EF bisects A^ED
3) ^S = N
^ | Exterior ∠ cyclic
E3 = x
4 2 ^ =x
B | Corresponding ∠
quadrilateral TSRN 2
^ =x
C 1
| Corresponding ∠s, EF || CD
⇒ △MTS ||| △MRN | AAA ^ =x
D | Alternate ∠s, BA || CD
2
MT
___ MS
5.8 = ____ | △MTS ||| △MRN AF
___ BE
MR MN 6.2.1 = ___ED | BA || EF
FC
MR.MS = MT.MN EC = ED | Isosceles △ECD
AF
___ BE
MP2 = MT.MN | Proved in 5.5 = ___
FC EC
⇒ MP2 = MR.MS 6.2.2 ^ =D
A ^ =x | Proved in 6.1
1 2
5.9 PT2 = MT.TN ^N = 90° and
| In △MPN, MP ABCD is a cyclic quadrilateral
PT ⊥ MN | BC subtends equal angles at A and D
PT = TQ | Proved in 5.2
PT.TQ = MT.TN
MT.TN
⇒ PT = ______
TQ
378 Answers
Answers 379
E
TOPIC 11: EXERCISE 2
1.1 r = –0,2378
A This shows that there is a weak negative
1.1 r = –1 correlation between x and y.
This shows that there is a perfect negative
correlation between x and y. 1.2 A = 67,71 and B = – 0,2186
Regression line: y = – 0,2231x + 67,65
1.2 A = 200 and B = –2
Regression line: y = –2x + 200 1.3 When x = 100: the regression line predicts
y = –45,85
1.3 When x = 150: the regression line predicts This is extrapolation.
y = –100
This is extrapolation. F
B 1.1 r = 0,509
This shows that there is a moderately strong
1.1 r = 0,985 positive correlation between x and y.
This shows that there is a very strong positive
correlation between x and y. 1.2 A = 33,2 and B = 1,4186
Regression line: y = 1,4186x + 33,2
1.2 A = –7,69 and B = 3,47
Regression line: y = 3,47x – 7,69 1.3 When x = 28: the regression line predicts
y = 72,9208
1.3 When x = 67: the regression line predicts This is interpolation.
y = 224,8
2.1 100 -
This is interpolation.
C 80 -
60 -
Test 1
1.1 r = 0,36
This shows that there is a fairly weak positive 40 -
correlation between x and y. 20 -
-
-
380 Answers
Weight (kg)
--
bivariate data is close to 1, and interpolation 90 –-
-
--
was involved in this prediction. -
80 –-
3.1 120 - --
-
Height/length (cm)
100 - 70 –-
--
80 - -
60 –
60 - x
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
–
150 160 170 180 190 200 210
40 -
Height (cm)
20 -
-
2010 SA Schools Players: Height versus weight
-
0 20 40 y
Age (months) 120 –-
--
3.2.1 r = 0,997 -
110 –-
--
3.2.2 A = 66,8 and B = 0,8278 -
100 –-
Weight (kg)
--
3.3 y = 0,827x x + 66,8 -
90 –-
At age 26 months, predicted height --
-
80 –-
= 88,3228 cm --
-
70 –-
3.4 At birth (x = 0), so predicted length = 66,8 cm --
-
3.5 This is not accurate because it involves 60 –
x
-
-
-
-
–
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
extrapolation. 150 160 170 180 190 200 210
120 - Height (cm)
3.6
Height/length (cm)
60 -
-
0 20 40 60
50 -
Age (months) 40 -
30 -
y = 10,983x + 88,655
3.7 Intuitively an exponential trend where the
20 -
rate of increase is decreasing, seems more 10 -
appropriate when considering all the points -
-
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
plotted. When comparing these points to the Hours spent watching TV
regression line, we see that the plotted points
5.2 y = −10,983x + 88,655
are first below, then above, and then below the
residual line. This trend means that the residual 5.3 r = – 0,95
values would be positive in the middle and 5.4 There is a strong negative correlation
negative at the low and high ends. This trend
confirms our intuitive suggestion that a linear
Answers 381
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
120 140 160 180 200
test A and 25 for test B). Test A also has a Q1 Q2 Q3
larger interquartile range (16 versus 7 for test
3.3 median = 160 cm, IQR = 168 – 153 = 15 cm
B). This shows that the results for test A were
more widely spread. In fact, for test B, 75% of 3.4 The IQR is fairly small compared to the range
the results were above 40. Both test values are (which is 75 cm), showing that 50% of the data
skewed to the left because each had one or two falls within a small range of 15 cm. There is
low results that caused the left whisker to be one high and one low value which have caused
long. the range to be large. These could possibly be
outliers. As the mean is almost equal to the
1.4 r = 0,53 which show that there is a moderately
median, we can say that the data is close to
strong positive correlation between the two test
symmetrical.
results.
4.1
1.5 60 - 400 -
Sales (thousands
40 - 300 -
Test B
of Rands)
20 - 200 -
-
100 -
-
0 20 40 60
Test A -
-
0 10 20 30 40 50
We saw from the value of r that there is a
Advertising (thousands of Rands)
moderately strong positive correlation between
4.2 r = 0,96 which shows that there is a very strong
the data values. Considering the scatter plot,
positive correlation between the advertising
it appears that a regression line would fit
expenditure and the sales figures. As they spend
reasonably well, especially if we omit the first
more money on advertising, so their sales
data value. Also, the points are randomly above
figures go up.
and below the regression line, which suggests
again that a linear trend is appropriate. 4.3 This set of bivariate data has a high correlation
coefficient (close to 1), and therefore has a
1.6 y = 0,2695x + 33,905
strong positive correlation.
382 Answers
0,04 -
0,03 - 7.2.1 y = – 0,1447x + 78,378
0,02 - 7.2.2 y = – 0,5155x + 95,759
0,01 -
7.3.1 r = – 0,2287
-
-
0 5 10 15 7.3.2 r = – 0, 868
Days passed since spillage
7.4 When the outlier is included, there is a weak
5.2 This shows a declining exponential trend.
negative correlation, whereas when the
5.3 Regression line: y = − 0,004x + 0,0434 outlier is excluded, there is a strong negative
Residuals will be negative for the middle correlation. In both cases they follow a linear
values and positive at the high and low ends. trend.
This confirms that a linear approach is not
8 r = 0,0007. As this value is very close to 0, it
appropriate in this situation.
shows that there is no correlation between these
5.4 r = – 0,96, which shows that there is a very
data values. So the height of the learners in this
strong negative correlation between these two
group did not affect their mathematics results.
sets of data. As the number of days since the
spillage increases, so the percentage of oil still in
the river decreases. TOPIC 12: EXERCISE 1
2 __
__ 1
1.1 =
6.1 300 - 4 2
Variable B
200 - 1.2 0
1
__
100 - 1.3 4
- 3
__
1.4
-
0 10 20 30 40 4
4 1
Variable A 2.1 P(queen) = ___ __
52 = 4
6.2 Parabolic trend. Perhaps the virus becomes 2.2 26 __
P(red card) = ___ 1
52 = 2
immune to the drug after 20 days
3
12 ___
2.3 P(picture card) = ___
52 = 13
6.3 y = 4,7086x + 160,73
2 1
Residuals will be negative for the middle values 2.4 P(black king) = ___ ___
52 = 26
and positive on the high and low ends. While 2.5 P(red or 7) = P(red) + P(7) − P(red and 7)
this cannot tell us that the trend is parabolic 1 4 2 7
= __ + ___ − ___ = ___
2 52 52 13
and not exponential, it does tell us that a linear 48 ___12
approach is not appropriate. We can see from 2.6 P(not Jack) = ___
52 = 13
the plotted points that there is an increase after 3.1 P(A ∩ C) = 0 ∴ A and C are mutually exclusive,
the decrease, which is why we would decide and P(A) + P(C) = 1 ∴ A and C are exhaustive.
that a parabolic trend is appropriate.
Answers 383
4 Male Female x + 10 x 2x + 20
Married 75 81 156
Unmarried 15 9 24 6x
90 90 180
x = 62
75 5
P(married male) = ____ = ___
180 12 ∴ there are 372 learners who play neither soccer
5 Striped tie nor rugby.
White
Black tie
shirt TOPIC 12: EXERCISE 2
Blue tie
Striped tie
Black Green 1 Win
Black tie
trousers shirt 0,4
Blue tie
Striped tie Rain
Blue
Black tie 0,2 0,6
shirt
Blue tie Lose
Striped tie Win
White 0,8 0,7
Black tie
shirt Not
Blue tie rain
Striped tie 0,3
Blue Green
Black tie Lose
trousers shirt
Blue tie 2
1.1 P(Rain and Win) = 0,2 × 0,4 = ___
25
Striped tie
Blue 1.2 P(Not Rain) = 0,8
Black tie
shirt
Blue tie 1.3 16
P(Win) = 0,2 × 0,4 + 0,8 × 0,7 = ___
1 25
5.1 P(Black Trousers, White Shirt, Striped Tie) = ___ 18 1.4 P(Lose | Not Rain) = 0,3
6 1
5.2 P(Striped Tie) = ___ = __
18 3 2.1 P(Knife, Fork and Spoon)
5.3 4
P(no Blue) = ___ 2
= __
18 9 (12 10
30 29 28
8 12
) (
8
30 29 28
10 10 12
) (
30 29 28
8
= ___ × ___ × ___ + ___ × ___ × ___ + ___ × ___ × ___ )
5.4 P(Trousers and Tie same colour) = P(both Black
6 1
(10 8
30 29 28
12 8
) (
12 10
30 29 28
8
) (
10 12
+ ___ × ___ × ___ + ___ × ___ × ___ + ___ × ___ × ___
30 29 28 )
or both Blue) = ___ __
18 = 3
(
12 × 10 × 8
= 6 ____________ = ____
30 × 29 × 28
48
203 )
6 C 60
2.2 P(three the same)
13 17
A (12
30
11
29
10
28
10
30 ) (
9
29
8
28
8
30
7
= ___ × ___ × ___ + ___ × ___ × ___ + ___ × ___
29 ) (
16 B
×
6
___
28 )
5 99
_____
9 =
1 015
5 1
2.3 P(three knives) = ___12 ___11 ___
(
10 11
____
30 × 29 × 28 = 203 )
6.1 P(A ∩ B) = ___ ___
60 = 12 10 ___ 8 7
___ 2
___
2.4 P(F, S, S) =___
30
×
29 × 28 = 87
31
6.2 P(B ∪ C)= ___
60 2.5 P(K, K,no fork)
43
6.3 P(C) ’= ___
60
(12 11 10
28
12
30 ) (
11 8 99
= ___ × ___ × ___ + ___ × ___ × ___ = _____
30 29 29 28 1 015 )
6.4 n(A ∪ B ∪ C) ’ = 13 10 1
3.1.1 P(run and gym) = ____ ___
100 = 10
5
6.5 P(B | A) = ___
21 90 9
3.1.2 P(Cycling) ’ = ____ ___
100 = 10
384 Answers
5.1 3 __
P(out first round) = __ 1 12.4 9 × 9P4 = 27 216
9=3
12.5 1 × 104 = 10 000
5.2 P(winner)
12.6 1 × 8P3 × 1 = 336
(
4 3 2
= 2 __ × __ × __
9 8
4 __
__
) (3
2 __ 4 __
__
7 + 9×8×7 + 9×8×7 ) (
2 __
1
)
12.7 1 × 1 × 93 = 729
2
( 4
+ __ × __ × __
9 8
3 2 __
__
) (
4 __
1 2 __
__
7 + 9×8×7 + 9×8×7 ) (
1 __
4
)
5 12.8 1 × 1 × 8P3 = 336
= ___
21
12.9 10 × 9P3 × 1 = 5040
5.3 P(winner | past first round)
12.10 10 × 103 × 1 = 10 000
(
3 2
= 2 __ × __
8
__
) (
2 __ 3
7 + 8×7 + 8×7
2 __
__ 1
) ( ) 13 58 = 390 625
4
(
+ __ × __
8
3 __
) (
4 __1
7 + 8×7 + 8×7
1 __
__ 4
) ( ) 14 5P3 + 5P4 = 180
5
= __
7 15.1 64 + 54 = 1 921
5.4 P(getting to third round)
15.2 64 + 5P4 = 1 416
4
(9 3 4
8 ) (9
2 2 4
8 ) (9
2 1
) (9
5
= __ × __ + __ × __ + __ × __ + __ × __ = ___
8 8 ) 12 15.3 6P4 + 54 = 985
6.1 n(A ∩ B) = 0,1 × 200 = 20
16.1 10! = 3 628 800
6.2 P(A) = 0,2 + 0,1 = 0,3 16.2 4! × 2! × 4! × 3! = 6 912
0,1 1
6.3 P(B | A) = ___ = __
0,3 3 16.3 7! × 4! = 120 960
6.4 P(A ∪ B ’) = 0,6 17.1 4! = 24
17.2 1 × 3! = 6
TOPIC 12: EXERCISE 3
17.3 3! × 1 = 6
1.1 99 = 387 420 489
17.4 1 × 1 × 2! = 2
1.2 9! = 362 880
17.5 2 × 3! = 12
2.1 3×2=6
2.2 3 × 2 × 1 × 2 = 12 17.6 3 × 3! = 18
Answers 385
1
__ 12.1 x = 0,55
1.1 6
5
__ 12.2 P(A ’ ∩ B)= 1 – (0,05+0,55+0,1) = 0,3
1.2 6
2 __
__ 1 12.3 P(A | B) = 0,55
1.3 6=3
1 __
__ 1 __
1 12.4 P(A ∩ B) = 0,55; P(A) × P(B) = 0,6 × 0,85
1.4 6+6=3 = 0,51 ≠ 0,55. A and B are not independent.
2.1 255 = 9 765 625 9
13.1 P(A ∩ B) = P(A) × P(B) = 0,75 × 0,15 = ___
80
2.2 25P5 = 6 375 600
10P3 13.2 P(A ∩ B) = 0
____ 9
___
3.1 = 120 P(A ∩ B) 80 3
3! 13.3 P(A | B) = _______
P(B)
= ____ = __
0,15 4
3.2 10P3 = 720
13.4 P(A) + P(B) = 0,9 < 1 so A and B are
4 210 = 1 024 not exhaustive and ∴ A and B are not
5.1.1 11P4 = 7 920 complimentary.
386 Answers
∑18(__13)n
h(−8x − 4h)
2.2.1 −1
(5) = lim___________
h
n=1 h→0
Answers 387
B E
x
C D
x + h = 12
h = 12 − x
1 1
Area △ABE = __ __
2 xh = 2 x(12 − x)
Perimeter BCDE = 2x + 2BC = 24
24 − 2x
BC = _______
2 = 12 − x
Area BCDE = x(12 − x)
1
Area ABCDE = __ 2 x(12 − x) + x(12 − x)
1
__
= (12 − x)( x + x)
2
3
= __x(12 − x) (4)
2
8.2 x=6 (3)
9.2.1 (4)
Dogs Cats
5
7 6
0
4 1
6
Fish
9.2.3 __
8
(2)
15
388 Answers
60 –-
-
-
-
55 –-
-
-
-
–
50 -
-
-
-
45 –-
-
-
-
40 –-
-
-
-
35 –-
-
-
-
30 –-
-
-
-
–
25 -
-
-
-
20 –-
-
-
-
–
15 -
-
-
-
10 –-
-
-
-
–
5 -
-
-
-
0– x
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
–
140 145 150 155 160 165 170 175 180 185 190
(4)
3.6 t = −1 or t = 5 (4)
1.3.1 164 (1)
3.7 64,65° (5)
1.3.2 12 (2)
125
4.1 x2 + (y − 5)2 = ____
4 (5)
1.3.3 18,3% (2)
1 45
4.2 y = − __ ___
2x + 4 (4)
1.4.1 Box-and-whisker diagram at the top of
the page below ogive (2) 4.3 Centre = (1;−3) and r = 2 (4)
Answers 389
7.1
1 y = cos(x – 30)
x
–180 –150 –120 –90 –60 –30 30 60 90 120 150 180
–1
y = sin 3x
390 Answers
3.1 d=4 2
__
7.1 (5)
x2
a=3 (5)
( )
x
6.1 f −1 ( 1
x ) = __ (2) 10.1 263 × 104 = 138 240 000 (3)
3
6.2.1 g ( x ) = − log__1 x = log3 x (1) 10.2 26 × 25 × 24 × 10 × 9 × 8 × 7 = 78 624 000 (3)
3
1.2 (3)
11 41 52 61 79
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
–
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
Answers 391
2-
1-
- x
-
-
0 20 40 60 80
Age (years)
(3) 4.2.1 Using identities:
cos 343°
2.2 y = 0,3837 + 0,0262x (4)
= cos 17°
__________
2.3 r = 0,9705916242 ≈ 0,9706 (1) = √_____
1 − sin2 17°
= √ 1 − p2
2.4 very strong, positive correlation (2)
Using figure:
2.5 y = 2,0867 seconds. (2)
392 Answers
(–90°; 12 (
(–90°:–1) (90°:–1)
(180°;– 3
2
(
5.3 360° (1) 6.1 ^ F = 90° − y − x
DG (3)
( )
cos ( y − x ) GF
5.4.1 x ∈ [ −30°;10° ] ∪ [ 130°;180° ] 6.2 DF = _____________
cos x ➀
or h cos x
______
GF = sin x
−30° ≤ x ≤ 10° or 130° ≤ x ≤ 180° (2)
h cos ( y − x )
DF = ___________ (6)
5.4.2 x ∈ ( − 60°;− 45° ) ∪ ( 45°;120° ) ∪ ( 135°;180° ] sin x
or − 60° < x < − 45° or 45° < x < 120°
or 135° < x ≤ 180° (2)
7.1 P
T
90° –x
x
90° – x
Q R
△PQR ||| △PRT ||| △RQT | △PQR is a right-angled triangle, with RT ⊥ PQ
PR ___
___ PQ
PT = PR | △PQR ||| △PRT
PR2 = PT.PQ
QR ___
___ PQ
QT = | △PQR ||| △RQT
RQ
QR2 = QT.PQ
RT
___ PT
= ___ | △PRT ||| △RQT
RT
QT
RT2 = QT.PT
PR2 + QR2 = PT.PQ + QT.PQ
= PQ ( PT + TQ )
= PQ.PQ
= PQ2
Answers 393
8.1 4: 2: 3 (4)
9
4.5 y ∈ ℝ, y > 0 (1)
1.1.3 x ≤ − 4 or x ≥ __
2 (5)
27
4.6 y
1.1.4 ___ (2)
4 h
1.1.5 x = −7 (3) B(–2;4)
x
__
1.2.1 y=4 (3)
4 16
1.2.2 y = __ and x = ___
5 5 (3) A(0;1)
x
2.1.1 Pattern 1: 8; 14; 20; 26 + … (1;0)
Pattern 2: 8; 18; 32; 50 + … (2) (4;–2)
h –1
2.1.2 Pattern 1 is linear because the 1st difference is (8;–3)
constant and is equal to 6.
Pattern 2 is quadratic because the 2nd difference
is constant and is equal to 4. (2) 0<x≤8 (4)
394 Answers
6.3.2 14 (3)
Squash 4
6.3.3 y = 6x − 7 (3)
(6)
6.3.4 f(−x) = C
f −1(x) = A
−f(x) = B (3)
8.1 h = 8 − 2x − πx (3)
πr2
8.2 A = 4x × h + ___
2 π(2x)2
= 4x(8 − 2x − πx) + ______
2
= 32x − 8x2 − 4πx2 + 2πx2
= 32x − 8x2 − 2πx2 (3)
dA
___
8.3 dx
= 32 − 16x − 4πx = 0
x = 4,48 m (4)
Answers 395
G
6
9 3
B P(GGB) = 7 6 3
8 10 9 8
G
6 G P(GBG) = 7 3 6
7 8 10 9 8
3
10 9 B
2 7 3 2
8 B P(GBB) =
10 9 8
6 G P(BGG) = 3 7 6
8 10 9 8
3 7 G
10 9 2
B P(BGB) = 3 7 2
8 10 9 8
B
7 G P(BBG) = 3 2 7
8 10 9 8
2
9 B
1 3 2 1
8 B P(BBB) =
10 9 8
7
___
9.3.1 24 (2)
21
___
9.3.2 40 (3)
1.2.1 12 cm (2)
1.2.2 25 cm (2)
340 -
320 -
300 -
280 -
260 -
240 -
220 -
200 -
180 -
160 -
140 -
120 -
100 -
80 -
60 -
40 -
20 -
-
-
0 5 10 15
Age (days)
396 Answers
-
-
-
–180° –135° –90° –45° 45° 90° 135° 180°
the new points do not lie on the original least
squares regression line (2)
3.2.5 ^ B = 26,56°
AD (5) 60° T
4.1 M(−2;−3) radius = 5 (5) D
9.1.1 ^
AOC = 120° (2)
4.2 A(− 6;0) and B(2;0) (4)
4 ^ C = 60°
4.3 y = __
3x + 8 (4) 9.1.2 AD (2)
___ __
− √155 − 2√5
______________ 9.1.3 ^ C = 120°
AB (2)
5.1 sin(B − A) = 18 (6)
1__ ^ D = 70°
5.2 tan 30° = ___
√
(5) 9.1.4 CA (2)
3
cos 2x
_____________ cos x − sin x
___________ 9.1.5 ^ C = 120°
AE (2)
6.1 3 = 1 + sin 2x
(cos x + sin x)
2
cos x − sin x 2 9.2 Theorem bookwork (5)
LHS = _____________3
(cos x + sin x)
9.3.1 a) ^ = 20°
O (4)
2
(cos x − sin x)(cos x + sin x)
= ________________________ ^ = 90°
(cos x + sin x)(cos x + sin x)2 9.3.1 b) D1
(2)
cos x − sin x
= _________________________ 9.3.2 ^ = 90°
O | Given
sin2 x + 2 sin x cos x + cos2x 1
^ C = 90° | Angle in semicircle
BD
cos x − sin x
= ___________ = RHS (5) The exterior angle of quadrilateral COED is
1 + sin 2x
6.2 x = 135° (5) equal to the interior opposite angle
COED is a cyclic quadrilateral. (3)
7.1 x = 45° + n.120°, n ∈ Z
or
x = −135° + n.360°, n ∈ Z (5)
Answers 397
10.3.1 P = N2 = x
Q2 = P = x (6)
10.3.2 Q1 = Q2 = x | Proved
P = N2 = x | Proved
N1 = M | Angles in △ (2)
QN QP
10.3.3 ____ ____
QM = QN | △QNP ||| △QMN
10.3.4 QM = 19,31
398 Answers
Glossary 399
S
scatter plot the graphical representation of bivariate data
in the form of points plotted on a Cartesian plane
scrap value the depreciated value of an item once it has
reached the end of its useful life
secant a line which passes through a circle, intersecting the
circle at two points
similar polygons polygons which have the same shape as
each other, but may be different in size
solution a value of the angle which satisfies a given
trigonometric equation
specific solutions solutions that satisfy a given
trigonometric equation in a restricted interval, such
as – 360° ≤ x ≤ 360°
sum to infinity no limit to the number of terms being
added to determine the sum
T
tangent a line which touches a curve at the point of
contact
V
vertex the point at which two straight lines meet to form an
angle
400 Index
B E
bivariate data 243–252 empirical probability 256
equations
of circles 188–192
C exponential 49–50
circles
of tangents to functions 158–161
centered at origin 188
of tangent to circle 193–197
centered off origin 188
trigonometric See trigonometric equations
equations of 188–192
Euclidean geometry 214–236
tangent to 193–197
events 256–260
common
examination
difference 4
learning derivations and proofs for 318
ratio 8
preparing for 316
vertex 221
structure of 296–298
complementary events 256–260
writing 317
compound angle identities 92–95
for tan (α ± β) 99–100 exponential
for tan 2α 99–100 equations 49–50
compound interest 60 functions 48–50, 48–50
calculating time periods 79 extrapolation 246
consecutive terms 7
contingency tables 261–266 F
correlation 243–252 factorial 268
coefficient 244 factor theorem 135–139
negative 244 finance 60–87
positive 244 first principles, differentiation of functions from 150–153
corresponding function
angles 218 derivative of 150
sides 218 f, using limits to define derivative of 146–149
counting 256–279 functions 34–36
principle, application to solve probability problems differentiation of, from first principles 150–153
275–279 exponential 48–50
cubic inverse of 37
graphs 167–175 logarithmic 51–52, 54–55
polynomials 135–139 many-to-one 35
one-to-one 35
D fundamental counting principle 267–274
data future value annuities 62–66
bivariate 243–252 delayed start of payments 77–78
skewed 240–242 that end early 73–75
symmetric 240–242, 240–242
dependent variable 146
Index 401
402 Index
T
tangent 144
tangents
to circle 193–197
to functions, equation of 158–161
third degree polynomial equations 132–134, 138–139
three dimensional problems 125–129
time periods, calculating using logarithms 79–81
tree diagrams 261–263, 261–266
triangles
equiangular 227–230
with proportional sides 231–234
trigonometric equations
with double angles and more than one ratio 105–108
ending with one ratio 103–105
solving using compound and double angle identities
101–102
trigonometry 90–108, 120–129
problems in three dimensions 125–129
problems in two dimensions 120–124
turning point formula 145
two-dimensional problems 120–124
V
Venn diagrams 261–262
vertex 221
vertical line test 35
X
x-intercept formula 145
x-intercept of graph 145
Y
y-intercept of graph 145
Index 403
website: www.mml.co.za
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or
otherwise, without the prior written permission of the copyright holder.
Every effort has been made to trace the copyright holders of material produced in this title. We would
like to apologise for any infringement of copyright so caused, and copyright holders are requested to
contact the publishers in order to rectify the matter.
Acknowledgements:
Edited by Penny Adnams
Proofreading by Lorrainne Bowie
Artwork by Will Alves and Tina Nel
Typesetting by Lizette van Greunen (LVG Maths) and Stronghold Publishing